14249 lines
482 KiB
Plaintext
14249 lines
482 KiB
Plaintext
(This foreword is not a part of American National Standard for
|
|
Information Systems --- Programming Language C, X3.???-1988.)
|
|
|
|
American National Standard Programming Language C specifies the
|
|
syntax and semantics of programs written in the C programming
|
|
language. It specifies the C program's interactions with the
|
|
execution environment via input and output data. It also specifies
|
|
restrictions and limits imposed upon conforming implementations of C
|
|
language translators.
|
|
|
|
The standard was developed by the X3J11 Technical Committee on the
|
|
C Programming Language under project 381-D by American National
|
|
Standards Committee on Computers and Information Processing (X3).
|
|
SPARC document number 83-079 describes the purpose of this project to
|
|
``provide an unambiguous and machine-independent definition of the
|
|
language C.''
|
|
|
|
The need for a single clearly defined standard had arisen in the C
|
|
community due to a rapidly expanding use of the C programming language
|
|
and the variety of differing translator implementations that had been
|
|
and were being developed. The existence of similar but incompatible
|
|
implementations was a serious problem for program developers who
|
|
wished to develop code that would compile and execute as expected in
|
|
several different environments.
|
|
|
|
Part of this problem could be traced to the fact that implementors
|
|
did not have an adequate definition of the C language upon which to
|
|
base their implementations. The de facto C programming language
|
|
standard, The C Programming Language by Brian W. Kernighan and Dennis
|
|
M. Ritchie, is an excellent book; however, it is not precise or
|
|
complete enough to specify the C language fully. In addition, the
|
|
language has grown over years of use to incorporate new ideas in
|
|
programming and to address some of the weaknesses of the original
|
|
language.
|
|
|
|
American National Standard Programming Language C addresses the
|
|
problems of both the program developer and the translator implementor
|
|
by specifying the C language precisely.
|
|
|
|
The work of X3J11 began in the summer of 1983, based on the several
|
|
documents that were made available to the Committee (see $1.5, Base
|
|
Documents). The Committee divided the effort into three pieces: the
|
|
environment, the language, and the library. A complete specification
|
|
in each of these areas is necessary if truly portable programs are to
|
|
be developed. Each of these areas is addressed in the Standard. The
|
|
Committee evaluated many proposals for additions, deletions, and
|
|
changes to the base documents during its deliberations. A concerted
|
|
effort was made to codify existing practice wherever unambiguous and
|
|
consistent practice could be identified. However, where no consistent
|
|
practice could be identified, the Committee worked to establish clear
|
|
rules that were consistent with the overall flavor of the language.
|
|
|
|
This document was approved as an American National Standard by the
|
|
American National Standards Institute (ANSI) on DD MM, 1988.
|
|
Suggestions for improvement of this Standard are welcome. They should
|
|
be sent to the American National Standards Institute, 1430 Broadway,
|
|
New York, NY 10018.
|
|
|
|
The Standard was processed and approved for submittal to ANSI by
|
|
the American National Standards Committee on Computers and Information
|
|
Processing, X3. Committee approval of the Standard does not
|
|
necessarily imply that all members voted for its approval. At the
|
|
time that it approved this Standard, the X3 Committee had the
|
|
following members:
|
|
|
|
Organization Name of Representative
|
|
(To be completed on approval of the Standard.)
|
|
|
|
Technical Committee X3J11 on the C Programming Language had the
|
|
following members at the time they forwarded this document to X3 for
|
|
processing as an American National Standard:
|
|
|
|
Chair
|
|
Jim Brodie
|
|
|
|
Vice-Chair
|
|
Thomas Plum Plum Hall Secretary
|
|
P. J. Plauger Whitesmiths, Ltd.
|
|
|
|
International Representative
|
|
P. J. Plauger Whitesmiths, Ltd.
|
|
Steve Hersee Lattice, Inc.
|
|
|
|
Vocabulary Representative
|
|
Andrew Johnson Prime Computer
|
|
|
|
Environment Subcommittee Chairs
|
|
Ralph Ryan Microsoft
|
|
Ralph Phraner Phraner Associates
|
|
|
|
Language Subcommittee Chair
|
|
Lawrence Rosler AT&T
|
|
|
|
Library Subcommittee Chair
|
|
P. J. Plauger Whitesmiths, Ltd.
|
|
|
|
Draft Redactor
|
|
David F. Prosser AT&T
|
|
Lawrence Rosler AT&T
|
|
|
|
Rationale Redactor
|
|
Randy Hudson Intermetrics, Inc.
|
|
|
|
In the following list, unmarked names denote principal members and *
|
|
denotes alternate members.
|
|
|
|
David F. Prosser, AT&T
|
|
Steven J. Adamski, AT&T* (X3H2 SQL liaison)
|
|
Bob Gottlieb, Alliant Computer Systems
|
|
Kevin Brosnan, Alliant Computer Systems
|
|
Neal Weidenhofer, Amdahl
|
|
Philip C. Steel, American Cimflex
|
|
Eric McGlohon, American Cimflex*
|
|
Stephen Kafka, Analog Devices
|
|
Kevin Leary, Analog Devices*
|
|
Gordon Sterling, Analog Devices*
|
|
John Peyton, Apollo Computer
|
|
Elizabeth Crockett, Apple Computers
|
|
Ed Wells, Arinc
|
|
Tom Ketterhagen, Arinc*
|
|
Vaughn Vernon, Aspen Scientific
|
|
Craig Bordelon, Bell Communications Research
|
|
Steve Carter, Bell Communications Research*
|
|
William Puig, Bell Communications Research*
|
|
Bob Jervis, Borland International
|
|
Yom-Tov Meged, Boston Systems Office
|
|
Rose Thomson, Boston Systems Office*
|
|
Maurice Fathi, COSMIC
|
|
John Wu, Charles River Data Systems
|
|
Daniel Mickey, Chemical Abstracts Service
|
|
Thomas Mimlitch, Chemical Abstracts Service*
|
|
Alan Losoff, Chicago Research & Trading Group
|
|
Edward Briggs, Citibank
|
|
Firmo Freire, Cobra S/A
|
|
Jim Patterson, Cognos
|
|
Bruce Tetelman, Columbia U. Center for Computing
|
|
Terry Moore, CompuDas
|
|
Mark Barrenechea, Computer Associates
|
|
George Eberhardt, Computer Innovations
|
|
Dave Neathery, Computer Innovations*
|
|
Joseph Bibbo, Computrition
|
|
Steve Davies, Concurrent Computer Corporation
|
|
Don Fosbury, Control Data
|
|
George VandeBunte, Control Data*
|
|
Lloyd Irons, Cormorant Communications
|
|
Tom MacDonald, Cray Research
|
|
Lynne Johnson, Cray Research*
|
|
Dave Becker, Cray Research*
|
|
Jean Risley, Custom Development Environments
|
|
Rex Jaeschke, DEC Professional
|
|
Mike Terrazas, DECUS Representative
|
|
Michael Meissner, Data General
|
|
Mark Harris, Data General*
|
|
Leonard Ohmes, Datapoint
|
|
James Stanley, Data Systems Analysts
|
|
Samuel J. Kendall, Delft Consulting
|
|
Randy Meyers, Digital Equipment Corporation
|
|
Art Bjork, Digital Equipment Corporation*
|
|
Lu Anne Van de Pas, Digital Equipment Corporation*
|
|
Ben Patel, EDS
|
|
Richard Relph, EPI
|
|
Graham Andrews, Edinburgh Portable Compilers
|
|
Colin McPhail, Edinburgh Portable Compilers*
|
|
J. Stephen Adamczyk, Edison Design Group
|
|
Eric Schwarz, Edison Design Group*
|
|
Dmitry Lenkov, Everest Solutions
|
|
Frank Farance, Farance Inc.
|
|
Peter Hayes, Farance Inc.*
|
|
Florin Jordan, Floradin
|
|
Philip Provin, General Electric Information Services
|
|
Liz Sanville, Gould CSD
|
|
Tina Aleksa, Gould CSD*
|
|
Thomas Kelly, HCR Corporation
|
|
Paul Jackson, HCR Corporation*
|
|
Gary Jeter, Harris Computer Systems
|
|
Sue Meloy, Hewlett Packard
|
|
Larry Rosler, Hewlett Packard*
|
|
Michelle Ruscetta, Hewlett Packard*
|
|
Thomas E. Osten, Honeywell Information Systems
|
|
David Kayden, Honeywell Information Systems*
|
|
Shawn Elliott, IBM
|
|
Larry Breed, IBM*
|
|
Mel Goldberg, IBM*
|
|
Mike Banahan, Instruction Set
|
|
Clark Nelson, Intel
|
|
Dan Lau, Intel*
|
|
John Wolfe, InterACT
|
|
Lillian Toll, InterACT*
|
|
Randy Hudson, Intermetrics
|
|
Keith Winter, International Computers Ltd.
|
|
Honey M. Schrecker, International Computers Ltd.*
|
|
Jim Brodie, J. Brodie & Associates
|
|
Jacklin Kotikian, Kendall Square Research
|
|
W. Peter Hesse, LSI Logic Europe Ltd.
|
|
John Kaminski, Language Processors Inc.
|
|
David Yost, Laurel Arts
|
|
Mike Branstetter, Lawrence Livermore National Laboratory
|
|
Bob Weaver, Los Alamos National Laboratory
|
|
Lidia Eberhart, Modcomp
|
|
Robert Sherry, Manx Software
|
|
Courtney Meissen, Mark Williams Co.
|
|
Patricia Jenkins, Masscomp
|
|
Dave Hinman, Masscomp*
|
|
Michael Kearns, MetaLink
|
|
Tom Pennello, MetaWare Incorporated
|
|
David F. Weil, Microsoft
|
|
Mitch Harder, Microsoft*
|
|
Kim Kempf, Microware Systems
|
|
Shane McCarron, Minnesota Educational Computing
|
|
Bruce Olsen, Mosaic Technologies
|
|
Michael Paton, Motorola
|
|
Rick Schubert, NCR
|
|
Brian Johnson, NCR*
|
|
Joseph Mueller, National Semiconductor
|
|
Derek Godfrey, National Semiconductor*
|
|
Jim Upperman, National Bureau of Standards
|
|
James W. Williams, Naval Research Laboratory
|
|
Lisa Simon, OCLC
|
|
Paul Amaranth, Oakland University
|
|
August R. Hansen, Omniware
|
|
Michael Rolle, Oracle
|
|
Carl Ellis, Oregon Software
|
|
Barry Hedquist, Perennial
|
|
Sassan Hazeghi, Peritus International
|
|
James Holmlund, Peritus International*
|
|
Thomas Plum, Plum Hall
|
|
Christopher Skelly, Plum Hall*
|
|
Andrew Johnson, Prime Computer
|
|
Fran Litterio, Prime Computer*
|
|
Daniel J. Conrad, Prismatics
|
|
David Fritz, Production Languages
|
|
Kenneth Pugh, Pugh
|
|
Killeen Ed Ramsey, Purdue University
|
|
Stephen Roberts, Purdue University*
|
|
Kevin Nolan, Quantitative Technology Corp.
|
|
Robert Mueller, Quantitative Technology Corp.*
|
|
Chris DeVoney, Que Corporation
|
|
Jon Tulk, Rabbit Software
|
|
Terry Colligan, Rational Systems
|
|
Daniel Saks, Saks & Associates
|
|
Nancy Saks, Saks & Associates*
|
|
Oliver Bradley, SAS Institute
|
|
Alan Beale, SAS Institute*
|
|
Larry Jones, SDRC
|
|
Donald Kossman, SEI Information Technology
|
|
Kenneth Harrenstien, SRI International
|
|
Larry Rosenthal, Sierra Systems
|
|
Phil Hempfner, Southern Bell Telephone
|
|
Purshotam Rajani, Spruce Technology
|
|
Savu Savulescu, Stagg Systems
|
|
Peter Darnell, Stellar Computer
|
|
Lee W. Cooprider, Stellar Computer*
|
|
Paul Gilmartin, Storage Technology Corp.
|
|
Steve Muchnick, Sun Microsystems
|
|
Chuck Rasbold, Supercomputer Systems, Inc.
|
|
Kelly O'Hair, Supercomputer Systems, Inc.*
|
|
Henry Richardson, Tandem
|
|
John M. Hausman, Tandem*
|
|
Samuel Harbison, Tartan Laboratories
|
|
Michael S. Ball, TauMetric
|
|
Carl Sutton, Tektronix
|
|
Jim Besemer, Tektronix*
|
|
Reid Tatge, Texas Instruments
|
|
Ed Brower, Tokheim
|
|
Robert Mansfield, Tokheim*
|
|
Monika Khushf, Tymlabs
|
|
Morgan Jones, Tymlabs*
|
|
Don Bixler, Unisys
|
|
Steve Bartels, Unisys*
|
|
Glenda Berkheimer, Unisys*
|
|
Annice Jackson, Unisys*
|
|
Fred Blonder, University of Maryland
|
|
Fred Schwarz, University of Michigan
|
|
R. Jordan Kreindler, University of Southern California CTC
|
|
Mike Carmody, University of Waterloo
|
|
Douglas Gwyn, US Army BRL (IEEE P1003 liaison)
|
|
C. Dale Pierce, US Army Management Engineering*
|
|
John C. Black, VideoFinancial
|
|
Joseph Musacchia, Wang Labs
|
|
Fred Rozakis, Wang Labs*
|
|
P. J. Plauger, Whitesmiths, Ltd.
|
|
Kim Leeper, Wick Hill
|
|
Mark Wittenberg, Zehntel
|
|
Jim Balter
|
|
Robert Bradbury
|
|
Edward Chin
|
|
Neil Daniels
|
|
Stephen Desofi
|
|
Michael Duffy
|
|
Phillip Escue
|
|
Ralph Phraner
|
|
D. Hugh Redelmeier
|
|
Arnold Davi
|
|
Robbins Roger
|
|
Wilks Michael
|
|
J. Young
|
|
|
|
|
|
purpose: 1.1
|
|
scope: 1.2
|
|
references: 1.3
|
|
organization of the document: 1.4
|
|
base documents: 1.5
|
|
definitions of terms: 1.6
|
|
compliance: 1.7
|
|
translation environment: 2.
|
|
execution environment: 2.
|
|
separate compilation: 2.1.1.1
|
|
separate translation: 2.1.1.1
|
|
source file: 2.1.1.1
|
|
translation unit: 2.1.1.1
|
|
program execution: 2.1.2.3
|
|
side effects: 2.1.2.3
|
|
sequence point: 2.1.2.3
|
|
character set: 2.2.1
|
|
signals: 2.2.3
|
|
interrupts: 2.2.3
|
|
syntax notation: 3.
|
|
lexical elements: 3.1
|
|
comment: 3.1
|
|
white space: 3.1
|
|
list of keywords: 3.1.1
|
|
reserved words: 3.1.1
|
|
underscore character: 3.1.2
|
|
enumeration constant: 3.1.2
|
|
length of names: 3.1.2
|
|
internal name, length of: 3.1.2
|
|
external name, length of: 3.1.2
|
|
function name, length of: 3.1.2
|
|
scopes: 3.1.2.1
|
|
prototype, function: 3.1.2.1
|
|
function scope: 3.1.2.1
|
|
file scope: 3.1.2.1
|
|
block scope: 3.1.2.1
|
|
block structure: 3.1.2.1
|
|
function prototype scope: 3.1.2.1
|
|
linkage: 3.1.2.2
|
|
external linkage: 3.1.2.2
|
|
internal linkage: 3.1.2.2
|
|
no linkage: 3.1.2.2
|
|
name spaces: 3.1.2.3
|
|
named label: 3.1.2.3
|
|
structure tag: 3.1.2.3
|
|
union tag: 3.1.2.3
|
|
enumeration tag: 3.1.2.3
|
|
structure member name: 3.1.2.3
|
|
union member name: 3.1.2.3
|
|
storage duration: 3.1.2.4
|
|
static storage duration: 3.1.2.4
|
|
automatic storage duration: 3.1.2.4
|
|
types: 3.1.2.5
|
|
object types: 3.1.2.5
|
|
function types: 3.1.2.5
|
|
incomplete types: 3.1.2.5
|
|
char type: 3.1.2.5
|
|
signed character: 3.1.2.5
|
|
signed char type: 3.1.2.5
|
|
short type: 3.1.2.5
|
|
long type: 3.1.2.5
|
|
unsigned type: 3.1.2.5
|
|
float type: 3.1.2.5
|
|
double type: 3.1.2.5
|
|
long double type: 3.1.2.5
|
|
basic types: 3.1.2.5
|
|
character types: 3.1.2.5
|
|
enumerated type: 3.1.2.5
|
|
void type: 3.1.2.5
|
|
derived types: 3.1.2.5
|
|
integral types: 3.1.2.5
|
|
arithmetic types: 3.1.2.5
|
|
scalar types: 3.1.2.5
|
|
aggregate types: 3.1.2.5
|
|
constants: 3.1.3
|
|
floating constant: 3.1.3.1
|
|
double constant: 3.1.3.1
|
|
integer constant: 3.1.3.2
|
|
decimal constant: 3.1.3.2
|
|
octal constant: 3.1.3.2
|
|
hexadecimal constant: 3.1.3.2
|
|
unsigned constant: 3.1.3.2
|
|
long constant: 3.1.3.2
|
|
enumeration constant: 3.1.3.3
|
|
character constant: 3.1.3.4
|
|
backslash character: 3.1.3.4
|
|
escape character: 3.1.3.4
|
|
escape sequence: 3.1.3.4
|
|
string literal: 3.1.4
|
|
character string: 3.1.4
|
|
operator: 3.1.5
|
|
evaluation: 3.1.5
|
|
operand: 3.1.5
|
|
punctuator: 3.1.6
|
|
character-integer conversion: 3.2.1.1
|
|
integer-character conversion: 3.2.1.1
|
|
integral promotions: 3.2.1.1
|
|
integer-long conversion: 3.2.1.1
|
|
signed character: 3.2.1.1
|
|
unsigned-integer conversion: 3.2.1.2
|
|
integer-unsigned conversion: 3.2.1.2
|
|
long-unsigned conversion: 3.2.1.2
|
|
long-integer conversion: 3.2.1.2
|
|
floating-integer conversion: 3.2.1.3
|
|
integer-floating conversion: 3.2.1.3
|
|
float-double conversion: 3.2.1.4
|
|
double-float conversion: 3.2.1.4
|
|
arithmetic conversions: 3.2.1.5
|
|
type conversion rules: 3.2.1.5
|
|
lvalue: 3.2.2.1
|
|
function designator: 3.2.2.1
|
|
conversion of array: 3.2.2.1
|
|
conversion of function name: 3.2.2.1
|
|
void type: 3.2.2.2
|
|
pointer-pointer conversion: 3.2.2.3
|
|
integer-pointer conversion: 3.2.2.3
|
|
null pointer: 3.2.2.3
|
|
expression: 3.3
|
|
precedence of operators: 3.3
|
|
associativity of operators: 3.3
|
|
order of evaluation of expressions: 3.3
|
|
order of evaluation: 3.3
|
|
bitwise operators: 3.3
|
|
exceptions: 3.3
|
|
primary expression: 3.3.1
|
|
type of string: 3.3.1
|
|
parenthesized expression: 3.3.1
|
|
subscript operator: 3.3.2
|
|
function call: 3.3.2
|
|
structure member operator: 3.3.2
|
|
structure pointer operator: 3.3.2
|
|
++ increment operator: 3.3.2
|
|
-- decrement operator: 3.3.2
|
|
array, explanation of subscripting: 3.3.2.1
|
|
subscripting, explanation of: 3.3.2.1
|
|
multi-dimensional array: 3.3.2.1
|
|
storage order of array: 3.3.2.1
|
|
function call: 3.3.2.2
|
|
implicit declaration of function: 3.3.2.2
|
|
function argument: 3.3.2.2
|
|
call by value: 3.3.2.2
|
|
recursion: 3.3.2.2
|
|
structure reference: 3.3.2.3
|
|
union reference: 3.3.2.3
|
|
common initial sequence: 3.3.2.3
|
|
postfix ++ and --: 3.3.2.4
|
|
-- decrement operator: 3.3.2.4
|
|
unary expression: 3.3.3
|
|
++ increment operator: 3.3.3
|
|
-- decrement operator: 3.3.3
|
|
sizeof operator: 3.3.3
|
|
& address operator: 3.3.3
|
|
* indirection operator: 3.3.3
|
|
+ unary plus operator: 3.3.3
|
|
- unary minus operator: 3.3.3
|
|
~ bitwise complement operator: 3.3.3
|
|
! logical negation operator: 3.3.3
|
|
++ increment operator: 3.3.3.1
|
|
prefix ++ and --: 3.3.3.1
|
|
-- decrement operator: 3.3.3.1
|
|
+ unary plus operator: 3.3.3.3
|
|
- unary minus operator: 3.3.3.3
|
|
~ bitwise complement operator: 3.3.3.3
|
|
! logical negation operator: 3.3.3.3
|
|
byte: 3.3.3.4
|
|
storage allocator: 3.3.3.4
|
|
cast expression: 3.3.4
|
|
cast operator: 3.3.4
|
|
explicit conversion operator: 3.3.4
|
|
cast operator: 3.3.4
|
|
pointer conversion: 3.3.4
|
|
explicit conversion operator: 3.3.4
|
|
pointer-integer conversion: 3.3.4
|
|
integer-pointer conversion: 3.3.4
|
|
alignment restriction: 3.3.4
|
|
arithmetic operators: 3.3.5
|
|
multiplicative operators: 3.3.5
|
|
* multiplication operator: 3.3.5
|
|
/ division operator: 3.3.5
|
|
% modulus operator: 3.3.5
|
|
additive operators: 3.3.6
|
|
+ addition operator: 3.3.6
|
|
- subtraction operator: 3.3.6
|
|
pointer arithmetic: 3.3.6
|
|
pointer arithmetic: 3.3.6
|
|
shift operators: 3.3.7
|
|
<< left shift operator: 3.3.7
|
|
>> right shift operator: 3.3.7
|
|
relational operators: 3.3.8
|
|
< less than operator: 3.3.8
|
|
> greater than operator: 3.3.8
|
|
<= less than or equal to operator: 3.3.8
|
|
>= greater than or equal to operator: 3.3.8
|
|
pointer comparison: 3.3.8
|
|
equality operators: 3.3.9
|
|
== equality operator: 3.3.9
|
|
!= inequality operator: 3.3.9
|
|
& bitwise AND operator: 3.3.10
|
|
^ bitwise exclusive OR operator: 3.3.11
|
|
| bitwise inclusive OR operator: 3.3.12
|
|
&& logical AND operator: 3.3.13
|
|
|| logical OR operator: 3.3.14
|
|
?: conditional expression: 3.3.15
|
|
assignment operators: 3.3.16
|
|
assignment expression: 3.3.16
|
|
simple assignment: 3.3.16.1
|
|
conversion by assignment: 3.3.16.1
|
|
compound assignment: 3.3.16.2
|
|
comma operator: 3.3.17
|
|
constant expression: 3.4
|
|
permitted form of initializer: 3.4
|
|
declarations: 3.5
|
|
storage-class specifier: 3.5.1
|
|
storage-class declaration: 3.5.1
|
|
typedef declaration: 3.5.1
|
|
extern storage class: 3.5.1
|
|
static storage class: 3.5.1
|
|
auto storage class: 3.5.1
|
|
register storage class: 3.5.1
|
|
type specifier: 3.5.2
|
|
void type: 3.5.2
|
|
char type: 3.5.2
|
|
short type: 3.5.2
|
|
int type: 3.5.2
|
|
long type: 3.5.2
|
|
float type: 3.5.2
|
|
double type: 3.5.2
|
|
signed type: 3.5.2
|
|
unsigned type: 3.5.2
|
|
structure declaration: 3.5.2.1
|
|
union declaration: 3.5.2.1
|
|
bit-field declaration: 3.5.2.1
|
|
bit-field: 3.5.2.1
|
|
member alignment: 3.5.2.1
|
|
enumeration: 3.5.2.2
|
|
enum-specifier: 3.5.2.2
|
|
enumerator: 3.5.2.2
|
|
structure tag: 3.5.2.3
|
|
union tag: 3.5.2.3
|
|
structure content: 3.5.2.3
|
|
union content: 3.5.2.3
|
|
enumeration content: 3.5.2.3
|
|
self-referential structure: 3.5.2.3
|
|
type qualifier: 3.5.3
|
|
const type qualifier: 3.5.3
|
|
volatile type qualifier: 3.5.3
|
|
declarator: 3.5.4
|
|
type declaration: 3.5.4
|
|
declaration of pointer: 3.5.4.1
|
|
array declaration: 3.5.4.2
|
|
declaration of function: 3.5.4.3
|
|
type names: 3.5.5
|
|
abstract declarator: 3.5.5
|
|
typedef declaration: 3.5.6
|
|
initialization: 3.5.7
|
|
initialization of statics: 3.5.7
|
|
implicit initialization: 3.5.7
|
|
default initialization: 3.5.7
|
|
initialization of automatics: 3.5.7
|
|
aggregate initialization: 3.5.7
|
|
array initialization: 3.5.7
|
|
structure initialization: 3.5.7
|
|
character array initialization: 3.5.7
|
|
wchar_t array initialization: 3.5.7
|
|
statements: 3.6
|
|
sequencing of statements: 3.6
|
|
full expression: 3.6
|
|
labeled statement: 3.6.1
|
|
named label: 3.6.1
|
|
case label: 3.6.1
|
|
default label: 3.6.1
|
|
compound statement: 3.6.2
|
|
block: 3.6.2
|
|
block structure: 3.6.2
|
|
initialization in blocks: 3.6.2
|
|
expression statement: 3.6.3
|
|
null statement: 3.6.3
|
|
empty statement: 3.6.3
|
|
if-else statement: 3.6.4.1
|
|
switch statement: 3.6.4.2
|
|
switch body: 3.6.4.2
|
|
loop body: 3.6.5
|
|
while statement: 3.6.5.1
|
|
do statement: 3.6.5.2
|
|
for statement: 3.6.5.3
|
|
goto statement: 3.6.6.1
|
|
continue statement: 3.6.6.2
|
|
break statement: 3.6.6.3
|
|
return statement: 3.6.6.4
|
|
type conversion by return: 3.6.6.4
|
|
conversion by return: 3.6.6.4
|
|
external definition: 3.7
|
|
function definition: 3.7.1
|
|
parameter: 3.7.1
|
|
array argument: 3.7.1
|
|
function name argument: 3.7.1
|
|
pointer to function: 3.7.1
|
|
object definitions: 3.7.2
|
|
scope of externals: 3.7.2
|
|
tentative definition: 3.7.2
|
|
preprocessing directives: 3.8
|
|
macro preprocessor: 3.8
|
|
preprocessing directive lines: 3.8
|
|
conditional inclusion: 3.8.1
|
|
#if: 3.8.1
|
|
#elif 3.8.1
|
|
#ifdef: 3.8.1
|
|
#ifndef: 3.8.1
|
|
#else: 3.8.1
|
|
#endif: 3.8.1
|
|
#include: 3.8.2
|
|
source file inclusion: 3.8.2
|
|
macro replacement: 3.8.3
|
|
object-like macro: 3.8.3
|
|
function-like macro: 3.8.3
|
|
macro name: 3.8.3
|
|
#define: 3.8.3
|
|
macro parameters: 3.8.3
|
|
macro invocation: 3.8.3
|
|
argument substitution: 3.8.3.1
|
|
# operator: 3.8.3.2
|
|
## operator: 3.8.3.3
|
|
rescanning and replacement: 3.8.3.4
|
|
macro definition scope: 3.8.3.5
|
|
#undef: 3.8.3.5
|
|
#line: 3.8.4
|
|
error directive: 3.8.5
|
|
pragma directive: 3.8.6
|
|
null directive: 3.8.7
|
|
introduction: 4.1
|
|
string definition: 4.1.1
|
|
letter definition: 4.1.1
|
|
decimal-point definition: 4.1.1
|
|
reserved identifier: 4.1.2
|
|
printing character: 4.3
|
|
control character: 4.3
|
|
variable arguments: 4.8
|
|
unbuffered stream: 4.9.3
|
|
fully buffered stream: 4.9.3
|
|
line buffered stream: 4.9.3
|
|
appendices: A.
|
|
language syntax summary: A.1
|
|
sequence points: A.2
|
|
library summary: A.3
|
|
implementation limits: A.4
|
|
warnings: A.5
|
|
portability: A.6
|
|
order of evaluation: A.6.1
|
|
machine dependency: A.6.3
|
|
restrictions on registers: A.6.3.7
|
|
function pointer casts: A.6.5.7
|
|
bit-field types: A.6.5.8
|
|
fortran keyword: A.6.5.9
|
|
asm keyword: A.6.5.10
|
|
multiple external definitions: A.6.5.11
|
|
empty macro arguments: A.6.5.12
|
|
predefined macro names: A.6.5.13
|
|
signal handler arguments: A.6.5.14
|
|
stream types: A.6.5.15
|
|
file-opening modes: A.6.5.15
|
|
file position indicator: A.6.5.16
|
|
foreword: A.7
|
|
|
|
|
|
1. INTRODUCTION
|
|
|
|
1.1 PURPOSE
|
|
|
|
This Standard specifies the form and establishes the interpretation
|
|
of programs written in the C programming language./1/
|
|
|
|
1.2 SCOPE
|
|
|
|
This Standard specifies:
|
|
|
|
* the representation of C programs;
|
|
|
|
* the syntax and constraints of the C language;
|
|
|
|
* the semantic rules for interpreting C programs;
|
|
|
|
* the representation of input data to be processed by C programs;
|
|
|
|
* the representation of output data produced by C programs;
|
|
|
|
* the restrictions and limits imposed by a conforming implementation of C.
|
|
|
|
|
|
This Standard does not specify:
|
|
|
|
* the mechanism by which C programs are transformed for use by a
|
|
data-processing system;
|
|
|
|
* the mechanism by which C programs are invoked for use by a
|
|
data-processing system;
|
|
|
|
* the mechanism by which input data are transformed for use by a C program;
|
|
|
|
* the mechanism by which output data are transformed after being
|
|
produced by a C program;
|
|
|
|
* the size or complexity of a program and its data that will exceed
|
|
the capacity of any specific data-processing system or the capacity of
|
|
a particular processor;
|
|
|
|
* all minimal requirements of a data-processing system that is
|
|
capable of supporting a conforming implementation.
|
|
|
|
|
|
1.3 REFERENCES
|
|
|
|
1. ``The C Reference Manual'' by Dennis M. Ritchie, a version of
|
|
which was published in The C Programming Language by Brian
|
|
W. Kernighan and Dennis M. Ritchie, Prentice-Hall, Inc., (1978).
|
|
Copyright owned by AT&T.
|
|
|
|
2. 1984 /usr/group Standard by the /usr/group Standards Committee,
|
|
Santa Clara, California, USA (November, 1984).
|
|
|
|
3. American National Dictionary for Information Processing Systems,
|
|
Information Processing Systems Technical Report ANSI X3/TR-1-82 (1982).
|
|
|
|
4. ISO 646-1983 Invariant Code Set.
|
|
|
|
5. IEEE Standard for Binary Floating-Point Arithmetic (ANSI/IEEE Std 754-1985).
|
|
|
|
6. ISO 4217 Codes for the Representation of Currency and Funds.
|
|
|
|
|
|
1.4 ORGANIZATION OF THE DOCUMENT
|
|
|
|
This document is divided into four major sections:
|
|
|
|
1. this introduction;
|
|
|
|
2. the characteristics of environments that translate and execute C programs;
|
|
|
|
3. the language syntax, constraints, and semantics;
|
|
|
|
4. the library facilities.
|
|
|
|
Examples are provided to illustrate possible forms of the
|
|
constructions described. Footnotes are provided to emphasize
|
|
consequences of the rules described in the section or elsewhere in the
|
|
Standard. References are used to refer to other related sections. A
|
|
set of appendices summarizes information contained in the Standard.
|
|
The abstract, the foreword, the examples, the footnotes, the
|
|
references, and the appendices are not part of the Standard.
|
|
|
|
1.5 BASE DOCUMENTS
|
|
|
|
The language section ($3) is derived from ``The C Reference
|
|
Manual'' by Dennis M. Ritchie, a version of which was published as
|
|
Appendix A of The C Programming Language by Brian W. Kernighan and
|
|
Dennis M. Ritchie, Prentice-Hall, Inc., 1978; copyright owned by AT&T.
|
|
|
|
The library section ($4) is based on the 1984 /usr/group Standard by
|
|
the /usr/group Standards Committee, Santa Clara, California, USA
|
|
(November 14, 1984).
|
|
|
|
1.6 DEFINITIONS OF TERMS
|
|
|
|
In this Standard, ``shall'' is to be interpreted as a requirement
|
|
on an implementation or on a program; conversely, ``shall not'' is to
|
|
be interpreted as a prohibition.
|
|
|
|
The following terms are used in this document:
|
|
|
|
* Implementation --- a particular set of software, running in a
|
|
particular translation environment under particular control options,
|
|
that performs translation of programs for, and supports execution of
|
|
functions in, a particular execution environment.
|
|
|
|
* Bit --- the unit of data storage in the execution environment large
|
|
enough to hold an object that may have one of two values. It need not
|
|
be possible to express the address of each individual bit of an
|
|
object.
|
|
|
|
* Byte --- the unit of data storage in the execution environment
|
|
large enough to hold any member of the basic character set of the
|
|
execution environment. It shall be possible to express the address of
|
|
each individual byte of an object uniquely. A byte is composed of a
|
|
contiguous sequence of bits, the number of which is
|
|
implementation-defined. The least significant bit is called the
|
|
low-order bit; the most significant bit is called the high-order bit.
|
|
|
|
* Object --- a region of data storage in the execution environment,
|
|
the contents of which can represent values. Except for bit-fields,
|
|
objects are composed of contiguous sequences of one or more bytes, the
|
|
number, order, and encoding of which are either explicitly specified
|
|
or implementation-defined.
|
|
|
|
* Character --- a single byte representing a member of the basic
|
|
character set of either the source or the execution environment.
|
|
|
|
* Multibyte character --- a sequence of one or more bytes
|
|
representing a member of the extended character set of either the
|
|
source or the execution environment. The extended character set is a
|
|
superset of the basic character set.
|
|
|
|
* Alignment --- a requirement that objects of a particular type be
|
|
located on storage boundaries with addresses that are particular
|
|
multiples of a byte address.
|
|
|
|
* Argument --- an expression in the comma-separated list bounded by
|
|
the parentheses in a function call expression, or a sequence of
|
|
preprocessing tokens in the comma-separated list bounded by the
|
|
parentheses in a function-like macro invocation. Also known as
|
|
``actual argument'' or ``actual parameter.''
|
|
|
|
* Parameter --- an object declared as part of a function declaration
|
|
or definition that acquires a value on entry to the function, or an
|
|
identifier from the comma-separated list bounded by the parentheses
|
|
immediately following the macro name in a function-like macro
|
|
definition. Also known as ``formal argument'' or ``formal
|
|
parameter.''
|
|
|
|
* Unspecified behavior --- behavior, for a correct program construct
|
|
and correct data, for which the Standard imposes no requirements.
|
|
|
|
* Undefined behavior --- behavior, upon use of a nonportable or
|
|
erroneous program construct, of erroneous data, or of
|
|
indeterminately-valued objects, for which the Standard imposes no
|
|
requirements. Permissible undefined behavior ranges from ignoring the
|
|
situation completely with unpredictable results, to behaving during
|
|
translation or program execution in a documented manner characteristic
|
|
of the environment (with or without the issuance of a diagnostic
|
|
message), to terminating a translation or execution (with the issuance
|
|
of a diagnostic message).
|
|
|
|
If a ``shall'' or ``shall not'' requirement that appears outside of
|
|
a constraint is violated, the behavior is undefined. Undefined
|
|
behavior is otherwise indicated in this Standard by the words
|
|
``undefined behavior'' or by the omission of any explicit definition
|
|
of behavior. There is no difference in emphasis among these three;
|
|
they all describe ``behavior that is undefined.''
|
|
|
|
* Implementation-defined behavior --- behavior, for a correct program
|
|
construct and correct data, that depends on the characteristics of the
|
|
implementation and that each implementation shall document.
|
|
|
|
* Locale-specific behavior --- behavior that depends on local
|
|
conventions of nationality, culture, and language that each
|
|
implementation shall document.
|
|
|
|
* Diagnostic message --- a message belonging to an
|
|
implementation-defined subset of the implementation's message output.
|
|
|
|
* Constraints --- syntactic and semantic restrictions by which the
|
|
exposition of language elements is to be interpreted.
|
|
|
|
* Implementation limits --- restrictions imposed upon programs by the
|
|
implementation.
|
|
|
|
* Forward references --- references to later sections of the Standard
|
|
that contain additional information relevant to this section.
|
|
|
|
Other terms are defined at their first appearance, indicated by italic
|
|
type. Terms explicitly defined in this Standard are not to be
|
|
presumed to refer implicitly to similar terms defined elsewhere.
|
|
|
|
Terms not defined in this Standard are to be interpreted according to
|
|
the American National Dictionary for Information Processing Systems,
|
|
Information Processing Systems Technical Report ANSI X3/TR-1-82 (1982).
|
|
|
|
Forward references: localization ($4.4).
|
|
|
|
"Examples"
|
|
|
|
An example of unspecified behavior is the order in which the
|
|
arguments to a function are evaluated.
|
|
|
|
An example of undefined behavior is the behavior on integer overflow.
|
|
|
|
An example of implementation-defined behavior is the propagation of
|
|
the high-order bit when a signed integer is shifted right.
|
|
|
|
An example of locale-specific behavior is whether the islower
|
|
function returns true for characters other than the 26 lower-case
|
|
English letters.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: bitwise shift operators ($3.3.7), expressions
|
|
($3.3), function calls ($3.3.2.2), the islower function ($4.3.1.6).
|
|
|
|
|
|
1.7 COMPLIANCE
|
|
|
|
A strictly conforming program shall use only those features of the
|
|
language and library specified in this Standard. It shall not produce
|
|
output dependent on any unspecified, undefined, or
|
|
implementation-defined behavior, and shall not exceed any minimum
|
|
implementation limit.
|
|
|
|
The two forms of conforming implementation are hosted and
|
|
freestanding. A conforming hosted implementation shall accept any
|
|
strictly conforming program. A conforming freestanding implementation
|
|
shall accept any strictly conforming program in which the use of the
|
|
features specified in the library section ($4) is confined to the
|
|
contents of the standard headers <float.h> , <limits.h> , <stdarg.h> ,
|
|
and <stddef.h> . A conforming implementation may have extensions
|
|
(including additional library functions), provided they do not alter
|
|
the behavior of any strictly conforming program.
|
|
|
|
A conforming program is one that is acceptable to a conforming
|
|
implementation./2/
|
|
|
|
An implementation shall be accompanied by a document that defines
|
|
all implementation-defined characteristics and all extensions.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: limits <float.h> and <limits.h> ($4.1.4), variable
|
|
arguments <stdarg.h> ($4.8), common definitions <stddef.h> ($4.1.5).
|
|
|
|
|
|
1.8 FUTURE DIRECTIONS
|
|
|
|
With the introduction of new devices and extended character sets,
|
|
new features may be added to the Standard. Subsections in the
|
|
language and library sections warn implementors and programmers of
|
|
usages which, though valid in themselves, may conflict with future
|
|
additions.
|
|
|
|
Certain features are obsolescent , which means that they may be
|
|
considered for withdrawal in future revisions of the Standard. They
|
|
are retained in the Standard because of their widespread use, but
|
|
their use in new implementations (for implementation features) or new
|
|
programs (for language or library features) is discouraged.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: future language directions ($3.9.9), future
|
|
library directions ($4.13).
|
|
|
|
1.9 ABOUT THIS DRAFT
|
|
|
|
Symbols in the right margin mark substantive differences between
|
|
this draft and its predecessor (ANSI X3J11/88-001, January 11, 1988).
|
|
A plus sign indicates an addition, a minus sign a deletion, and a
|
|
vertical bar a replacement.
|
|
|
|
This section and the difference marks themselves will not appear in
|
|
the published document.
|
|
|
|
|
|
2. ENVIRONMENT
|
|
|
|
An implementation translates C source files and executes C programs
|
|
in two data-processing-system environments, which will be called the
|
|
translation environment and the execution environment in this
|
|
Standard. Their characteristics define and constrain the results of
|
|
executing conforming C programs constructed according to the syntactic
|
|
and semantic rules for conforming implementations.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: In the environment section ($2), only a few of
|
|
many possible forward references have been noted.
|
|
|
|
|
|
2.1 CONCEPTUAL MODELS
|
|
|
|
2.1.1 Translation environment
|
|
|
|
2.1.1.1 Program structure
|
|
|
|
A C program need not all be translated at the same time. The text
|
|
of the program is kept in units called source files in this Standard.
|
|
A source file together with all the headers and source files included
|
|
via the preprocessing directive #include , less any source lines
|
|
skipped by any of the conditional inclusion preprocessing directives,
|
|
is called a translation unit. Previously translated translation units
|
|
may be preserved individually or in libraries. The separate
|
|
translation units of a program communicate by (for example) calls to
|
|
functions whose identifiers have external linkage, by manipulation of
|
|
objects whose identifiers have external linkage, and by manipulation
|
|
of data files. Translation units may be separately translated and
|
|
then later linked to produce an executable program.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: conditional inclusion ($3.8.1), linkages of
|
|
identifiers ($3.1.2.2), source file inclusion ($3.8.2).
|
|
|
|
2.1.1.2 Translation phases
|
|
|
|
The precedence among the syntax rules of translation is specified
|
|
by the following phases./3/
|
|
|
|
1. Physical source file characters are mapped to the source character
|
|
set (introducing new-line characters for end-of-line indicators) if
|
|
necessary. Trigraph sequences are replaced by corresponding
|
|
single-character internal representations.
|
|
|
|
2. Each instance of a new-line character and an immediately preceding
|
|
backslash character is deleted, splicing physical source lines to form
|
|
logical source lines. A source file that is not empty shall end in a
|
|
new-line character, which shall not be immediately preceded by a
|
|
backslash character.
|
|
|
|
3. The source file is decomposed into preprocessing tokens/4/ and
|
|
sequences of white-space characters (including comments). A source
|
|
file shall not end in a partial preprocessing token or comment. Each
|
|
comment is replaced by one space character. New-line characters are
|
|
retained. Whether each nonempty sequence of other white-space
|
|
characters is retained or replaced by one space character is
|
|
implementation-defined.
|
|
|
|
4. Preprocessing directives are executed and macro invocations are
|
|
expanded. A #include preprocessing directive causes the named header
|
|
or source file to be processed from phase 1 through phase 4,
|
|
recursively.
|
|
|
|
5. Each escape sequence in character constants and string literals is
|
|
converted to a member of the execution character set.
|
|
|
|
6. Adjacent character string literal tokens are concatenated and
|
|
adjacent wide string literal tokens are concatenated.
|
|
|
|
7. White-space characters separating tokens are no longer
|
|
significant. Preprocessing tokens are converted into tokens. The
|
|
resulting tokens are syntactically and semantically analyzed and
|
|
translated.
|
|
|
|
8. All external object and function references are resolved. Library
|
|
components are linked to satisfy external references to functions and
|
|
objects not defined in the current translation. All such translator
|
|
output is collected into a program image which contains information
|
|
needed for execution in its execution environment.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: lexical elements ($3.1), preprocessing directives
|
|
($3.8), trigraph sequences ($2.2.1.1).
|
|
|
|
2.1.1.3 Diagnostics
|
|
|
|
A conforming implementation shall produce at least one diagnostic
|
|
message (identified in an implementation-defined manner) for every
|
|
translation unit that contains a violation of any syntax rule or
|
|
constraint. Diagnostic messages need not be produced in other
|
|
circumstances.
|
|
|
|
2.1.2 Execution environments
|
|
|
|
Two execution environments are defined: freestanding and hosted.
|
|
In both cases, program startup occurs when a designated C function
|
|
is called by the execution environment. All objects in static storage
|
|
shall be initialized (set to their initial values) before program
|
|
startup. The manner and timing of such initialization are otherwise
|
|
unspecified. Program termination returns control to the execution
|
|
environment.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: initialization ($3.5.7).
|
|
|
|
2.1.2.1 Freestanding environment
|
|
|
|
In a freestanding environment (in which C program execution may
|
|
take place without any benefit of an operating system), the name and
|
|
type of the function called at program startup are
|
|
implementation-defined. There are otherwise no reserved external
|
|
identifiers. Any library facilities available to a freestanding
|
|
program are implementation-defined.
|
|
|
|
The effect of program termination in a freestanding environment is
|
|
implementation-defined.
|
|
|
|
2.1.2.2 Hosted environment
|
|
|
|
A hosted environment need not be provided, but shall conform to the
|
|
following specifications if present.
|
|
|
|
"Program startup"
|
|
|
|
The function called at program startup is named main . The
|
|
implementation declares no prototype for this function. It can be
|
|
defined with no parameters:
|
|
|
|
int main(void) { /*...*/ }
|
|
|
|
or with two parameters (referred to here as argc and argv , though any
|
|
names may be used, as they are local to the function in which they are
|
|
declared):
|
|
|
|
int main(int argc, char *argv[]) { /*...*/ }
|
|
|
|
|
|
If they are defined, the parameters to the main function shall obey
|
|
the following constraints:
|
|
|
|
* The value of argc shall be nonnegative.
|
|
|
|
* argv[argc] shall be a null pointer.
|
|
|
|
* If the value of argc is greater than zero, the array members
|
|
argv[0] through argv[argc-1] inclusive shall contain pointers to
|
|
strings, which are given implementation-defined values by the host
|
|
environment prior to program startup. The intent is to supply to the
|
|
program information determined prior to program startup from elsewhere
|
|
in the hosted environment. If the host environment is not capable of
|
|
supplying strings with letters in both upper-case and lower-case, the
|
|
implementation shall ensure that the strings are received in
|
|
lower-case.
|
|
|
|
* If the value of argc is greater than zero, the string pointed to by
|
|
argv[0] represents the program name ;argv[0][0] shall be the null
|
|
character if the program name is not available from the host
|
|
environment. If the value of argc is greater than one, the strings
|
|
pointed to by argv[1] through argv[argc-1] represent the program
|
|
parameters .
|
|
|
|
* The parameters argc and argv and the strings pointed to by the argv
|
|
array shall be modifiable by the program, and retain their last-stored
|
|
values between program startup and program termination.
|
|
|
|
"Program execution"
|
|
|
|
In a hosted environment, a program may use all the functions,
|
|
macros, type definitions, and objects described in the library section ($4).
|
|
|
|
"Program termination"
|
|
|
|
A return from the initial call to the main function is equivalent
|
|
to calling the exit function with the value returned by the main
|
|
function as its argument. If the main function executes a return that
|
|
specifies no value, the termination status returned to the host
|
|
environment is undefined.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: definition of terms ($4.1.1), the exit function
|
|
($4.10.4.3).
|
|
|
|
|
|
2.1.2.3 Program execution
|
|
|
|
The semantic descriptions in this Standard describe the behavior of
|
|
an abstract machine in which issues of optimization are irrelevant.
|
|
|
|
Accessing a volatile object, modifying an object, modifying a file,
|
|
or calling a function that does any of those operations are all side
|
|
effects ,which are changes in the state of the execution environment.
|
|
Evaluation of an expression may produce side effects. At certain
|
|
specified points in the execution sequence called sequence points, all
|
|
side effects of previous evaluations shall be complete and no side
|
|
effects of subsequent evaluations shall have taken place.
|
|
|
|
In the abstract machine, all expressions are evaluated as specified
|
|
by the semantics. An actual implementation need not evaluate part of
|
|
an expression if it can deduce that its value is not used and that no
|
|
needed side effects are produced (including any caused by calling a
|
|
function or accessing a volatile object).
|
|
|
|
When the processing of the abstract machine is interrupted by
|
|
receipt of a signal, only the values of objects as of the previous
|
|
sequence point may be relied on. Objects that may be modified between
|
|
the previous sequence point and the next sequence point need not have
|
|
received their correct values yet.
|
|
|
|
An instance of each object with automatic storage duration is
|
|
associated with each entry into a block. Such an object exists and
|
|
retains its last-stored value during the execution of the block and
|
|
while the block is suspended (by a call of a function or receipt of a
|
|
signal).
|
|
|
|
The least requirements on a conforming implementation are:
|
|
|
|
* At sequence points, volatile objects are stable in the sense that
|
|
previous evaluations are complete and subsequent evaluations have not
|
|
yet occurred.
|
|
|
|
* At program termination, all data written into files shall be
|
|
identical to the result that execution of the program according to the
|
|
abstract semantics would have produced.
|
|
|
|
* The input and output dynamics of interactive devices shall take
|
|
place as specified in $4.9.3. The intent of these requirements is
|
|
that unbuffered or line-buffered output appear as soon as possible, to
|
|
ensure that prompting messages actually appear prior to a program
|
|
waiting for input.
|
|
|
|
What constitutes an interactive device is implementation-defined.
|
|
|
|
More stringent correspondences between abstract and actual
|
|
semantics may be defined by each implementation.
|
|
|
|
"Examples"
|
|
|
|
An implementation might define a one-to-one correspondence between
|
|
abstract and actual semantics: at every sequence point, the values of
|
|
the actual objects would agree with those specified by the abstract
|
|
semantics. The keyword volatile would then be redundant.
|
|
|
|
Alternatively, an implementation might perform various
|
|
optimizations within each translation unit, such that the actual
|
|
semantics would agree with the abstract semantics only when making
|
|
function calls across translation unit boundaries. In such an
|
|
implementation, at the time of each function entry and function return
|
|
where the calling function and the called function are in different
|
|
translation units, the values of all externally linked objects and of
|
|
all objects accessible via pointers therein would agree with the
|
|
abstract semantics. Furthermore, at the time of each such function
|
|
entry the values of the parameters of the called function and of all
|
|
objects accessible via pointers therein would agree with the abstract
|
|
semantics. In this type of implementation, objects referred to by
|
|
interrupt service routines activated by the signal function would
|
|
require explicit specification of volatile storage, as well as other
|
|
implementation-defined restrictions.
|
|
|
|
In executing the fragment
|
|
|
|
char c1, c2;
|
|
/*...*/
|
|
c1 = c1 + c2;
|
|
|
|
the ``integral promotions'' require that the abstract machine promote
|
|
the value of each variable to int size and then add the two int s and
|
|
truncate the sum. Provided the addition of two char s can be done
|
|
without creating an overflow exception, the actual execution need only
|
|
produce the same result, possibly omitting the promotions.
|
|
|
|
Similarly, in the fragment
|
|
|
|
float f1, f2;
|
|
double d;
|
|
/*...*/
|
|
f1 = f2 * d;
|
|
|
|
the multiplication may be executed using single-precision arithmetic
|
|
if the implementation can ascertain that the result would be the same
|
|
as if it were executed using double-precision arithmetic (for example,
|
|
if d were replaced by the constant 2.0, which has type double ).
|
|
Alternatively, an operation involving only int s or float s may be
|
|
executed using double-precision operations if neither range nor
|
|
precision is lost thereby.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: compound statement, or block ($3.6.2), files
|
|
($4.9.3), sequence points ($3.3, $3.6), the signal function ($4.7),
|
|
type qualifiers ($3.5.3).
|
|
|
|
|
|
2.2 ENVIRONMENTAL CONSIDERATIONS
|
|
|
|
2.2.1 Character sets
|
|
|
|
Two sets of characters and their associated collating sequences
|
|
shall be defined: the set in which source files are written, and the
|
|
set interpreted in the execution environment. The values of the
|
|
members of the execution character set are implementation-defined; any
|
|
additional members beyond those required by this section are
|
|
locale-specific.
|
|
|
|
In a character constant or string literal, members of the execution
|
|
character set shall be represented by corresponding members of the
|
|
source character set or by escape sequences consisting of the
|
|
backslash \ followed by one or more characters. A byte with all bits
|
|
set to 0, called the null character, shall exist in the basic
|
|
execution character set; it is used to terminate a character string
|
|
literal.
|
|
|
|
Both the basic source and basic execution character sets shall have
|
|
at least the following members: the 26 upper-case letters of the
|
|
English alphabet
|
|
|
|
A B C D E F G H I J K L M
|
|
N O P Q R S T U V W X Y Z
|
|
|
|
the 26 lower-case letters of the English alphabet
|
|
|
|
a b c d e f g h i j k l m
|
|
n o p q r s t u v w x y z
|
|
|
|
the 10 decimal digits
|
|
|
|
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
|
|
|
|
the following 29 graphic characters
|
|
|
|
! " # % & ' ( ) * + , - . / :
|
|
; < = > ? [ \ ] ^ _ { | } ~
|
|
|
|
the space character, and control characters representing horizontal
|
|
tab, vertical tab, and form feed. In both the source and execution
|
|
basic character sets, the value of each character after 0 in the above
|
|
list of decimal digits shall be one greater than the value of the
|
|
previous. In source files, there shall be some way of indicating the
|
|
end of each line of text; this Standard treats such an end-of-line
|
|
indicator as if it were a single new-line character. In the execution
|
|
character set, there shall be control characters representing alert,
|
|
backspace, carriage return, and new line. If any other characters are
|
|
encountered in a source file (except in a preprocessing token that is
|
|
never converted to a token, a character constant, a string literal, or
|
|
a comment), the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: character constants ($3.1.3.4), preprocessing
|
|
directives ($3.8), string literals ($3.1.4), comments ($3.1.9).
|
|
|
|
|
|
2.2.1.1 Trigraph sequences
|
|
|
|
All occurrences in a source file of the following sequences of
|
|
three characters (called trigraph sequences /5/)are replaced with the
|
|
corresponding single character.
|
|
|
|
??= #
|
|
??( [
|
|
??/ \
|
|
??) ]
|
|
??' ^
|
|
??< {
|
|
??! |
|
|
??> }
|
|
??- ~
|
|
|
|
No other trigraph sequences exist. Each ? that does not begin one of
|
|
the trigraphs listed above is not changed.
|
|
|
|
Example
|
|
|
|
The following source line
|
|
|
|
printf("Eh???/n");
|
|
|
|
becomes (after replacement of the trigraph sequence ??/ )
|
|
|
|
printf("Eh?\n");
|
|
|
|
|
|
2.2.1.2 Multibyte characters
|
|
|
|
The source character set may contain multibyte characters, used to
|
|
represent members of the extended character set. The execution
|
|
character set may also contain multibyte characters, which need not
|
|
have the same encoding as for the source character set. For both
|
|
character sets, the following shall hold:
|
|
|
|
* The single-byte characters defined in $2.2.1 shall be present.
|
|
|
|
* The presence, meaning, and representation of any additional members
|
|
is locale-specific.
|
|
|
|
* A multibyte character may have a state-dependent encoding ,wherein
|
|
each sequence of multibyte characters begins in an initial shift state
|
|
and enters other implementation-defined shift states when specific
|
|
multibyte characters are encountered in the sequence. While in the
|
|
initial shift state, all single-byte characters retain their usual
|
|
interpretation and do not alter the shift state. The interpretation
|
|
for subsequent bytes in the sequence is a function of the current
|
|
shift state.
|
|
|
|
* A byte with all bits zero shall be interpreted as a null character
|
|
independent of shift state.
|
|
|
|
* A byte with all bits zero shall not occur in the second or
|
|
subsequent bytes of a multibyte character.
|
|
|
|
For the source character set, the following shall hold:
|
|
|
|
* A comment, string literal, character constant, or header name shall
|
|
begin and end in the initial shift state.
|
|
|
|
* A comment, string literal, character constant, or header name shall
|
|
consist of a sequence of valid multibyte characters.
|
|
|
|
|
|
2.2.2 Character display semantics
|
|
|
|
The active position is that location on a display device where the
|
|
next character output by the fputc function would appear. The intent
|
|
of writing a printable character (as defined by the isprint function)
|
|
to a display device is to display a graphic representation of that
|
|
character at the active position and then advance the active position
|
|
to the next position on the current line. The direction of printing
|
|
is locale-specific. If the active position is at the final position
|
|
of a line (if there is one), the behavior is unspecified.
|
|
|
|
Alphabetic escape sequences representing nongraphic characters in
|
|
the execution character set are intended to produce actions on display
|
|
devices as follows: ( alert ) Produces an audible or visible alert.
|
|
The active position shall not be changed. ( backspace ) Moves the
|
|
active position to the previous position on the current line. If the
|
|
active position is at the initial position of a line, the behavior is
|
|
unspecified. ( "form feed" ) Moves the active position to the initial
|
|
position at the start of the next logical page. ( "new line" ) Moves
|
|
the active position to the initial position of the next line.
|
|
( "carriage return" ) Moves the active position to the initial position
|
|
of the current line. ( "horizontal tab" ) Moves the active position
|
|
to the next horizontal tabulation position on the current line. If
|
|
the active position is at or past the last defined horizontal
|
|
tabulation position, the behavior is unspecified. ( "vertical tab" )
|
|
Moves the active position to the initial position of the next vertical
|
|
tabulation position. If the active position is at or past the last
|
|
defined vertical tabulation position, the behavior is unspecified.
|
|
|
|
Each of these escape sequences shall produce a unique
|
|
implementation-defined value which can be stored in a single char
|
|
object. The external representations in a text file need not be
|
|
identical to the internal representations, and are outside the scope
|
|
of this Standard.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: the fputc function ($4.9.7.3), the isprint
|
|
function ($4.3.1.7).
|
|
|
|
|
|
2.2.3 Signals and interrupts
|
|
|
|
Functions shall be implemented such that they may be interrupted at
|
|
any time by a signal, or may be called by a signal handler, or both,
|
|
with no alteration to earlier, but still active, invocations' control
|
|
flow (after the interruption), function return values, or objects with
|
|
automatic storage duration. All such objects shall be maintained
|
|
outside the function image (the instructions that comprise the
|
|
executable representation of a function) on a per-invocation basis.
|
|
|
|
The functions in the standard library are not guaranteed to be
|
|
reentrant and may modify objects with static storage duration.
|
|
|
|
|
|
2.2.4 Environmental limits
|
|
|
|
Both the translation and execution environments constrain the
|
|
implementation of language translators and libraries. The following
|
|
summarizes the environmental limits on a conforming implementation.
|
|
|
|
|
|
2.2.4.1 Translation limits
|
|
|
|
The implementation shall be able to translate and execute at least
|
|
one program that contains at least one instance of every one of the
|
|
following limits:/6/
|
|
|
|
* 15 nesting levels of compound statements, iteration control
|
|
structures, and selection control structures
|
|
|
|
* 8 nesting levels of conditional inclusion
|
|
|
|
* 12 pointer, array, and function declarators (in any combinations)
|
|
modifying an arithmetic, a structure, a union, or an incomplete type
|
|
in a declaration
|
|
|
|
* 31 declarators nested by parentheses within a full declarator
|
|
|
|
* 32 expressions nested by parentheses within a full expression
|
|
|
|
* 31 significant initial characters in an internal identifier or a
|
|
macro name
|
|
|
|
* 6 significant initial characters in an external identifier
|
|
|
|
* 511 external identifiers in one translation unit
|
|
|
|
* 127 identifiers with block scope declared in one block
|
|
|
|
* 1024 macro identifiers simultaneously defined in one translation unit
|
|
|
|
* 31 parameters in one function definition
|
|
|
|
* 31 arguments in one function call
|
|
|
|
* 31 parameters in one macro definition
|
|
|
|
* 31 arguments in one macro invocation
|
|
|
|
* 509 characters in a logical source line
|
|
|
|
* 509 characters in a character string literal or wide string literal
|
|
(after concatenation)
|
|
|
|
* 32767 bytes in an object (in a hosted environment only)
|
|
|
|
* 8 nesting levels for #include'd files
|
|
|
|
* 257 case labels for a switch statement (excluding those for any
|
|
nested switch statements)
|
|
|
|
* 127 members in a single structure or union
|
|
|
|
* 127 enumeration constants in a single enumeration
|
|
|
|
* 15 levels of nested structure or union definitions in a single
|
|
struct-declaration-list
|
|
|
|
|
|
2.2.4.2 Numerical limits
|
|
|
|
A conforming implementation shall document all the limits specified
|
|
in this section, which shall be specified in the headers <limits.h>
|
|
and <float.h> .
|
|
|
|
"Sizes of integral types <limits.h>"
|
|
|
|
The values given below shall be replaced by constant expressions
|
|
suitable for use in #if preprocessing directives. Their
|
|
implementation-defined values shall be equal or greater in magnitude
|
|
(absolute value) to those shown, with the same sign.
|
|
|
|
* maximum number of bits for smallest object that is not a bit-field (byte)
|
|
CHAR_BIT 8
|
|
|
|
* minimum value for an object of type signed char
|
|
SCHAR_MIN -127
|
|
|
|
* maximum value for an object of type signed char
|
|
SCHAR_MAX +127
|
|
|
|
* maximum value for an object of type unsigned char
|
|
UCHAR_MAX 255
|
|
|
|
* minimum value for an object of type char
|
|
CHAR_MIN see below
|
|
|
|
* maximum value for an object of type char
|
|
CHAR_MAX see below
|
|
|
|
* maximum number of bytes in a multibyte character, for any supported locale
|
|
MB_LEN_MAX 1
|
|
|
|
* minimum value for an object of type short int
|
|
SHRT_MIN -32767
|
|
|
|
* maximum value for an object of type short int
|
|
SHRT_MAX +32767
|
|
|
|
* maximum value for an object of type unsigned short int
|
|
USHRT_MAX 65535
|
|
|
|
* minimum value for an object of type int
|
|
INT_MIN -32767
|
|
|
|
* maximum value for an object of type int
|
|
INT_MAX +32767
|
|
|
|
* maximum value for an object of type unsigned int
|
|
UINT_MAX 65535
|
|
|
|
* minimum value for an object of type long int
|
|
LONG_MIN -2147483647
|
|
|
|
* maximum value for an object of type long int
|
|
LONG_MAX +2147483647
|
|
|
|
* maximum value for an object of type unsigned long int
|
|
ULONG_MAX 4294967295
|
|
|
|
If the value of an object of type char sign-extends when used in an
|
|
expression, the value of CHAR_MIN shall be the same as that of
|
|
SCHAR_MIN and the value of CHAR_MAX shall be the same as that of
|
|
SCHAR_MAX . If the value of an object of type char does not
|
|
sign-extend when used in an expression, the value of CHAR_MIN shall be
|
|
0 and the value of CHAR_MAX shall be the same as that of UCHAR_MAX
|
|
./7/
|
|
|
|
"Characteristics of floating types <float.h>"
|
|
|
|
delim $$ The characteristics of floating types are defined in terms
|
|
of a model that describes a representation of floating-point numbers
|
|
and values that provide information about an implementation's
|
|
floating-point arithmetic. The following parameters are used to
|
|
define the model for each floating-point type:
|
|
|
|
A normalized floating-point number x ($f sub 1$ > 0 if x is defined
|
|
by the following model:/8/ $x~=~s~times~b sup e~times~sum from k=1 to
|
|
p~f sub k~times~b sup -k~,~~~e sub min~<=~e~<=~e sub max$
|
|
|
|
Of the values in the <float.h> header, FLT_RADIX shall be a
|
|
constant expression suitable for use in #if preprocessing directives;
|
|
all other values need not be constant expressions. All except
|
|
FLT_RADIX and FLT_ROUNDS have separate names for all three
|
|
floating-point types. The floating-point model representation is
|
|
provided for all values except FLT_ROUNDS .
|
|
|
|
The rounding mode for floating-point addition is characterized by
|
|
the value of FLT_ROUNDS : -1 indeterminable, 0 toward zero, 1 to nearest,
|
|
2 toward positive infinity, 3 toward negative infinity. All other values
|
|
for FLT_ROUNDS characterize implementation-defined rounding behavior.
|
|
|
|
The values given in the following list shall be replaced by
|
|
implementation-defined expressions that shall be equal or greater in
|
|
magnitude (absolute value) to those shown, with the same sign.
|
|
|
|
* radix of exponent representation, b
|
|
FLT_RADIX 2
|
|
|
|
* number of base- FLT_RADIX digits in the floating-point mantissa, p
|
|
|
|
FLT_MANT_DIG
|
|
DBL_MANT_DIG
|
|
LDBL_MANT_DIG
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
* number of decimal digits of precision, $left floor~(p~-~1)~times~{
|
|
log sub 10 } b~right floor ~+~ left { lpile { 1 above 0 } ~~ lpile {
|
|
roman "if " b roman " is a power of 10" above roman otherwise }$
|
|
|
|
FLT_DIG 6
|
|
DBL_DIG 10
|
|
LDBL_DIG 10
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
* minimum negative integer such that FLT_RADIX raised to that power
|
|
minus 1 is a normalized floating-point number, $e sub min$
|
|
|
|
FLT_MIN_EXP
|
|
DBL_MIN_EXP
|
|
LDBL_MIN_EXP
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
* minimum negative integer such that 10 raised to that power is in
|
|
the range of normalized floating-point numbers,
|
|
|
|
FLT_MIN_10_EXP -37
|
|
DBL_MIN_10_EXP -37
|
|
LDBL_MIN_10_EXP -37
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
* maximum integer such that FLT_RADIX raised to that power minus 1 is
|
|
a representable finite floating-point number, $e sub max$
|
|
|
|
FLT_MAX_EXP
|
|
DBL_MAX_EXP
|
|
LDBL_MAX_EXP
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
* maximum integer such that 10 raised to that power is in the range
|
|
of representable finite floating-point numbers,
|
|
|
|
FLT_MAX_10_EXP +37
|
|
DBL_MAX_10_EXP +37
|
|
LDBL_MAX_10_EXP +37
|
|
|
|
|
|
The values given in the following list shall be replaced by
|
|
implementation-defined expressions with values that shall be equal to
|
|
or greater than those shown.
|
|
|
|
* maximum representable finite floating-point number,
|
|
|
|
FLT_MAX 1E+37
|
|
DBL_MAX 1E+37
|
|
LDBL_MAX 1E+37
|
|
|
|
|
|
The values given in the following list shall be replaced by
|
|
implementation-defined expressions with values that shall be equal to
|
|
or smaller than those shown.
|
|
|
|
* minimum positive floating-point number x such that 1.0 + x
|
|
|
|
FLT_EPSILON 1E-5
|
|
DBL_EPSILON 1E-9
|
|
LDBL_EPSILON 1E-9
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
* minimum normalized positive floating-point number, $b sup { e sub
|
|
min - 1 }$
|
|
|
|
FLT_MIN 1E-37
|
|
DBL_MIN 1E-37
|
|
LDBL_MIN 1E-37
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Examples
|
|
|
|
The following describes an artificial floating-point representation
|
|
that meets the minimum requirements of the Standard, and the
|
|
appropriate values in a <float.h> header for type float :
|
|
$x~=~s~times~16 sup e~times~sum from k=1 to 6~f sub k~times~16 sup
|
|
-k~,~~~-31~<=~e~<=~+32$
|
|
|
|
|
|
FLT_RADIX 16
|
|
FLT_MANT_DIG 6
|
|
FLT_EPSILON 9.53674316E-07F
|
|
FLT_DIG 6
|
|
FLT_MIN_EXP -31
|
|
FLT_MIN 2.93873588E-39F
|
|
FLT_MIN_10_EXP -38
|
|
FLT_MAX_EXP +32
|
|
FLT_MAX 3.40282347E+38F
|
|
FLT_MAX_10_EXP +38
|
|
|
|
|
|
The following describes floating-point representations that also
|
|
meet the requirements for single-precision and double-precision
|
|
normalized numbers in the IEEE Standard for Binary Floating-Point
|
|
Arithmetic (ANSI/IEEE Std 754-1985),/9/ b and the appropriate values
|
|
in a <float.h> header for types float and double : $x sub
|
|
f~=~s~times~2 sup e~times~{ sum from k=1 to 24~f sub k~times~2 sup -k
|
|
},~~~-125~<=~e~<=~+128$ $x sub d~=~s~times~2 sup e~times~{ sum from
|
|
k=1 to 53~f sub k~times~2 sup -k },~~~-1021~<=~e~<=~+1024$
|
|
|
|
|
|
FLT_RADIX 2
|
|
FLT_MANT_DIG 24
|
|
FLT_EPSILON 1.19209290E-07F
|
|
FLT_DIG 6
|
|
FLT_MIN_EXP -125
|
|
FLT_MIN 1.17549435E-38F
|
|
FLT_MIN_10_EXP -37
|
|
FLT_MAX_EXP +128
|
|
FLT_MAX 3.40282347E+38F
|
|
FLT_MAX_10_EXP +38
|
|
DBL_MANT_DIG 53
|
|
DBL_EPSILON 2.2204460492503131E-16
|
|
DBL_DIG 15
|
|
DBL_MIN_EXP -1021
|
|
DBL_MIN 2.2250738585072016E-308
|
|
DBL_MIN_10_EXP -307
|
|
DBL_MAX_EXP +1024
|
|
DBL_MAX 1.7976931348623157E+308
|
|
DBL_MAX_10_EXP +308
|
|
|
|
|
|
The values shown above for FLT_EPSILON and DBL_EPSILON are
|
|
appropriate for the ANSI/IEEE Std 754-1985 default rounding mode (to
|
|
nearest). Their values may differ for other rounding modes.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: conditional inclusion ($3.8.1). conditional
|
|
inclusion ($3.8.1).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3. LANGUAGE
|
|
|
|
In the syntax notation used in the language section ($3), syntactic
|
|
categories (nonterminals) are indicated by italic type, and literal
|
|
words and character set members (terminals) by bold type. A colon (:)
|
|
following a nonterminal introduces its definition. Alternative
|
|
definitions are listed on separate lines, except when prefaced by the
|
|
words ``one of.'' An optional symbol is indicated by the so that
|
|
|
|
{ expression<opt> }
|
|
|
|
indicates an optional expression enclosed in braces.
|
|
|
|
3.1 LEXICAL ELEMENTS
|
|
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
token:
|
|
keyword
|
|
identifier
|
|
constant
|
|
string-literal
|
|
operator
|
|
punctuator
|
|
|
|
preprocessing-token:
|
|
header-name
|
|
identifier
|
|
pp-number
|
|
character-constant
|
|
string-literal
|
|
operator
|
|
punctuator
|
|
each non-white-space character that cannot be one of
|
|
the above
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
Each preprocessing token that is converted to a token shall have
|
|
the lexical form of a keyword, an identifier, a constant, a string
|
|
literal, an operator, or a punctuator.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
A token is the minimal lexical element of the language in
|
|
translation phases 7 and 8. The categories of tokens are: keywords,
|
|
identifiers, constants, string literals, operators, and punctuators.
|
|
A preprocessing token is the minimal lexical element of the language
|
|
in translation phases 3 through 6. The categories of preprocessing
|
|
token are: header names, identifiers, preprocessing numbers,
|
|
character constants, string literals, operators, punctuators, and
|
|
single non-white-space characters that do not lexically match the
|
|
other preprocessing token categories. If a ' or a " character matches
|
|
the last category, the behavior is undefined. Comments (described
|
|
later) and the characters space, horizontal tab, new-line, vertical
|
|
tab, and form-feed---collectively called white space ---canseparate
|
|
preprocessing tokens. As described in $3.8, in certain circumstances
|
|
during translation phase 4, white space (or the absence thereof)
|
|
serves as more than preprocessing token separation. White space may
|
|
appear within a preprocessing token only as part of a header name or
|
|
between the quotation characters in a character constant or string
|
|
literal.
|
|
|
|
If the input stream has been parsed into preprocessing tokens up to
|
|
a given character, the next preprocessing token is the longest
|
|
sequence of characters that could constitute a preprocessing token.
|
|
|
|
Examples
|
|
|
|
The program fragment 1Ex is parsed as a preprocessing number token
|
|
(one that is not a valid floating or integer constant token), even
|
|
though a parse as the pair of preprocessing tokens 1 and Ex might
|
|
produce a valid expression (for example, if Ex were a macro defined as
|
|
+1 ). Similarly, the program fragment 1E1 is parsed as a
|
|
preprocessing number (one that is a valid floating constant token),
|
|
whether or not E is a macro name.
|
|
|
|
The program fragment x+++++y is parsed as x ++ ++ + y, which
|
|
violates a constraint on increment operators, even though the parse x
|
|
++ + ++ y might yield a correct expression.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: character constants ($3.1.3.4), comments ($3.1.9),
|
|
expressions ($3.3), floating constants ($3.1.3.1), header names
|
|
($3.1.7), macro replacement ($3.8.3), postfix increment and decrement
|
|
operators ($3.3.2.4), prefix increment and decrement operators
|
|
($3.3.3.1), preprocessing directives ($3.8), preprocessing numbers
|
|
($3.1.8), string literals ($3.1.4).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.1.1 Keywords
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
keyword: one of
|
|
|
|
auto double int struct
|
|
break else long switch
|
|
case enum register typedef
|
|
char extern return union
|
|
const float short unsigned
|
|
continue for signed void
|
|
default goto sizeof volatile
|
|
do if static while
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
The above tokens (entirely in lower-case) are reserved (in
|
|
translation phases 7 and 8) for use as keywords, and shall not be used
|
|
otherwise.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.1.2 Identifiers
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
identifier:
|
|
nondigit
|
|
identifier nondigit
|
|
identifier digit
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
nondigit: one of
|
|
_ a b c d e f g h i j k l m
|
|
n o p q r s t u v w x y z
|
|
A B C D E F G H I J K L M
|
|
N O P Q R S T U V W X Y Z
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
digit: one of
|
|
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
An identifier is a sequence of nondigit characters (including the
|
|
underscore _ and the lower-case and upper-case letters) and digits.
|
|
The first character shall be a nondigit character.
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
In translation phases 7 and 8, an identifier shall not consist of
|
|
the same sequence of characters as a keyword.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
An identifier denotes an object, a function, or one of the
|
|
following entities that will be described later: a tag or a member of
|
|
a structure, union, or enumeration; a typedef name; a label name; a
|
|
macro name; or a macro parameter. A member of an enumeration is
|
|
called an enumeration constant. Macro names and macro parameters are
|
|
not considered further here, because prior to the semantic phase of
|
|
program translation any occurrences of macro names in the source file
|
|
are replaced by the preprocessing token sequences that constitute
|
|
their macro definitions.
|
|
|
|
There is no specific limit on the maximum length of an identifier.
|
|
|
|
"Implementation limits"
|
|
|
|
The implementation shall treat at least the first 31 characters of
|
|
an internal name (a macro name or an identifier that does not have
|
|
external linkage) as significant. Corresponding lower-case and
|
|
upper-case letters are different. The implementation may further
|
|
restrict the significance of an external name (an identifier that has
|
|
external linkage) to six characters and may ignore distinctions of
|
|
alphabetical case for such names./10/ These limitations on identifiers
|
|
are all implementation-defined.
|
|
|
|
Any identifiers that differ in a significant character are
|
|
different identifiers. If two identifiers differ in a non-significant
|
|
character, the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: linkages of identifiers ($3.1.2.2), macro
|
|
replacement ($3.8.3).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.1.2.1 Scopes of identifiers
|
|
|
|
An identifier is visible (i.e., can be used) only within a region
|
|
of program text called its scope . There are four kinds of scopes:
|
|
function, file, block, and function prototype. (A function prototype
|
|
is a declaration of a function that declares the types of its
|
|
parameters.)
|
|
|
|
A label name is the only kind of identifier that has function scope.
|
|
It can be used (in a goto statement) anywhere in the function in
|
|
which it appears, and is declared implicitly by its syntactic
|
|
appearance (followed by a : and a statement). Label names shall be
|
|
unique within a function.
|
|
|
|
Every other identifier has scope determined by the placement of its
|
|
declaration (in a declarator or type specifier). If the declarator or
|
|
type specifier that declares the identifier appears outside of any
|
|
block or list of parameters, the identifier has file scope, which
|
|
terminates at the end of the translation unit. If the declarator or
|
|
type specifier that declares the identifier appears inside a block or
|
|
within the list of parameter declarations in a function definition,
|
|
the identifier has block scope, which terminates at the } that closes
|
|
the associated block. If the declarator or type specifier that
|
|
declares the identifier appears within the list of parameter
|
|
declarations in a function prototype (not part of a function
|
|
definition), the identifier has function prototype scope ,which
|
|
terminates at the end of the function declarator. If an outer
|
|
declaration of a lexically identical identifier exists in the same
|
|
name space, it is hidden until the current scope terminates, after
|
|
which it again becomes visible.
|
|
|
|
Structure, union, and enumeration tags have scope that begins just
|
|
after the appearance of the tag in a type specifier that declares the
|
|
tag. Each enumeration constant has scope that begins just after the
|
|
appearance of its defining enumerator in an enumerator list. Any
|
|
other identifier has scope that begins just after the completion of
|
|
its declarator.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: compound statement, or block ($3.6.2),
|
|
declarations ($3.5), enumeration specifiers ($3.5.2.2), function calls
|
|
($3.3.2.2), function declarators (including prototypes) ($3.5.4.3),
|
|
function definitions ($3.7.1), the goto statement ($3.6.6.1), labeled
|
|
statements ($3.6.1), name spaces of identifiers ($3.1.2.3), scope of
|
|
macro definitions ($3.8.3.5), source file inclusion ($3.8.2), tags
|
|
($3.5.2.3), type specifiers ($3.5.2).
|
|
|
|
3.1.2.2 Linkages of identifiers
|
|
|
|
An identifier declared in different scopes or in the same scope
|
|
more than once can be made to refer to the same object or function by
|
|
a process called linkage . There are three kinds of linkage: external,
|
|
internal, and none.
|
|
|
|
In the set of translation units and libraries that constitutes an
|
|
entire program, each instance of a particular identifier with external
|
|
linkage denotes the same object or function. Within one translation
|
|
unit, each instance of an identifier with internal linkage denotes the
|
|
same object or function. Identifiers with no linkage denote unique
|
|
entities.
|
|
|
|
If the declaration of an identifier for an object or a function has
|
|
file scope and contains the storage-class specifier static, the
|
|
identifier has internal linkage.
|
|
|
|
If the declaration of an identifier for an object or a function
|
|
contains the storage-class specifier extern , the identifier has the
|
|
same linkage as any visible declaration of the identifier with file
|
|
scope. If there is no visible declaration with file scope, the
|
|
identifier has external linkage.
|
|
|
|
If the declaration of an identifier for a function has no
|
|
storage-class specifier, its linkage is determined exactly as if it
|
|
were declared with the storage-class specifier extern . If the
|
|
declaration of an identifier for an object has file scope and no
|
|
storage-class specifier, its linkage is external.
|
|
|
|
The following identifiers have no linkage: an identifier declared
|
|
to be anything other than an object or a function; an identifier
|
|
declared to be a function parameter; an identifier declared to be an
|
|
object inside a block without the storage-class specifier extern.
|
|
|
|
If, within a translation unit, the same identifier appears with
|
|
both internal and external linkage, the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: compound statement, or block ($3.6.2),
|
|
declarations ($3.5), expressions ($3.3), external definitions ($3.7).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.1.2.3 Name spaces of identifiers
|
|
|
|
If more than one declaration of a particular identifier is visible
|
|
at any point in a translation unit, the syntactic context
|
|
disambiguates uses that refer to different entities. Thus, there are
|
|
separate name spaces for various categories of identifiers, as
|
|
follows:
|
|
|
|
* label names (disambiguated by the syntax of the label declaration
|
|
and use);
|
|
|
|
* the tags of structures, unions, and enumerations (disambiguated by
|
|
following any/11/ of the keywords struct , union , or enum );
|
|
|
|
* the members of structures or unions; each structure or union has a
|
|
separate name space for its members (disambiguated by the type of the
|
|
expression used to access the member via the . or -> operator);
|
|
|
|
* all other identifiers, called ordinary identifiers (declared in
|
|
ordinary declarators or as enumeration constants).
|
|
|
|
Forward references: declarators ($3.5.4), enumeration specifiers
|
|
($3.5.2.2), labeled statements ($3.6.1), structure and union
|
|
specifiers ($3.5.2.1), structure and union members ($3.3.2.3), tags
|
|
($3.5.2.3).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.1.2.4 Storage durations of objects
|
|
|
|
An object has a storage duration that determines its lifetime.
|
|
There are two storage durations: static and automatic.
|
|
|
|
An object declared with external or internal linkage, or with the
|
|
storage-class specifier static has static storage duration. For such
|
|
an object, storage is reserved and its stored value is initialized
|
|
only once, prior to program startup. The object exists and retains
|
|
its last-stored value throughout the execution of the entire
|
|
program./12/
|
|
|
|
An object declared with no linkage and without the storage-class
|
|
specifier static has automatic storage duration. Storage is guaranteed
|
|
to be reserved for a new instance of such an object on each normal
|
|
entry into the block in which it is declared, or on a jump from
|
|
outside the block to a label in the block or in an enclosed block. If
|
|
an initialization is specified for the value stored in the object, it
|
|
is performed on each normal entry, but not if the block is entered by
|
|
a jump to a label. Storage for the object is no longer guaranteed to
|
|
be reserved when execution of the block ends in any way. (Entering an
|
|
enclosed block suspends but does not end execution of the enclosing
|
|
block. Calling a function that returns suspends but does not end
|
|
execution of the block containing the call.) The value of a pointer
|
|
that referred to an object with automatic storage duration that is no
|
|
longer guaranteed to be reserved is indeterminate.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: compound statement, or block ($3.6.2), function
|
|
calls ($3.3.2.2), initialization ($3.5.7).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.1.2.5 Types
|
|
|
|
The meaning of a value stored in an object or returned by a
|
|
function is determined by the type of the expression used to access
|
|
it. (An identifier declared to be an object is the simplest such
|
|
expression; the type is specified in the declaration of the
|
|
identifier.) Types are partitioned into object types (types that
|
|
describe objects), function types (types that describe functions), and
|
|
incomplete types (types that describe objects but lack information
|
|
needed to determine their sizes).
|
|
|
|
An object declared as type char is large enough to store any member
|
|
of the basic execution character set. If a member of the required
|
|
source character set enumerated in $2.2.1 is stored in a char object,
|
|
its value is guaranteed to be positive. If other quantities are
|
|
stored in a char object, the behavior is implementation-defined: the
|
|
values are treated as either signed or nonnegative integers.
|
|
|
|
There are four signed integer types, designated as signed char,
|
|
short int, int, and long int. (The signed integer and other types
|
|
may be designated in several additional ways, as described in $3.5.2.)
|
|
|
|
An object declared as type signed char occupies the same amount of
|
|
storage as a ``plain'' char object. A ``plain'' int object has the
|
|
natural size suggested by the architecture of the execution
|
|
environment (large enough to contain any value in the range INT_MIN to
|
|
INT_MAX as defined in the header <limits.h> ). In the list of signed
|
|
integer types above, the range of values of each type is a subrange of
|
|
the values of the next type in the list.
|
|
|
|
For each of the signed integer types, there is a corresponding (but
|
|
different) unsigned integer type (designated with the keyword unsigned)
|
|
that uses the same amount of storage (including sign information)
|
|
and has the same alignment requirements. The range of nonnegative
|
|
values of a signed integer type is a subrange of the corresponding
|
|
unsigned integer type, and the representation of the same value in
|
|
each type is the same. A computation involving unsigned operands can
|
|
never overflow, because a result that cannot be represented by the
|
|
resulting unsigned integer type is reduced modulo the number that is
|
|
one greater than the largest value that can be represented by the
|
|
resulting unsigned integer type.
|
|
|
|
There are three floating types, designated as float , double , and
|
|
long double . The set of values of the type float is a subset of the
|
|
set of values of the type double ; the set of values of the type
|
|
double is a subset of the set of values of the type long double.
|
|
|
|
The type char, the signed and unsigned integer types, and the
|
|
floating types are collectively called the basic types. Even if the
|
|
implementation defines two or more basic types to have the same
|
|
representation, they are nevertheless different types.
|
|
|
|
There are three character types, designated as char , signed char ,
|
|
and unsigned char.
|
|
|
|
An enumeration comprises a set of named integer constant values.
|
|
Each distinct enumeration constitutes a different enumerated type.
|
|
|
|
The void type comprises an empty set of values; it is an incomplete
|
|
type that cannot be completed.
|
|
|
|
Any number of derived types can be constructed from the basic,
|
|
enumerated, and incomplete types, as follows:
|
|
|
|
* An array type describes a contiguously allocated set of objects
|
|
with a particular member object type, called the element type .Array
|
|
types are characterized by their element type and by the number of
|
|
members of the array. An array type is said to be derived from its
|
|
element type, and if its element type is T , the array type is
|
|
sometimes called ``array of T .'' The construction of an array type
|
|
from an element type is called ``array type derivation.''
|
|
|
|
* A structure type describes a sequentially allocated set of member
|
|
objects, each of which has an optionally specified name and possibly
|
|
distinct type.
|
|
|
|
* A union type describes an overlapping set of member objects, each
|
|
of which has an optionally specified name and possibly distinct type.
|
|
|
|
* A function type describes a function with specified return type. A
|
|
function type is characterized by its return type and the number and
|
|
types of its parameters. A function type is said to be derived from
|
|
its return type, and if its return type is T , the function type is
|
|
sometimes called ``function returning T.'' The construction of a
|
|
function type from a return type is called ``function type
|
|
derivation.''
|
|
|
|
* A pointer type may be derived from a function type, an object type,
|
|
or an incomplete type, called the referenced type. A pointer type
|
|
describes an object whose value provides a reference to an entity of
|
|
the referenced type. A pointer type derived from the referenced type
|
|
T is sometimes called ``pointer to T .'' The construction of a pointer
|
|
type from a referenced type is called ``pointer type derivation.''
|
|
|
|
These methods of constructing derived types can be applied
|
|
recursively.
|
|
|
|
The type char, the signed and unsigned integer types, and the
|
|
enumerated types are collectively called integral types. The
|
|
representations of integral types shall define values by use of a pure
|
|
binary numeration system./13/ American National Dictionary for
|
|
Information Processing Systems.) The representations of floating types
|
|
are unspecified.
|
|
|
|
Integral and floating types are collectively called arithmetic
|
|
types. Arithmetic types and pointer types are collectively called
|
|
scalar types. Array and structure types are collectively called
|
|
aggregate types. /14/
|
|
|
|
A pointer to void shall have the same representation and alignment
|
|
requirements as a pointer to a character type. Other pointer types
|
|
need not have the same representation or alignment requirements.
|
|
|
|
An array type of unknown size is an incomplete type. It is
|
|
completed, for an identifier of that type, by specifying the size in a
|
|
later declaration (with internal or external linkage). A structure or
|
|
union type of unknown content (as described in $3.5.2.3) is an
|
|
incomplete type. It is completed, for all declarations of that type,
|
|
by declaring the same structure or union tag with its defining content
|
|
later in the same scope.
|
|
|
|
Array, function, and pointer types are collectively called derived
|
|
declarator types. A declarator type derivation from a type T is the
|
|
construction of a derived declarator type from T by the application of
|
|
an array, a function, or a pointer type derivation to T.
|
|
|
|
A type is characterized by its top type, which is either the first
|
|
type named in describing a derived type (as noted above in the
|
|
construction of derived types), or the type itself if the type
|
|
consists of no derived types.
|
|
|
|
A type has qualified type if its top type is specified with a type
|
|
qualifier; otherwise it has unqualified type. The type qualifiers
|
|
const and volatile respectively designate const-qualified type and
|
|
volatile-qualified type. /15/ For each qualified type there is an
|
|
unqualified type that is specified the same way as the qualified type,
|
|
but without any type qualifiers in its top type. This type is known
|
|
as the unqualified version of the qualified type. Similarly, there
|
|
are appropriately qualified versions of types (such as a
|
|
const-qualified version of a type), just as there are appropriately
|
|
non-qualified versions of types (such as a non-const-qualified version
|
|
of a type).
|
|
|
|
Examples
|
|
|
|
The type designated as ``float *'' is called ``pointer to float''
|
|
and its top type is a pointer type, not a floating type. The
|
|
const-qualified version of this type is designated as ``float * const''
|
|
whereas the type designated as `` const float * '' is not a
|
|
qualified type --- it is called ``pointer to const float '' and is a
|
|
pointer to a qualified type.
|
|
|
|
Finally, the type designated as `` struct tag (*[5])(float) '' is
|
|
called ``array of pointer to function returning struct tag.'' Its top
|
|
type is array type. The array has length five and the function has a
|
|
single parameter of type float.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: character constants ($3.1.3.4), declarations
|
|
($3.5), tags ($3.5.2.3), type qualifiers ($3.5.3).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.1.2.6 Compatible type and composite type
|
|
|
|
Two types have compatible type if their types are the same.
|
|
Additional rules for determining whether two types are compatible are
|
|
described in $3.5.2 for type specifiers, in $3.5.3 for type
|
|
qualifiers, and in $3.5.4 for declarators. /16/ Moreover, two
|
|
structure, union, or enumeration types declared in separate
|
|
translation units are compatible if they have the same number of
|
|
members, the same member names, and compatible member types; for two
|
|
structures, the members shall be in the same order; for two
|
|
enumerations, the members shall have the same values.
|
|
|
|
All declarations that refer to the same object or function shall
|
|
have compatible type; otherwise the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
A composite type can be constructed from two types that are
|
|
compatible; it is a type that is compatible with both of the two types
|
|
and has the following additions:
|
|
|
|
* If one type is an array of known size, the composite type is an
|
|
array of that size.
|
|
|
|
* If only one type is a function type with a parameter type list (a
|
|
function prototype), the composite type is a function prototype with
|
|
the parameter type list.
|
|
|
|
* If both types have parameter type lists, the type of each parameter
|
|
in the composite parameter type list is the composite type of the
|
|
corresponding parameters.
|
|
|
|
These rules apply recursively to the types from which the two types
|
|
are derived.
|
|
|
|
For an identifier with external or internal linkage declared in the
|
|
same scope as another declaration for that identifier, the type of the
|
|
identifier becomes the composite type.
|
|
|
|
Example
|
|
|
|
Given the following two file scope declarations:
|
|
|
|
int f(int (*)(), double (*)[3]);
|
|
int f(int (*)(char *), double (*)[]);
|
|
|
|
The resulting composite type for the function is:
|
|
|
|
int f(int (*)(char *), double (*)[3]);
|
|
|
|
Forward references: declarators ($3.5.4), enumeration specifiers
|
|
($3.5.2.2), structure and union specifiers ($3.5.2.1), type
|
|
definitions ($3.5.6), type qualifiers ($3.5.3), type specifiers
|
|
($3.5.2).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.1.3 Constants
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
constant:
|
|
floating-constant
|
|
integer-constant
|
|
enumeration-constant
|
|
character-constant
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
The value of a constant shall be in the range of representable
|
|
values for its type.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
Each constant has a type, determined by its form and value, as
|
|
detailed later.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.1.3.1 Floating constants
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
floating-constant:
|
|
fractional-constant exponent-part<opt> floating-suffix<opt>
|
|
digit-sequence exponent-part floating-suffix<opt>
|
|
|
|
fractional-constant:
|
|
digit-sequence<opt>.digit-sequence
|
|
digit-sequence.
|
|
|
|
exponent-part:
|
|
e sign<opt> digit-sequence
|
|
E sign<opt> digit-sequence
|
|
|
|
sign: one of
|
|
+ -
|
|
|
|
digit-sequence:
|
|
digit
|
|
digit-sequence digit
|
|
|
|
floating-suffix: one of
|
|
f l F L
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
A floating constant has a value part that may be followed by an
|
|
exponent part and a suffix that specifies its type. The components of
|
|
the value part may include a digit sequence representing the
|
|
whole-number part, followed by a period (.), followed by a digit
|
|
sequence representing the fraction part. The components of the
|
|
exponent part are an e or E followed by an exponent consisting of an
|
|
optionally signed digit sequence. Either the whole-number part or the
|
|
fraction part shall be present; either the period or the exponent part
|
|
shall be present.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
The value part is interpreted as a decimal rational number; the
|
|
digit sequence in the exponent part is interpreted as a decimal
|
|
integer. The exponent indicates the power of 10 by which the value
|
|
part is to be scaled. If the scaled value is in the range of
|
|
representable values (for its type) but cannot be represented exactly,
|
|
the result is either the nearest higher or nearest lower value, chosen
|
|
in an implementation-defined manner.
|
|
|
|
An unsuffixed floating constant has type double. If suffixed by
|
|
the letter f or F, it has type float. If suffixed by the letter l
|
|
or L, it has type long double.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.1.3.2 Integer constants
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
integer-constant:
|
|
decimal-constant integer-suffix<opt>
|
|
octal-constant integer-suffix<opt>
|
|
hexadecimal-constant integer-suffix<opt>
|
|
|
|
decimal-constant:
|
|
nonzero-digit
|
|
decimal-constant digit
|
|
|
|
octal-constant:
|
|
0
|
|
octal-constant octal-digit
|
|
|
|
hexadecimal-constant:
|
|
0x hexadecimal-digit
|
|
0X hexadecimal-digit
|
|
hexadecimal-constant hexadecimal-digit
|
|
|
|
nonzero-digit: one of
|
|
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
|
|
|
|
octal-digit: one of
|
|
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
|
|
|
|
hexadecimal-digit: one of
|
|
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
|
|
a b c d e f
|
|
A B C D E F
|
|
|
|
integer-suffix:
|
|
unsigned-suffix long-suffix<opt>
|
|
long-suffix unsigned-suffix<opt>
|
|
|
|
unsigned-suffix: one of
|
|
u U
|
|
|
|
long-suffix: one of
|
|
l L
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
An integer constant begins with a digit, but has no period or
|
|
exponent part. It may have a prefix that specifies its base and a
|
|
suffix that specifies its type.
|
|
|
|
A decimal constant begins with a nonzero digit and consists of a
|
|
sequence of decimal digits. An octal constant consists of the prefix
|
|
0 optionally followed by a sequence of the digits 0 through 7 only. A
|
|
hexadecimal constant consists of the prefix 0x or 0X followed by a
|
|
sequence of the decimal digits and the letters a (or A ) through f (or
|
|
F) with values 10 through 15 respectively.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
The value of a decimal constant is computed base 10; that of an
|
|
octal constant, base 8; that of a hexadecimal constant, base 16. The
|
|
lexically first digit is the most significant.
|
|
|
|
The type of an integer constant is the first of the corresponding
|
|
list in which its value can be represented. Unsuffixed decimal: int,
|
|
long int, unsigned long int; unsuffixed octal or hexadecimal: int,
|
|
unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int; suffixed by the letter u
|
|
or U: unsigned int, unsigned long int; suffixed by the letter l or
|
|
L: long int, unsigned long int; suffixed by both the letters u or U
|
|
and l or L: unsigned long int .
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.1.3.3 Enumeration constants
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
enumeration-constant:
|
|
identifier
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
An identifier declared as an enumeration constant has type int.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: enumeration specifiers ($3.5.2.2).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.1.3.4 Character constants
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
character-constant:
|
|
' c-char-sequence'
|
|
L' c-char-sequence'
|
|
|
|
c-char-sequence:
|
|
c-char
|
|
c-char-sequence c-char
|
|
|
|
c-char:
|
|
any member of the source character set except
|
|
the single-quote ', backslash \, or new-line character
|
|
escape-sequence
|
|
|
|
escape-sequence:
|
|
simple-escape-sequence
|
|
octal-escape-sequence
|
|
hexadecimal-escape-sequence
|
|
|
|
simple-escape-sequence: one of
|
|
\' \" \? \\
|
|
\a \b \f \n \r \t \v
|
|
|
|
octal-escape-sequence:
|
|
\ octal-digit
|
|
\ octal-digit octal-digit
|
|
\ octal-digit octal-digit octal-digit
|
|
|
|
hexadecimal-escape-sequence:
|
|
\x hexadecimal-digit
|
|
hexadecimal-escape-sequence hexadecimal-digit
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
An integer character constant is a sequence of one or more
|
|
multibyte characters enclosed in single-quotes, as in 'x' or 'ab'. A
|
|
wide character constant is the same, except prefixed by the letter L .
|
|
With a few exceptions detailed later, the elements of the sequence are
|
|
any members of the source character set; they are mapped in an
|
|
implementation-defined manner to members of the execution character
|
|
set.
|
|
|
|
The single-quote ', the double-quote , the question-mark ?, the
|
|
backslash \ , and arbitrary integral values, are representable
|
|
according to the following table of escape sequences:
|
|
|
|
single-quote ' \'
|
|
double-quote " \"
|
|
question-mark ? \?
|
|
backslash \ \\
|
|
octal integer \ octal digits
|
|
hexadecimal integer \x hexadecimal digits
|
|
|
|
The double-quote and question-mark ? are representable either by
|
|
themselves or by the escape sequences \" and \? respectively, but the
|
|
single-quote ' and the backslash \ shall be represented, respectively,
|
|
by the escape sequences \' and \\ .
|
|
|
|
The octal digits that follow the backslash in an octal escape
|
|
sequence are taken to be part of the construction of a single
|
|
character for an integer character constant or of a single wide
|
|
character for a wide character constant. The numerical value of the
|
|
octal integer so formed specifies the value of the desired character.
|
|
|
|
The hexadecimal digits that follow the backslash and the letter x
|
|
in a hexadecimal escape sequence are taken to be part of the
|
|
construction of a single character for an integer character constant
|
|
or of a single wide character for a wide character constant. The
|
|
numerical value of the hexadecimal integer so formed specifies the
|
|
value of the desired character.
|
|
|
|
Each octal or hexadecimal escape sequence is the longest sequence
|
|
of characters that can constitute the escape sequence.
|
|
|
|
In addition, certain nongraphic characters are representable by
|
|
escape sequences consisting of the backslash \ followed by a
|
|
lower-case letter: \a , \b , \f , \n , \r , \t , and \v ./17/ If any
|
|
other escape sequence is encountered, the behavior is undefined./18/
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
The value of an octal or hexadecimal escape sequence shall be in
|
|
the range of representable values for the unsigned type corresponding
|
|
to its type.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
An integer character constant has type int. The value of an
|
|
integer character constant containing a single character that maps
|
|
into a member of the basic execution character set is the numerical
|
|
value of the representation of the mapped character interpreted as an
|
|
integer. The value of an integer character constant containing more
|
|
than one character, or containing a character or escape sequence not
|
|
represented in the basic execution character set, is
|
|
implementation-defined. In particular, in an implementation in which
|
|
type char has the same range of values as signed char, the high-order
|
|
bit position of a single-character integer character constant is
|
|
treated as a sign bit.
|
|
|
|
A wide character constant has type wchar_t , an integral type
|
|
defined in the <stddef.h> header. The value of a wide character
|
|
constant containing a single multibyte character that maps into a
|
|
member of the extended execution character set is the wide character
|
|
(code) corresponding to that multibyte character, as defined by the
|
|
mbtowc function, with an implementation-defined current locale. The
|
|
value of a wide character constant containing more than one multibyte
|
|
character, or containing a multibyte character or escape sequence not
|
|
represented in the extended execution character set, is
|
|
implementation-defined.
|
|
|
|
Examples
|
|
|
|
The construction '\0' is commonly used to represent the null character.
|
|
|
|
Consider implementations that use two's-complement representation
|
|
for integers and eight bits for objects that have type char. In an
|
|
implementation in which type char has the same range of values as
|
|
signed char, the integer character constant '\xFF' has the value if
|
|
type char has the same range of values as unsigned char, the
|
|
character constant '\xFF' has the value
|
|
|
|
Even if eight bits are used for objects that have type char , the
|
|
construction '\x123' specifies an integer character constant
|
|
containing only one character. (The value of this single-character
|
|
integer character constant is implementation-defined and violates the
|
|
above constraint.) To specify an integer character constant containing
|
|
the two characters whose values are 0x12 and '3', the construction
|
|
'\0223' may be used, since a hexadecimal escape sequence is terminated
|
|
only by a non-hexadecimal character. (The value of this two-character
|
|
integer character constant is implementation-defined also.)
|
|
|
|
Even if 12 or more bits are used for objects that have type wchar_t,
|
|
the construction L'\1234' specifies the implementation-defined value
|
|
that results from the combination of the values 0123 and '4'.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: characters and integers ($3.2.1.1) common
|
|
definitions <stddef.h> ($4.1.5), the mbtowc function ($4.10.7.2).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.1.4 String literals
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
string-literal:
|
|
" s-char-sequence<opt>"
|
|
L" s-char-sequence<opt>"
|
|
|
|
s-char-sequence:
|
|
s-char
|
|
s-char-sequence s-char
|
|
|
|
s-char:
|
|
any member of the source character set except
|
|
the double-quote ", backslash \, or new-line character
|
|
escape-sequence
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
A character string literal is a sequence of zero or more multibyte
|
|
characters enclosed in double-quotes, as in xyz. A wide string
|
|
literal is the same, except prefixed by the letter L.
|
|
|
|
The same considerations apply to each element of the sequence in a
|
|
character string literal or a wide string literal as if it were in an
|
|
integer character constant or a wide character constant, except that
|
|
the single-quote ' is representable either by itself or by the escape
|
|
sequence \', but the double-quote shall be represented by the escape
|
|
sequence \.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
A character string literal has static storage duration and type
|
|
``array of char ,'' and is initialized with the given characters. A
|
|
wide string literal has static storage duration and type ``array of
|
|
wchar_t,'' and is initialized with the wide characters corresponding
|
|
to the given multibyte characters. Character string literals that are
|
|
adjacent tokens are concatenated into a single character string
|
|
literal. A null character is then appended. /19/ Likewise, adjacent
|
|
wide string literal tokens are concatenated into a single wide string
|
|
literal to which a code with value zero is then appended. If a
|
|
character string literal token is adjacent to a wide string literal
|
|
token, the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
Identical string literals of either form need not be distinct. If
|
|
the program attempts to modify a string literal of either form, the
|
|
behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
Example
|
|
|
|
This pair of adjacent character string literals
|
|
|
|
"\x12" "3"
|
|
|
|
produces a single character string literal containing the two
|
|
characters whose values are \x12 and '3', because escape sequences are
|
|
converted into single members of the execution character set just
|
|
prior to adjacent string literal concatenation.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: common definitions <stddef.h> ($4.1.5).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.1.5 Operators
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
operator: one of
|
|
[ ] ( ) . ->
|
|
++ -- & * + - ~ ! sizeof
|
|
/ % << >> < > <= >= == != ^ | && ||
|
|
? :
|
|
= *= /= %= += -= <<= >>= &= ^= |=
|
|
, # ##
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
The operators [ ] , ( ) , and ? : shall occur in pairs, possibly
|
|
separated by expressions. The operators # and ## shall occur in
|
|
macro-defining preprocessing directives only.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
An operator specifies an operation to be performed (an evaluation )
|
|
that yields a value, or yields a designator, or produces a side
|
|
effect, or a combination thereof. An operand is an entity on which an
|
|
operator acts.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: expressions ($3.3), macro replacement ($3.8.3).
|
|
|
|
3.1.6 Punctuators
|
|
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
punctuator: one of
|
|
[ ] ( ) { } * , : = ; ... #
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
The punctuators [ ] , ( ) , and { } shall occur in pairs, possibly
|
|
separated by expressions, declarations, or statements. The punctuator
|
|
# shall occur in preprocessing directives only.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
A punctuator is a symbol that has independent syntactic and
|
|
semantic significance but does not specify an operation to be
|
|
performed that yields a value. Depending on context, the same symbol
|
|
may also represent an operator or part of an operator.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: expressions ($3.3), declarations ($3.5),
|
|
preprocessing directives ($3.8), statements ($3.6).
|
|
|
|
3.1.7 Header names
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
header-name:
|
|
< h-char-sequence>
|
|
" q-char-sequence"
|
|
|
|
h-char-sequence:
|
|
h-char
|
|
h-char-sequence h-char
|
|
|
|
h-char:
|
|
any member of the source character set except
|
|
the new-line character and >
|
|
|
|
q-char-sequence:
|
|
q-char
|
|
q-char-sequence q-char
|
|
|
|
q-char:
|
|
any member of the source character set except
|
|
the new-line character and "
|
|
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
Header name preprocessing tokens shall only appear within a
|
|
#include preprocessing directive.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
The sequences in both forms of header names are mapped in an
|
|
implementation-defined manner to headers or external source file names
|
|
as specified in $3.8.2.
|
|
|
|
If the characters ', \ , , or /* occur in the sequence between the
|
|
< and > delimiters, the behavior is undefined. Similarly, if the
|
|
characters ', \ , or /* occur in the sequence between the " delimiters,
|
|
the behavior is undefined. /20/
|
|
|
|
Example
|
|
|
|
The following sequence of characters:
|
|
|
|
0x3<1/a.h>1e2
|
|
#include <1/a.h>
|
|
#define const.member@$
|
|
|
|
forms the following sequence of preprocessing tokens (with each
|
|
individual preprocessing token delimited by a { on the left and a } on
|
|
the right).
|
|
|
|
{0x3}{<}{1}{/}{a}{.}{h}{>}{1e2}
|
|
{#}{include} {<1/a.h>}
|
|
{#}{define} {const}{.}{member}{@}{$}
|
|
|
|
Forward references: source file inclusion ($3.8.2).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.1.8 Preprocessing numbers
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
pp-number:
|
|
digit
|
|
. digit
|
|
pp-number digit
|
|
pp-number nondigit
|
|
pp-number e sign
|
|
pp-number E sign
|
|
pp-number .
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
A preprocessing number begins with a digit optionally preceded by a
|
|
period (.) and may be followed by letters, underscores, digits,
|
|
periods, and e+, e-, E+, or E- character sequences.
|
|
|
|
Preprocessing number tokens lexically include all floating and
|
|
integer constant tokens.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
A preprocessing number does not have type or a value; it acquires
|
|
both after a successful conversion (as part of translation phase 7) to
|
|
a floating constant token or an integer constant token.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.1.9 Comments
|
|
|
|
Except within a character constant, a string literal, or a comment,
|
|
the characters /* introduce a comment. The contents of a comment are
|
|
examined only to identify multibyte characters and to find the
|
|
characters */ that terminate it. /21/
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.2 CONVERSIONS
|
|
|
|
Several operators convert operand values from one type to another
|
|
automatically. This section specifies the result required from such
|
|
an implicit conversion, as well as those that result from a cast
|
|
operation (an explicit conversion). The list in $3.2.1.5 summarizes
|
|
the conversions performed by most ordinary operators; it is
|
|
supplemented as required by the discussion of each operator in $3.3.
|
|
|
|
Conversion of an operand value to a compatible type causes no change.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: cast operators ($3.3.4).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.2.1 Arithmetic operands
|
|
|
|
3.2.1.1 Characters and integers
|
|
|
|
A char, a short int, or an int bit-field, or their signed or
|
|
unsigned varieties, or an object that has enumeration type, may be
|
|
used in an expression wherever an int or unsigned int may be used. If
|
|
an int can represent all values of the original type, the value is
|
|
converted to an int; otherwise it is converted to an unsigned int.
|
|
These are called the integral promotions.
|
|
|
|
The integral promotions preserve value including sign. As
|
|
discussed earlier, whether a ``plain'' char is treated as signed is
|
|
implementation-defined.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: enumeration specifiers ($3.5.2.2), structure and
|
|
union specifiers ($3.5.2.1).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.2.1.2 Signed and unsigned integers
|
|
|
|
When an unsigned integer is converted to another integral type, if
|
|
the value can be represented by the new type, its value is unchanged.
|
|
|
|
When a signed integer is converted to an unsigned integer with
|
|
equal or greater size, if the value of the signed integer is
|
|
nonnegative, its value is unchanged. Otherwise: if the unsigned
|
|
integer has greater size, the signed integer is first promoted to the
|
|
signed integer corresponding to the unsigned integer; the value is
|
|
converted to unsigned by adding to it one greater than the largest
|
|
number that can be represented in the unsigned integer type. /22/
|
|
|
|
When an integer is demoted to an unsigned integer with smaller
|
|
size, the result is the nonnegative remainder on division by the
|
|
number one greater than the largest unsigned number that can be
|
|
represented in the type with smaller size. When an integer is demoted
|
|
to a signed integer with smaller size, or an unsigned integer is
|
|
converted to its corresponding signed integer, if the value cannot be
|
|
represented the result is implementation-defined.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.2.1.3 Floating and integral
|
|
|
|
When a value of floating type is converted to integral type, the
|
|
fractional part is discarded. If the value of the integral part
|
|
cannot be represented by the integral type, the behavior is
|
|
undefined. /23/
|
|
|
|
When a value of integral type is converted to floating type, if the
|
|
value being converted is in the range of values that can be
|
|
represented but cannot be represented exactly, the result is either
|
|
the nearest higher or nearest lower value, chosen in an
|
|
implementation-defined manner.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.2.1.4 Floating types
|
|
|
|
When a float is promoted to double or long double , or a double is
|
|
promoted to long double , its value is unchanged.
|
|
|
|
When a double is demoted to float or a long double to double or
|
|
float, if the value being converted is outside the range of values
|
|
that can be represented, the behavior is undefined. If the value
|
|
being converted is in the range of values that can be represented but
|
|
cannot be represented exactly, the result is either the nearest higher
|
|
or nearest lower value, chosen in an implementation-defined manner.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.2.1.5 Usual arithmetic conversions
|
|
|
|
Many binary operators that expect operands of arithmetic type cause
|
|
conversions and yield result types in a similar way. The purpose is
|
|
to yield a common type, which is also the type of the result. This
|
|
pattern is called the usual arithmetic conversions: First, if either
|
|
operand has type long double, the other operand is converted to long
|
|
double . Otherwise, if either operand has type double, the other
|
|
operand is converted to double. Otherwise, if either operand has
|
|
type float, the other operand is converted to float. Otherwise, the
|
|
integral promotions are performed on both operands. Then the
|
|
following rules are applied: If either operand has type unsigned long
|
|
int, the other operand is converted to unsigned long int.
|
|
Otherwise, if one operand has type long int and the other has type
|
|
unsigned int, if a long int can represent all values of an unsigned
|
|
int, the operand of type unsigned int is converted to long int ; if a
|
|
long int cannot represent all the values of an unsigned int, both
|
|
operands are converted to unsigned long int. Otherwise, if either
|
|
operand has type long int, the other operand is converted to long int.
|
|
Otherwise, if either operand has type unsigned int, the other
|
|
operand is converted to unsigned int. Otherwise, both operands have
|
|
type int.
|
|
|
|
The values of operands and of the results of expressions may be
|
|
represented in greater precision and range than that required by the
|
|
type; the types are not changed thereby.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.2.2 Other operands
|
|
|
|
3.2.2.1 Lvalues and function designators
|
|
|
|
An lvalue is an expression (with an object type or an incomplete
|
|
type other than void) that designates an object. /24/ When an object
|
|
is said to have a particular type, the type is specified by the lvalue
|
|
used to designate the object. A modifiable lvalue is an lvalue that
|
|
does not have array type, does not have an incomplete type, does not
|
|
have a const-qualified type, and if it is a structure or union, does
|
|
not have any member (including, recursively, any member of all
|
|
contained structures or unions) with a const-qualified type.
|
|
|
|
Except when it is the operand of the sizeof operator, the unary &
|
|
operator, the ++ operator, the -- operator, or the left operand of the .
|
|
operator or an assignment operator, an lvalue that does not have
|
|
array type is converted to the value stored in the designated object
|
|
(and is no longer an lvalue). If the lvalue has qualified type, the
|
|
value has the unqualified version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise
|
|
the value has the type of the lvalue. If the lvalue has an incomplete
|
|
type and does not have array type, the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
Except when it is the operand of the sizeof operator or the unary &
|
|
operator, or is a character string literal used to initialize an array
|
|
of character type, or is a wide string literal used to initialize an
|
|
array with element type compatible with wchar_t, an lvalue that has
|
|
type ``array of type '' is converted to an expression that has type
|
|
``pointer to type '' that points to the initial member of the array
|
|
object and is not an lvalue.
|
|
|
|
A function designator is an expression that has function type.
|
|
Except when it is the operand of the sizeof operator /25/ or the unary
|
|
& operator, a function designator with type ``function returning type
|
|
'' is converted to an expression that has type ``pointer to function
|
|
returning type .''
|
|
|
|
Forward references: address and indirection operators ($3.3.3.2),
|
|
assignment operators ($3.3.16), common definitions <stddef.h>
|
|
($4.1.5), initialization ($3.5.7), postfix increment and decrement
|
|
operators ($3.3.2.4), prefix increment and decrement operators
|
|
($3.3.3.1), the sizeof operator ($3.3.3.4), structure and union
|
|
members ($3.3.2.3).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.2.2.2 void
|
|
|
|
The (nonexistent) value of a void expression (an expression that
|
|
has type void) shall not be used in any way, and implicit or explicit
|
|
conversions (except to void ) shall not be applied to such an
|
|
expression. If an expression of any other type occurs in a context
|
|
where a void expression is required, its value or designator is
|
|
discarded. (A void expression is evaluated for its side effects.)
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.2.2.3 Pointers
|
|
|
|
A pointer to void may be converted to or from a pointer to any
|
|
incomplete or object type. A pointer to any incomplete or object type
|
|
may be converted to a pointer to void and back again; the result shall
|
|
compare equal to the original pointer.
|
|
|
|
A pointer to a non-q-qualified type may be converted to a pointer
|
|
to the q-qualified version of the type; the values stored in the
|
|
original and converted pointers shall compare equal.
|
|
|
|
An integral constant expression with the value 0, or such an
|
|
expression cast to type void * , is called a null pointer constant. If
|
|
a null pointer constant is assigned to or compared for equality to a
|
|
pointer, the constant is converted to a pointer of that type. Such a
|
|
pointer, called a null pointer, is guaranteed to compare unequal to a
|
|
pointer to any object or function.
|
|
|
|
Two null pointers, converted through possibly different sequences
|
|
of casts to pointer types, shall compare equal.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: cast operators ($3.3.4), equality operators
|
|
($3.3.9), simple assignment ($3.3.16.1).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.3 EXPRESSIONS
|
|
|
|
An expression is a sequence of operators and operands that
|
|
specifies computation of a value, or that designates an object or a
|
|
function, or that generates side effects, or that performs a
|
|
combination thereof.
|
|
|
|
Between the previous and next sequence point an object shall have
|
|
its stored value modified at most once by the evaluation of an
|
|
expression. Furthermore, the prior value shall be accessed only to
|
|
determine the value to be stored. /26/
|
|
|
|
Except as indicated by the syntax /27/ or otherwise specified later
|
|
(for the function-call operator () , && , || , ?: , and comma
|
|
operators), the order of evaluation of subexpressions and the order in
|
|
which side effects take place are both unspecified.
|
|
|
|
Some operators (the unary operator ~ , and the binary operators << ,
|
|
>> , & , ^ , and | , collectively described as bitwise operators
|
|
)shall have operands that have integral type. These operators return
|
|
values that depend on the internal representations of integers, and
|
|
thus have implementation-defined aspects for signed types.
|
|
|
|
If an exception occurs during the evaluation of an expression (that
|
|
is, if the result is not mathematically defined or not representable),
|
|
the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
An object shall have its stored value accessed only by an lvalue
|
|
that has one of the following types: /28/
|
|
|
|
* the declared type of the object,
|
|
|
|
* a qualified version of the declared type of the object,
|
|
|
|
* a type that is the signed or unsigned type corresponding to the
|
|
declared type of the object,
|
|
|
|
* a type that is the signed or unsigned type corresponding to a
|
|
qualified version of the declared type of the object,
|
|
|
|
* an aggregate or union type that includes one of the aforementioned
|
|
types among its members (including, recursively, a member of a
|
|
subaggregate or contained union), or
|
|
|
|
* a character type.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.3.1 Primary expressions
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
primary-expression:
|
|
identifier
|
|
constant
|
|
string-literal
|
|
( expression )
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
An identifier is a primary expression, provided it has been
|
|
declared as designating an object (in which case it is an lvalue) or a
|
|
function (in which case it is a function designator).
|
|
|
|
A constant is a primary expression. Its type depends on its form,
|
|
as detailed in $3.1.3.
|
|
|
|
A string literal is a primary expression. It is an lvalue with
|
|
type as detailed in $3.1.4.
|
|
|
|
A parenthesized expression is a primary expression. Its type and
|
|
value are identical to those of the unparenthesized expression. It is
|
|
an lvalue, a function designator, or a void expression if the
|
|
unparenthesized expression is, respectively, an lvalue, a function
|
|
designator, or a void expression.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: declarations ($3.5).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.3.2 Postfix operators
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
postfix-expression:
|
|
primary-expression
|
|
postfix-expression [ expression ]
|
|
postfix-expression ( argument-expression-list<opt> )
|
|
postfix-expression . identifier
|
|
postfix-expression -> identifier
|
|
postfix-expression ++
|
|
postfix-expression --
|
|
|
|
argument-expression-list:
|
|
assignment-expression
|
|
argument-expression-list , assignment-expression
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.3.2.1 Array subscripting
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
One of the expressions shall have type ``pointer to object type ,''
|
|
the other expression shall have integral type, and the result has type
|
|
`` type .''
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
A postfix expression followed by an expression in square brackets
|
|
[] is a subscripted designation of a member of an array object. The
|
|
definition of the subscript operator [] is that E1[E2] is identical to
|
|
(*(E1+(E2))) . Because of the conversion rules that apply to the
|
|
binary + operator, if E1 is an array object (equivalently, a pointer
|
|
to the initial member of an array object) and E2 is an integer, E1[E2]
|
|
designates the E2 -th member of E1 (counting from zero).
|
|
|
|
Successive subscript operators designate a member of a
|
|
multi-dimensional array object. If E is an n -dimensional array ( n
|
|
>=2) with dimensions i x j "x ... x" k , then E (used as other than an
|
|
lvalue) is converted to a pointer to an ( n -1)-dimensional array with
|
|
dimensions j "x ... x" k . If the unary * operator is applied to this
|
|
pointer explicitly, or implicitly as a result of subscripting, the
|
|
result is the pointed-to ( n -1)-dimensional array, which itself is
|
|
converted into a pointer if used as other than an lvalue. It follows
|
|
from this that arrays are stored in row-major order (last subscript
|
|
varies fastest).
|
|
|
|
Example
|
|
|
|
Consider the array object defined by the declaration
|
|
|
|
int x[3][5];
|
|
|
|
Here x is a 3x5 array of int s; more precisely, x is an array of three
|
|
member objects, each of which is an array of five int s. In the
|
|
expression x[i] , which is equivalent to (*(x+(i))) , x is first
|
|
converted to a pointer to the initial array of five int s. Then i is
|
|
adjusted according to the type of x , which conceptually entails
|
|
multiplying i by the size of the object to which the pointer points,
|
|
namely an array of five int objects. The results are added and
|
|
indirection is applied to yield an array of five int s. When used in
|
|
the expression x[i][j] , that in turn is converted to a pointer to the
|
|
first of the int s, so x[i][j] yields an int.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: additive operators ($3.3.6), address and
|
|
indirection operators ($3.3.3.2), array declarators ($3.5.4.2).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.3.2.2 Function calls
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
The expression that denotes the called function/29/ shall have type
|
|
pointer to function returning void or returning an object type other
|
|
than array.
|
|
|
|
If the expression that denotes the called function has a type that
|
|
includes a prototype, the number of arguments shall agree with the
|
|
number of parameters. Each argument shall have a type such that its
|
|
value may be assigned to an object with the unqualified version of the
|
|
type of its corresponding parameter.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
A postfix expression followed by parentheses () containing a
|
|
possibly empty, comma-separated list of expressions is a function
|
|
call. The postfix expression denotes the called function. The list
|
|
of expressions specifies the arguments to the function.
|
|
|
|
If the expression that precedes the parenthesized argument list in
|
|
a function call consists solely of an identifier, and if no
|
|
declaration is visible for this identifier, the identifier is
|
|
implicitly declared exactly as if, in the innermost block containing
|
|
the function call, the declaration
|
|
|
|
extern int identifier();
|
|
|
|
appeared. /30/
|
|
|
|
An argument may be an expression of any object type. In preparing
|
|
for the call to a function, the arguments are evaluated, and each
|
|
parameter is assigned the value of the corresponding argument./31/ The
|
|
value of the function call expression is specified in $3.6.6.4.
|
|
|
|
If the expression that denotes the called function has a type that
|
|
does not include a prototype, the integral promotions are performed on
|
|
each argument and arguments that have type float are promoted to
|
|
double. These are called the default argument promotions. If the
|
|
number of arguments does not agree with the number of parameters, the
|
|
behavior is undefined. If the function is defined with a type that
|
|
does not include a prototype, and the types of the arguments after
|
|
promotion are not compatible with those of the parameters after
|
|
promotion, the behavior is undefined. If the function is defined with
|
|
a type that includes a prototype, and the types of the arguments after
|
|
promotion are not compatible with the types of the parameters, or if
|
|
the prototype ends with an ellipsis ( ", ..." ), the behavior is
|
|
undefined.
|
|
|
|
If the expression that denotes the called function has a type that
|
|
includes a prototype, the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
|
|
assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameters. The
|
|
ellipsis notation in a function prototype declarator causes argument
|
|
type conversion to stop after the last declared parameter. The
|
|
default argument promotions are performed on trailing arguments. If
|
|
the function is defined with a type that is not compatible with the
|
|
type (of the expression) pointed to by the expression that denotes the
|
|
called function, the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
No other conversions are performed implicitly; in particular, the
|
|
number and types of arguments are not compared with those of the
|
|
parameters in a function definition that does not include a function
|
|
prototype declarator.
|
|
|
|
The order of evaluation of the function designator, the arguments,
|
|
and subexpressions within the arguments is unspecified, but there is a
|
|
sequence point before the actual call.
|
|
|
|
Recursive function calls shall be permitted, both directly and
|
|
indirectly through any chain of other functions.
|
|
|
|
Example
|
|
|
|
In the function call
|
|
|
|
(*pf[f1()]) (f2(), f3() + f4())
|
|
|
|
the functions f1 , f2 , f3 , and f4 may be called in any order. All
|
|
side effects shall be completed before the function pointed to by
|
|
pf[f1()] is entered.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: function declarators (including prototypes)
|
|
($3.5.4.3), function definitions ($3.7.1), the return statement
|
|
($3.6.6.4), simple assignment ($3.3.16.1).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.3.2.3 Structure and union members
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
The first operand of the . operator shall have a qualified or
|
|
unqualified structure or union type, and the second operand shall name
|
|
a member of that type.
|
|
|
|
The first operand of the -> operator shall have type ``pointer to
|
|
qualified or unqualified structure'' or ``pointer to qualified or
|
|
unqualified union,'' and the second operand shall name a member of the
|
|
type pointed to.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
A postfix expression followed by a dot . and an identifier
|
|
designates a member of a structure or union object. The value is that
|
|
of the named member, and is an lvalue if the first expression is an
|
|
lvalue. If the first expression has qualified type, the result has
|
|
the so-qualified version of the type of the designated member.
|
|
|
|
A postfix expression followed by an arrow -> and an identifier
|
|
designates a member of a structure or union object. The value is that
|
|
of the named member of the object to which the first expression
|
|
points, and is an lvalue./32/ If the first expression is a pointer to
|
|
a qualified type, the result has the so-qualified version of the type
|
|
of the designated member.
|
|
|
|
With one exception, if a member of a union object is accessed after
|
|
a value has been stored in a different member of the object, the
|
|
behavior is implementation-defined./33/ One special guarantee is made
|
|
in order to simplify the use of unions: If a union contains several
|
|
structures that share a common initial sequence, and if the union
|
|
object currently contains one of these structures, it is permitted to
|
|
inspect the common initial part of any of them. Two structures share
|
|
a common initial sequence if corresponding members have compatible
|
|
types for a sequence of one or more initial members.
|
|
|
|
Example
|
|
|
|
If f is a function returning a structure or union, and x is a
|
|
member of that structure or union, f().x is a valid postfix expression
|
|
but is not an lvalue.
|
|
|
|
The following is a valid fragment:
|
|
|
|
union {
|
|
struct {
|
|
int alltypes;
|
|
} n;
|
|
struct {
|
|
int type;
|
|
int intnode;
|
|
} ni;
|
|
struct {
|
|
int type;
|
|
double doublenode;
|
|
} nf;
|
|
} u;
|
|
/*...*/
|
|
u.nf.type = 1;
|
|
u.nf.doublenode = 3.14;
|
|
/*...*/
|
|
if (u.n.alltypes == 1)
|
|
/*...*/ sin(u.nf.doublenode) /*...*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Forward references: address and indirection operators ($3.3.3.2),
|
|
structure and union specifiers ($3.5.2.1).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.3.2.4 Postfix increment and decrement operators
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
The operand of the postfix increment or decrement operator shall
|
|
have qualified or unqualified scalar type and shall be a modifiable
|
|
lvalue.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
The result of the postfix ++ operator is the value of the operand.
|
|
After the result is obtained, the value of the operand is incremented.
|
|
(That is, the value 1 of the appropriate type is added to it.) See the
|
|
discussions of additive operators and compound assignment for
|
|
information on constraints, types and conversions and the effects of
|
|
operations on pointers. The side effect of updating the stored value
|
|
of the operand shall occur between the previous and the next sequence
|
|
point.
|
|
|
|
The postfix -- operator is analogous to the postfix ++ operator,
|
|
except that the value of the operand is decremented (that is, the
|
|
value 1 of the appropriate type is subtracted from it).
|
|
|
|
Forward references: additive operators ($3.3.6), compound assignment
|
|
($3.3.16.2).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.3.3 Unary operators
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
unary-expression:
|
|
postfix-expression
|
|
++ unary-expression
|
|
-- unary-expression
|
|
unary-operator cast-expression
|
|
sizeof unary-expression
|
|
sizeof ( type-name )
|
|
|
|
unary-operator: one of
|
|
& * + - ~ !
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.3.3.1 Prefix increment and decrement operators
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
The operand of the prefix increment or decrement operator shall
|
|
have qualified or unqualified scalar type and shall be a modifiable
|
|
lvalue.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
The value of the operand of the prefix ++ operator is incremented.
|
|
The result is the new value of the operand after incrementation. The
|
|
expression ++E is equivalent to (E+=1) . See the discussions of
|
|
additive operators and compound assignment for information on
|
|
constraints, types, side effects, and conversions and the effects of
|
|
operations on pointers.
|
|
|
|
The prefix -- operator is analogous to the prefix ++ operator,
|
|
except that the value of the operand is decremented.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: additive operators ($3.3.6), compound assignment
|
|
($3.3.16.2).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.3.3.2 Address and indirection operators
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
The operand of the unary & operator shall be either a function
|
|
designator or an lvalue that designates an object that is not a
|
|
bit-field and is not declared with the register storage-class
|
|
specifier.
|
|
|
|
The operand of the unary * operator shall have pointer type.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
The result of the unary & (address-of) operator is a pointer to the
|
|
object or function designated by its operand. If the operand has type
|
|
`` type ,'' the result has type ``pointer to type .''
|
|
|
|
The unary * operator denotes indirection. If the operand points to
|
|
a function, the result is a function designator; if it points to an
|
|
object, the result is an lvalue designating the object. If the
|
|
operand has type ``pointer to type ,'' the result has type `` type .''
|
|
If an invalid value has been assigned to the pointer, the behavior of
|
|
the unary * operator is undefined./34/
|
|
|
|
Forward references: storage-class specifiers ($3.5.1), structure and
|
|
union specifiers ($3.5.2.1).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.3.3.3 Unary arithmetic operators
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
The operand of the unary + or - operator shall have arithmetic
|
|
type; of the ~ operator, integral type; of the ! operator, scalar
|
|
type.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
The result of the unary + operator is the value of its operand.
|
|
The integral promotion is performed on the operand, and the result has
|
|
the promoted type.
|
|
|
|
The result of the unary - operator is the negative of its operand.
|
|
The integral promotion is performed on the operand, and the result has
|
|
the promoted type.
|
|
|
|
The result of the ~ operator is the bitwise complement of its
|
|
operand (that is, each bit in the result is set if and only if the
|
|
corresponding bit in the converted operand is not set). The integral
|
|
promotion is performed on the operand, and the result has the promoted
|
|
type. The expression ~E is equivalent to (ULONG_MAX-E) if E is
|
|
promoted to type unsigned long , to (UINT_MAX-E) if E is promoted to
|
|
type unsigned int . (The constants ULONG_MAX and UINT_MAX are defined
|
|
in the header <limits.h> .)
|
|
|
|
The result of the logical negation operator ! is 0 if the value of
|
|
its operand compares unequal to 0, 1 if the value of its operand
|
|
compares equal to 0. The result has type int . The expression !E is
|
|
equivalent to (0==E) .
|
|
|
|
Forward references: limits <float.h> and <limits.h> ($4.1.4).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.3.3.4 The sizeof operator
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
The sizeof operator shall not be applied to an expression that has
|
|
function type or an incomplete type, to the parenthesized name of such
|
|
a type, or to an lvalue that designates a bit-field object.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
The sizeof operator yields the size (in bytes) of its operand,
|
|
which may be an expression or the parenthesized name of a type. The
|
|
size is determined from the type of the operand, which is not itself
|
|
evaluated. The result is an integer constant.
|
|
|
|
When applied to an operand that has type char , unsigned char , or
|
|
signed char , (or a qualified version thereof) the result is 1. When
|
|
applied to an operand that has array type, the result is the total
|
|
number of bytes in the array./35/ When applied to an operand that has
|
|
structure or union type, the result is the total number of bytes in
|
|
such an object, including internal and trailing padding.
|
|
|
|
The value of the result is implementation-defined, and its type (an
|
|
unsigned integral type) is size_t defined in the <stddef.h> header.
|
|
|
|
Examples
|
|
|
|
A principal use of the sizeof operator is in communication with
|
|
routines such as storage allocators and I/O systems. A
|
|
storage-allocation function might accept a size (in bytes) of an
|
|
object to allocate and return a pointer to void. For example:
|
|
|
|
extern void *alloc();
|
|
double *dp = alloc(sizeof *dp);
|
|
|
|
The implementation of the alloc function should ensure that its return
|
|
value is aligned suitably for conversion to a pointer to double.
|
|
|
|
Another use of the sizeof operator is to compute the number of
|
|
members in an array:
|
|
|
|
sizeof array / sizeof array[0]
|
|
|
|
Forward references: common definitions <stddef.h> ($4.1.5),
|
|
declarations ($3.5), structure and union specifiers ($3.5.2.1), type
|
|
names ($3.5.5).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.3.4 Cast operators
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
cast-expression:
|
|
unary-expression
|
|
( type-name ) cast-expression
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
Unless the type name specifies void type, the type name shall
|
|
specify qualified or unqualified scalar type and the operand shall
|
|
have scalar type.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
Preceding an expression by a parenthesized type name converts the
|
|
value of the expression to the named type. This construction is
|
|
called a cast. /36/ A cast that specifies an implicit conversion or no
|
|
conversion has no effect on the type or value of an expression.
|
|
|
|
Conversions that involve pointers (other than as permitted by the
|
|
constraints of $3.3.16.1) shall be specified by means of an explicit
|
|
cast; they have implementation-defined aspects: A pointer may be
|
|
converted to an integral type. The size of integer required and the
|
|
result are implementation-defined. If the space provided is not long
|
|
enough, the behavior is undefined. An arbitrary integer may be
|
|
converted to a pointer. The result is implementation-defined./37/ A
|
|
pointer to an object or incomplete type may be converted to a pointer
|
|
to a different object type or a different incomplete type. The
|
|
resulting pointer might not be valid if it is improperly aligned for
|
|
the type pointed to. It is guaranteed, however, that a pointer to an
|
|
object of a given alignment may be converted to a pointer to an object
|
|
of the same alignment or a less strict alignment and back again; the
|
|
result shall compare equal to the original pointer. (An object that
|
|
has character type has the least strict alignment.) A pointer to a
|
|
function of one type may be converted to a pointer to a function of
|
|
another type and back again; the result shall compare equal to the
|
|
original pointer. If a converted pointer is used to call a function
|
|
that has a type that is not compatible with the type of the called
|
|
function, the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: equality operators ($3.3.9), function declarators
|
|
(including prototypes) ($3.5.4.3), simple assignment ($3.3.16.1), type
|
|
names ($3.5.5).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.3.5 Multiplicative operators
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
multiplicative-expression:
|
|
cast-expression
|
|
multiplicative-expression * cast-expression
|
|
multiplicative-expression / cast-expression
|
|
multiplicative-expression % cast-expression
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
Each of the operands shall have arithmetic type. The operands of
|
|
the % operator shall have integral type.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
The usual arithmetic conversions are performed on the operands.
|
|
|
|
The result of the binary * operator is the product of the operands.
|
|
|
|
The result of the / operator is the quotient from the division of
|
|
the first operand by the second; the result of the % operator is the
|
|
remainder. In both operations, if the value of the second operand is
|
|
zero, the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
When integers are divided and the division is inexact, if both
|
|
operands are positive the result of the / operator is the largest
|
|
integer less than the algebraic quotient and the result of the %
|
|
operator is positive. If either operand is negative, whether the
|
|
result of the / operator is the largest integer less than the
|
|
algebraic quotient or the smallest integer greater than the algebraic
|
|
quotient is implementation-defined, as is the sign of the result of
|
|
the % operator. If the quotient a/b is representable, the expression
|
|
(a/b)*b + a%b shall equal a .
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.3.6 Additive operators
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
additive-expression:
|
|
multiplicative-expression
|
|
additive-expression + multiplicative-expression
|
|
additive-expression - multiplicative-expression
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
For addition, either both operands shall have arithmetic type, or
|
|
one operand shall be a pointer to an object type and the other shall
|
|
have integral type. (Incrementing is equivalent to adding 1.)
|
|
|
|
For subtraction, one of the following shall hold:
|
|
|
|
* both operands have arithmetic type;
|
|
|
|
* both operands are pointers to qualified or unqualified versions of
|
|
compatible object types; or
|
|
|
|
* the left operand is a pointer to an object type and the right
|
|
operand has integral type. (Decrementing is equivalent to subtracting 1.)
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
If both operands have arithmetic type, the usual arithmetic
|
|
conversions are performed on them.
|
|
|
|
The result of the binary + operator is the sum of the operands.
|
|
|
|
The result of the binary - operator is the difference resulting
|
|
from the subtraction of the second operand from the first.
|
|
|
|
When an expression that has integral type is added to or subtracted
|
|
from a pointer, the integral value is first multiplied by the size of
|
|
the object pointed to. The result has the type of the pointer
|
|
operand. If the pointer operand points to a member of an array
|
|
object, and the array object is large enough, the result points to a
|
|
member of the same array object, appropriately offset from the
|
|
original member. Thus if P points to a member of an array object, the
|
|
expression P+1 points to the next member of the array object. Unless
|
|
both the pointer operand and the result point to a member of the same
|
|
array object, or one past the last member of the array object, the
|
|
behavior is undefined. Unless both the pointer operand and the result
|
|
point to a member of the same array object, or the pointer operand
|
|
points one past the last member of an array object and the result
|
|
points to a member of the same array object, the behavior is undefined
|
|
if the result is used as the operand of a unary * operator.
|
|
|
|
When two pointers to members of the same array object are
|
|
subtracted, the difference is divided by the size of a member. The
|
|
result represents the difference of the subscripts of the two array
|
|
members. The size of the result is implementation-defined, and its
|
|
type (a signed integral type) is ptrdiff_t defined in the <stddef.h>
|
|
header. As with any other arithmetic overflow, if the result does not
|
|
fit in the space provided, the behavior is undefined. If two pointers
|
|
that do not point to members of the same array object are subtracted,
|
|
the behavior is undefined. However, if P points either to a member of
|
|
an array object or one past the last member of an array object, and Q
|
|
points to the last member of the same array object, the expression
|
|
(Q+1) - P has the same value as (Q-P) + 1 , even though Q+1 does not
|
|
point to a member of the array object.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: common definitions <stddef.h> ($4.1.5).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.3.7 Bitwise shift operators
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
shift-expression:
|
|
additive-expression
|
|
shift-expression << additive-expression
|
|
shift-expression >> additive-expression
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
Each of the operands shall have integral type.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
The integral promotions are performed on each of the operands. The
|
|
type of the result is that of the promoted left operand. If the value
|
|
of the right operand is negative or is greater than or equal to the
|
|
width in bits of the promoted left operand, the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
The result of E1 << E2 is E1 left-shifted E2 bit positions; vacated
|
|
bits are filled with zeros. If E1 has an unsigned type, the value of
|
|
the result is E1 multiplied by the quantity, 2 raised to the power E2,
|
|
reduced modulo ULONG_MAX+1 if E1 has type unsigned long, UINT_MAX+1
|
|
otherwise. (The constants ULONG_MAX and UINT_MAX are defined in the
|
|
header <limits.h> .)
|
|
|
|
The result of E1 >> E2 is E1 right-shifted E2 bit positions. If E1
|
|
has an unsigned type or if E1 has a signed type and a nonnegative
|
|
value, the value of the result is the integral part of the quotient of
|
|
E1 divided by the quantity, 2 raised to the power E2 . If E1 has a
|
|
signed type and a negative value, the resulting value is
|
|
implementation-defined.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.3.8 Relational operators
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
relational-expression:
|
|
shift-expression
|
|
relational-expression < shift-expression
|
|
relational-expression > shift-expression
|
|
relational-expression <= shift-expression
|
|
relational-expression >= shift-expression
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
One of the following shall hold:
|
|
|
|
* both operands have arithmetic type;
|
|
|
|
* both operands are pointers to qualified or unqualified versions of
|
|
compatible object types; or
|
|
|
|
* both operands are pointers to qualified or unqualified versions of
|
|
compatible incomplete types.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
If both of the operands have arithmetic type, the usual arithmetic
|
|
conversions are performed.
|
|
|
|
When two pointers are compared, the result depends on the relative
|
|
locations in the address space of the objects pointed to. If the
|
|
objects pointed to are members of the same aggregate object, pointers
|
|
to structure members declared later compare higher than pointers to
|
|
members declared earlier in the structure, and pointers to array
|
|
elements with larger subscript values compare higher than pointers to
|
|
elements of the same array with lower subscript values. All pointers
|
|
to members of the same union object compare equal. If the objects
|
|
pointed to are not members of the same aggregate or union object, the
|
|
result is undefined, with the following exception. If P points to the
|
|
last member of an array object and Q points to a member of the same
|
|
array object, the pointer expression P+1 compares higher than Q , even
|
|
though P+1 does not point to a member of the array object.
|
|
|
|
Each of the operators < (less than), > (greater than), <= (less
|
|
than or equal to), and >= (greater than or equal to) shall yield 1 if
|
|
the specified relation is true and 0 if it is false./38/ The result
|
|
has type int.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.3.9 Equality operators
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
equality-expression:
|
|
relational-expression
|
|
equality-expression == relational-expression
|
|
equality-expression != relational-expression
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
One of the following shall hold:
|
|
|
|
* both operands have arithmetic type;
|
|
|
|
* both operands are pointers to qualified or unqualified versions of
|
|
compatible types;
|
|
|
|
* one operand is a pointer to an object or incomplete type and the
|
|
other is a qualified or unqualified version of void ; or
|
|
|
|
* one operand is a pointer and the other is a null pointer constant.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
The == (equal to) and the != (not equal to) operators are analogous
|
|
to the relational operators except for their lower precedence./39/
|
|
|
|
If two pointers to object or incomplete types compare equal, they
|
|
point to the same object. If two pointers to functions compare equal,
|
|
they point to the same function. If two pointers point to the same
|
|
object or function, they compare equal./40/ If one of the operands is
|
|
a pointer to an object or incomplete type and the other has type
|
|
pointer to a qualified or unqualified version of void , the pointer to
|
|
an object or incomplete type is converted to the type of the other
|
|
operand.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.3.10 Bitwise AND operator
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
AND-expression:
|
|
equality-expression
|
|
AND-expression & equality-expression
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
Each of the operands shall have integral type.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
The usual arithmetic conversions are performed on the operands.
|
|
|
|
The result of the binary & operator is the bitwise AND of the
|
|
operands (that is, each bit in the result is set if and only if each
|
|
of the corresponding bits in the converted operands is set).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.3.11 Bitwise exclusive OR operator
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
exclusive-OR-expression:
|
|
AND-expression
|
|
exclusive-OR-expression ^ AND-expression
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
Each of the operands shall have integral type.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
The usual arithmetic conversions are performed on the operands.
|
|
|
|
The result of the ^ operator is the bitwise exclusive OR of the
|
|
operands (that is, each bit in the result is set if and only if
|
|
exactly one of the corresponding bits in the converted operands is
|
|
set).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.3.12 Bitwise inclusive OR operator
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
inclusive-OR-expression:
|
|
exclusive-OR-expression
|
|
inclusive-OR-expression | exclusive-OR-expression
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
Each of the operands shall have integral type.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
The usual arithmetic conversions are performed on the operands.
|
|
|
|
The result of the | operator is the bitwise inclusive OR of the
|
|
operands (that is, each bit in the result is set if and only if at
|
|
least one of the corresponding bits in the converted operands is set).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.3.13 Logical AND operator
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
logical-AND-expression:
|
|
inclusive-OR-expression
|
|
logical-AND-expression && inclusive-OR-expression
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
Each of the operands shall have scalar type.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
The && operator shall yield 1 if both of its operands compare
|
|
unequal to 0, otherwise it yields 0. The result has type int.
|
|
|
|
Unlike the bitwise binary & operator, the && operator guarantees
|
|
left-to-right evaluation; there is a sequence point after the
|
|
evaluation of the first operand. If the first operand compares equal
|
|
to 0, the second operand is not evaluated.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.3.14 Logical OR operator
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
logical-OR-expression:
|
|
logical-AND-expression
|
|
logical-OR-expression || logical-AND-expression
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
Each of the operands shall have scalar type.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
The || operator shall yield 1 if either of its operands compare
|
|
unequal to 0, otherwise it yields 0. The result has type int.
|
|
|
|
Unlike the bitwise | operator, the || operator guarantees
|
|
left-to-right evaluation; there is a sequence point after the
|
|
evaluation of the first operand. If the first operand compares
|
|
unequal to 0, the second operand is not evaluated.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.3.15 Conditional operator
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
conditional-expression:
|
|
logical-OR-expression
|
|
logical-OR-expression ? expression : conditional-expression
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
The first operand shall have scalar type.
|
|
|
|
One of the following shall hold for the second and third operands:
|
|
|
|
* both operands have arithmetic type;
|
|
|
|
* both operands have compatible structure or union types;
|
|
|
|
* both operands have void type;
|
|
|
|
* both operands are pointers to qualified or unqualified versions of
|
|
compatible types;
|
|
|
|
* one operand is a pointer and the other is a null pointer constant; or
|
|
|
|
* one operand is a pointer to an object or incomplete type and the
|
|
other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified version of void .
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
The first operand is evaluated; there is a sequence point after its
|
|
evaluation. The second operand is evaluated only if the first
|
|
compares unequal to 0; the third operand is evaluated only if the
|
|
first compares equal to 0; the value of the second or third operand
|
|
(whichever is evaluated) is the result./41/
|
|
|
|
If both the second and third operands have arithmetic type, the
|
|
usual arithmetic conversions are performed to bring them to a common
|
|
type and the result has that type. If both the operands have
|
|
structure or union type, the result has that type. If both operands
|
|
have void type, the result has void type.
|
|
|
|
If both the second and third operands are pointers or one is a null
|
|
pointer constant and the other is a pointer, the result type is a
|
|
pointer to a type qualified with all the type qualifiers of the types
|
|
pointed-to by both operands. Furthermore, if both operands are
|
|
pointers to compatible types or differently qualified versions of a
|
|
compatible type, the result has the composite type; if one operand is
|
|
a null pointer constant, the result has the type of the other operand;
|
|
otherwise, one operand is a pointer to void or a qualified version of
|
|
void, in which case the other operand is converted to type pointer to
|
|
void, and the result has that type.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.3.16 Assignment operators
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
assignment-expression:
|
|
conditional-expression
|
|
unary-expression assignment-operator assignment-expression
|
|
|
|
assignment-operator: one of
|
|
= *= /= %= += -= <<= >>= &= ^= |=
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
An assignment operator shall have a modifiable lvalue as its left operand.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
An assignment operator stores a value in the object designated by
|
|
the left operand. An assignment expression has the value of the left
|
|
operand after the assignment, but is not an lvalue. The type of an
|
|
assignment expression is the type of the left operand unless the left
|
|
operand has qualified type, in which case it is the unqualified
|
|
version of the type of the left operand. The side effect of updating
|
|
the stored value of the left operand shall occur between the previous
|
|
and the next sequence point.
|
|
|
|
The order of evaluation of the operands is unspecified.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.3.16.1 Simple assignment
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
One of the following shall hold:/42/
|
|
|
|
* the left operand has qualified or unqualified arithmetic type and
|
|
the right has arithmetic type;
|
|
|
|
* the left operand has a qualified or unqualified version of a
|
|
structure or union type compatible with the type of the right;
|
|
|
|
* both operands are pointers to qualified or unqualified versions of
|
|
compatible types, and the type pointed to by the left has all the
|
|
qualifiers of the type pointed to by the right;
|
|
|
|
* one operand is a pointer to an object or incomplete type and the
|
|
other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified version of void, and
|
|
the type pointed to by the left has all the qualifiers of the type
|
|
pointed to by the right; or
|
|
|
|
* the left operand is a pointer and the right is a null pointer constant.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
In simple assignment ( = ), the value of the right operand is
|
|
converted to the type of the assignment expression and replaces the
|
|
value stored in the object designated by the left operand.
|
|
|
|
If the value being stored in an object is accessed from another
|
|
object that overlaps in any way the storage of the first object, then
|
|
the overlap shall be exact and the two objects shall have qualified or
|
|
unqualified versions of a compatible type; otherwise the behavior is
|
|
undefined.
|
|
|
|
Example
|
|
|
|
In the program fragment
|
|
|
|
int f(void);
|
|
char c;
|
|
/*...*/
|
|
/*...*/ ((c = f()) == -1) /*...*/
|
|
|
|
the int value returned by the function may be truncated when stored in
|
|
the char, and then converted back to int width prior to the
|
|
comparison. In an implementation in which ``plain'' char has the same
|
|
range of values as unsigned char (and char is narrower than int ), the
|
|
result of the conversion cannot be negative, so the operands of the
|
|
comparison can never compare equal. Therefore, for full portability
|
|
the variable c should be declared as int.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.3.16.2 Compound assignment
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
For the operators += and -= only, either the left operand shall be
|
|
a pointer to an object type and the right shall have integral type, or
|
|
the left operand shall have qualified or unqualified arithmetic type
|
|
and the right shall have arithmetic type.
|
|
|
|
For the other operators, each operand shall have arithmetic type
|
|
consistent with those allowed by the corresponding binary operator.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
A compound assignment of the form E1 op = E2 differs from the
|
|
simple assignment expression E1 = E1 op (E2) only in that the lvalue
|
|
E1 is evaluated only once.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.3.17 Comma operator
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
expression:
|
|
assignment-expression
|
|
expression , assignment-expression
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
The left operand of a comma operator is evaluated as a void
|
|
expression; there is a sequence point after its evaluation. Then the
|
|
right operand is evaluated; the result has its type and value./43/
|
|
|
|
Example
|
|
|
|
As indicated by the syntax, in contexts where a comma is a
|
|
punctuator (in lists of arguments to functions and lists of
|
|
initializers) the comma operator as described in this section cannot
|
|
appear. On the other hand, it can be used within a parenthesized
|
|
expression or within the second expression of a conditional operator
|
|
in such contexts. In the function call
|
|
|
|
f(a, (t=3, t+2), c)
|
|
|
|
the function has three arguments, the second of which has the value 5.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: initialization ($3.5.7).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.4 CONSTANT EXPRESSIONS
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
constant-expression:
|
|
conditional-expression
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
A constant expression can be evaluated during translation rather
|
|
than runtime, and accordingly may be used in any place that a constant
|
|
may be.
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
Constant expressions shall not contain assignment, increment,
|
|
decrement, function-call, or comma operators, except when they are
|
|
contained within the operand of a sizeof operator./44/
|
|
|
|
Each constant expression shall evaluate to a constant that is in
|
|
the range of representable values for its type.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
An expression that evaluates to a constant is required in several
|
|
contexts./45/ If the expression is evaluated in the translation
|
|
environment, the arithmetic precision and range shall be at least as
|
|
great as if the expression were being evaluated in the execution
|
|
environment.
|
|
|
|
An integral constant expression shall have integral type and shall
|
|
only have operands that are integer constants, enumeration constants,
|
|
character constants, sizeof expressions, and floating constants that
|
|
are the immediate operands of casts. Cast operators in an integral
|
|
constant expression shall only convert arithmetic types to integral
|
|
types, except as part of an operand to the sizeof operator.
|
|
|
|
More latitude is permitted for constant expressions in
|
|
initializers. Such a constant expression shall evaluate to one of the
|
|
following:
|
|
|
|
* an arithmetic constant expression,
|
|
|
|
* an address constant, or
|
|
|
|
* an address constant for an object type plus or minus an integral
|
|
constant expression.
|
|
|
|
An arithmetic constant expression shall have arithmetic type and
|
|
shall only have operands that are integer constants, floating
|
|
constants, enumeration constants, character constants, and sizeof
|
|
expressions. Cast operators in an arithmetic constant expression
|
|
shall only convert arithmetic types to arithmetic types, except as
|
|
part of an operand to the sizeof operator.
|
|
|
|
An address constant is a pointer to an lvalue designating an object
|
|
of static storage duration, or to a function designator; it shall be
|
|
created explicitly, using the unary & operator, or implicitly, by the
|
|
use of an expression of array or function type. The array-subscript
|
|
[] and member-access . and -> operators, the address & and
|
|
indirection * unary operators, and pointer casts may be used in the
|
|
creation an address constant, but the value of an object shall not be
|
|
accessed by use of these operators.
|
|
|
|
The semantic rules for the evaluation of a constant expression are
|
|
the same as for non-constant expressions./46/
|
|
|
|
Forward references: initialization ($3.5.7).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.5 DECLARATIONS
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
declaration:
|
|
declaration-specifiers init-declarator-list<opt> ;
|
|
|
|
declaration-specifiers:
|
|
storage-class-specifier declaration-specifiers<opt>
|
|
type-specifier declaration-specifiers<opt>
|
|
type-qualifier declaration-specifiers<opt>
|
|
|
|
init-declarator-list:
|
|
init-declarator
|
|
init-declarator-list , init-declarator
|
|
|
|
init-declarator:
|
|
declarator
|
|
declarator = initializer
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
A declaration shall declare at least a declarator, a tag, or the
|
|
members of an enumeration.
|
|
|
|
If an identifier has no linkage, there shall be no more than one
|
|
declaration of the identifier (in a declarator or type specifier) with
|
|
the same scope and in the same name space, except for tags as
|
|
specified in $3.5.2.3.
|
|
|
|
All declarations in the same scope that refer to the same object or
|
|
function shall specify compatible types.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
A declaration specifies the interpretation and attributes of a set
|
|
of identifiers. A declaration that also causes storage to be reserved
|
|
for an object or function named by an identifier is a definition ./47/
|
|
|
|
The declaration specifiers consist of a sequence of specifiers that
|
|
indicate the linkage, storage duration, and part of the type of the
|
|
entities that the declarators denote. The init-declarator-list is a
|
|
comma-separated sequence of declarators, each of which may have
|
|
additional type information, or an initializer, or both. The
|
|
declarators contain the identifiers (if any) being declared.
|
|
|
|
If an identifier for an object is declared with no linkage, the
|
|
type for the object shall be complete by the end of its declarator, or
|
|
by the end of its init-declarator if it has an initializer.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: declarators ($3.5.4), enumeration specifiers
|
|
($3.5.2.2), initialization ($3.5.7), tags ($3.5.2.3).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.5.1 Storage-class specifiers
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
storage-class-specifier:
|
|
typedef
|
|
extern
|
|
static
|
|
auto
|
|
register
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
At most one storage-class specifier may be given in the declaration
|
|
specifiers in a declaration./48/
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
The typedef specifier is called a ``storage-class specifier'' for
|
|
syntactic convenience only; it is discussed in $3.5.6. The meanings
|
|
of the various linkages and storage durations were discussed in
|
|
$3.1.2.2 and $3.1.2.4.
|
|
|
|
A declaration of an identifier for an object with storage-class
|
|
specifier register suggests that access to the object be as fast as
|
|
possible. The extent to which such suggestions are effective is
|
|
implementation-defined./49/
|
|
|
|
The declaration of an identifier for a function that has block
|
|
scope shall have no explicit storage-class specifier other than extern.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: type definitions ($3.5.6).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.5.2 Type specifiers
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
type-specifier:
|
|
void
|
|
char
|
|
short
|
|
int
|
|
long
|
|
float
|
|
double
|
|
signed
|
|
unsigned
|
|
struct-or-union-specifier
|
|
enum-specifier
|
|
typedef-name
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
Each list of type specifiers shall be one of the following sets; the
|
|
type specifiers may occur in any order, possibly intermixed with the
|
|
other declaration specifiers.
|
|
|
|
* void
|
|
|
|
* char
|
|
|
|
* signed char
|
|
|
|
* unsigned char
|
|
|
|
* short , signed short , short int , or signed short int
|
|
|
|
* unsigned short , or unsigned short int
|
|
|
|
* int , signed , signed int , or no type specifiers
|
|
|
|
* unsigned , or unsigned int
|
|
|
|
* long , signed long , long int , or signed long int
|
|
|
|
* unsigned long , or unsigned long int
|
|
|
|
* float
|
|
|
|
* double
|
|
|
|
* long double
|
|
|
|
* struct-or-union specifier
|
|
|
|
* enum-specifier
|
|
|
|
* typedef-name
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
Specifiers for structures, unions, and enumerations are discussed
|
|
in $3.5.2.1 through $3.5.2.3. Declarations of typedef names are
|
|
discussed in $3.5.6. The characteristics of the other types are
|
|
discussed in $3.1.2.5.
|
|
|
|
Each of the above comma-separated lists designates the same type,
|
|
except that for bit-field declarations, signed int (or signed ) may
|
|
differ from int (or no type specifiers).
|
|
|
|
Forward references: enumeration specifiers ($3.5.2.2), structure and
|
|
union specifiers ($3.5.2.1), tags ($3.5.2.3), type definitions ($3.5.6).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.5.2.1 Structure and union specifiers
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
struct-or-union-specifier:
|
|
struct-or-union identifier<opt> { struct-declaration-list }
|
|
struct-or-union identifier
|
|
|
|
struct-or-union:
|
|
struct
|
|
union
|
|
|
|
struct-declaration-list:
|
|
struct-declaration
|
|
struct-declaration-list struct-declaration
|
|
|
|
struct-declaration:
|
|
specifier-qualifier-list struct-declarator-list ;
|
|
|
|
specifier-qualifier-list:
|
|
type-specifier specifier-qualifier-list<opt>
|
|
type-qualifier specifier-qualifier-list<opt>
|
|
|
|
struct-declarator-list:
|
|
struct-declarator
|
|
struct-declarator-list , struct-declarator
|
|
|
|
struct-declarator:
|
|
declarator
|
|
declarator<opt> : constant-expression
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
A structure or union shall not contain a member with incomplete or
|
|
function type. Hence it shall not contain an instance of itself (but
|
|
may contain a pointer to an instance of itself).
|
|
|
|
The expression that specifies the width of a bit-field shall be an
|
|
integral constant expression that has nonnegative value that shall not
|
|
exceed the number of bits in an ordinary object of compatible type.
|
|
If the value is zero, the declaration shall have no declarator.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
As discussed in $3.1.2.5, a structure is a type consisting of a
|
|
sequence of named members, whose storage is allocated in an ordered
|
|
sequence, and a union is a type consisting of a sequence of named
|
|
members, whose storage overlap.
|
|
|
|
Structure and union specifiers have the same form.
|
|
|
|
The presence of a struct-declaration-list in a
|
|
struct-or-union-specifier declares a new type, within a translation
|
|
unit. The struct-declaration-list is a sequence of declarations for
|
|
the members of the structure or union. The type is incomplete until
|
|
after the } that terminates the list.
|
|
|
|
A member of a structure or union may have any object type. In
|
|
addition, a member may be declared to consist of a specified number of
|
|
bits (including a sign bit, if any). Such a member is called a
|
|
bit-field ;/50/ its width is preceded by a colon.
|
|
|
|
A bit-field may have type int , unsigned int , or signed int .
|
|
Whether the high-order bit position of a ``plain'' int bit-field is
|
|
treated as a sign bit is implementation-defined. A bit-field is
|
|
interpreted as an integral type consisting of the specified number of
|
|
bits.
|
|
|
|
An implementation may allocate any addressable storage unit large
|
|
enough to hold a bit-field. If enough space remains, a bit-field that
|
|
immediately follows another bit-field in a structure shall be packed
|
|
into adjacent bits of the same unit. If insufficient space remains,
|
|
whether a bit-field that does not fit is put into the next unit or
|
|
overlaps adjacent units is implementation-defined. The order of
|
|
allocation of bit-fields within a unit (high-order to low-order or
|
|
low-order to high-order) is implementation-defined. The alignment of
|
|
the addressable storage unit is unspecified.
|
|
|
|
A bit-field declaration with no declarator, but only a colon and a
|
|
width, indicates an unnamed bit-field./51/ As a special case of this,
|
|
a bit-field with a width of 0 indicates that no further bit-field is
|
|
to be packed into the unit in which the previous bit-field, if any,
|
|
was placed.
|
|
|
|
Each non-bit-field member of a structure or union object is aligned
|
|
in an implementation-defined manner appropriate to its type.
|
|
|
|
Within a structure object, the non-bit-field members and the units
|
|
in which bit-fields reside have addresses that increase in the order
|
|
in which they are declared. A pointer to a structure object, suitably
|
|
cast, points to its initial member (or if that member is a bit-field,
|
|
then to the unit in which it resides), and vice versa. There may
|
|
therefore be unnamed holes within a structure object, but not at its
|
|
beginning, as necessary to achieve the appropriate alignment.
|
|
|
|
The size of a union is sufficient to contain the largest of its
|
|
members. The value of at most one of the members can be stored in a
|
|
union object at any time. A pointer to a union object, suitably cast,
|
|
points to each of its members (or if a member is a bit-field, then to
|
|
the unit in which it resides), and vice versa.
|
|
|
|
There may also be unnamed padding at the end of a structure or
|
|
union, as necessary to achieve the appropriate alignment were the
|
|
structure or union to be a member of an array.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.5.2.2 Enumeration specifiers
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
enum-specifier:
|
|
enum identifier<opt> { enumerator-list }
|
|
enum identifier
|
|
|
|
enumerator-list:
|
|
enumerator
|
|
enumerator-list , enumerator
|
|
|
|
enumerator:
|
|
enumeration-constant
|
|
enumeration-constant = constant-expression
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
The expression that defines the value of an enumeration constant
|
|
shall be an integral constant expression that has a value
|
|
representable as an int.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
The identifiers in an enumerator list are declared as constants
|
|
that have type int and may appear wherever such are permitted./52/ An
|
|
enumerator with = defines its enumeration constant as the value of the
|
|
constant expression. If the first enumerator has no = , the value of
|
|
its enumeration constant is 0. Each subsequent enumerator with no =
|
|
defines its enumeration constant as the value of the constant
|
|
expression obtained by adding 1 to the value of the previous
|
|
enumeration constant. (A combination of both forms of enumerators may
|
|
produce enumeration constants with values that duplicate other values
|
|
in the same enumeration.) The enumerators of an enumeration are also
|
|
known as its members.
|
|
|
|
Each enumerated type shall be compatible with an integer type; the
|
|
choice of type is implementation-defined.
|
|
|
|
Example
|
|
|
|
enum hue { chartreuse, burgundy, claret=20, winedark };
|
|
/*...*/
|
|
enum hue col, *cp;
|
|
/*...*/
|
|
col = claret;
|
|
cp = &col;
|
|
/*...*/
|
|
/*...*/ (*cp != burgundy) /*...*/
|
|
|
|
makes hue the tag of an enumeration, and then declares col as an
|
|
object that has that type and cp as a pointer to an object that has
|
|
that type. The enumerated values are in the set {0, 1, 20, 21}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.5.2.3 Tags
|
|
|
|
A type specifier of the form
|
|
|
|
struct-or-union identifier { struct-declaration-list }
|
|
enum identifier { enumerator-list }
|
|
|
|
declares the identifier to be the tag of the structure, union, or
|
|
enumeration specified by the list. The list defines the structure
|
|
content ,union content ,or enumeration content .If this declaration of
|
|
the tag is visible, a subsequent declaration that uses the tag and
|
|
that omits the bracketed list specifies the declared structure, union,
|
|
or enumerated type. Subsequent declarations in the same scope shall
|
|
omit the bracketed list.
|
|
|
|
If a type specifier of the form
|
|
|
|
struct-or-union identifier
|
|
|
|
occurs prior to the declaration that defines the content, the
|
|
structure or union is an incomplete type./53/ It declares a tag that
|
|
specifies a type that may be used only when the size of an object of
|
|
the specified type is not needed./54/ If the type is to be completed,
|
|
another declaration of the tag in the same scope (but not in an
|
|
enclosed block, which declares a new type known only within that
|
|
block) shall define the content. A declaration of the form
|
|
|
|
struct-or-union identifier ;
|
|
|
|
specifies a structure or union type and declares a tag, both visible
|
|
only within the scope in which the declaration occurs. It specifies a
|
|
new type distinct from any type with the same tag in an enclosing
|
|
scope (if any).
|
|
|
|
A type specifier of the form
|
|
|
|
struct-or-union { struct-declaration-list }
|
|
enum { enumerator-list }
|
|
|
|
specifies a new structure, union, or enumerated type, within the
|
|
translation unit, that can only be referred to by the declaration of
|
|
which it is a part./55/
|
|
|
|
Examples
|
|
|
|
This mechanism allows declaration of a self-referential structure.
|
|
|
|
struct tnode {
|
|
int count;
|
|
struct tnode *left, *right;
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
specifies a structure that contains an integer and two pointers to
|
|
objects of the same type. Once this declaration has been given, the
|
|
declaration
|
|
|
|
struct tnode s, *sp;
|
|
|
|
declares s to be an object of the given type and sp to be a pointer to
|
|
an object of the given type. With these declarations, the expression
|
|
sp->left refers to the left struct tnode pointer of the object to
|
|
which sp points; the expression s.right->count designates the count
|
|
member of the right struct tnode pointed to from s .
|
|
|
|
The following alternative formulation uses the typedef mechanism:
|
|
|
|
typedef struct tnode TNODE;
|
|
struct tnode {
|
|
int count;
|
|
TNODE *left, *right;
|
|
};
|
|
TNODE s, *sp;
|
|
|
|
To illustrate the use of prior declaration of a tag to specify a
|
|
pair of mutually-referential structures, the declarations
|
|
|
|
struct s1 { struct s2 *s2p; /*...*/ }; /* D1 */
|
|
struct s2 { struct s1 *s1p; /*...*/ }; /* D2 */
|
|
|
|
specify a pair of structures that contain pointers to each other.
|
|
Note, however, that if s2 were already declared as a tag in an
|
|
enclosing scope, the declaration D1 would refer to it, not to the tag
|
|
s2 declared in D2 . To eliminate this context sensitivity, the
|
|
otherwise vacuous declaration
|
|
|
|
struct s2;
|
|
|
|
may be inserted ahead of D1. This declares a new tag s2 in the inner
|
|
scope; the declaration D2 then completes the specification of the new type.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: type definitions ($3.5.6).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.5.3 Type qualifiers
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
type-qualifier:
|
|
const
|
|
volatile
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
The same type qualifier shall not appear more than once in the same
|
|
specifier list or qualifier list, either directly or via one or more
|
|
typedef s.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
The properties associated with qualified types are meaningful only
|
|
for expressions that are lvalues./56/
|
|
|
|
If an attempt is made to modify an object defined with a
|
|
const-qualified type through use of an lvalue with non-const-qualified
|
|
type, the behavior is undefined. If an attempt is made to refer to an
|
|
object defined with a volatile-qualified type through use of an lvalue
|
|
with non-volatile-qualified type, the behavior is undefined./57/
|
|
|
|
An object that has volatile-qualified type may be modified in ways
|
|
unknown to the implementation or have other unknown side effects.
|
|
Therefore any expression referring to such an object shall be
|
|
evaluated strictly according to the rules of the abstract machine, as
|
|
described in $2.1.2.3. Furthermore, at every sequence point the value
|
|
last stored in the object shall agree with that prescribed by the
|
|
abstract machine, except as modified by the unknown factors mentioned
|
|
previously./58/ What constitutes an access to an object that has
|
|
volatile-qualified type is implementation-defined.
|
|
|
|
If the specification of an array type includes any type qualifiers,
|
|
the element type is so-qualified, not the array type. If the
|
|
specification of a function type includes any type qualifiers, the
|
|
behavior is undefined./59/
|
|
|
|
For two qualified types to be compatible, both shall have the
|
|
identically qualified version of a compatible type; the order of type
|
|
qualifiers within a list of specifiers or qualifiers does not affect
|
|
the specified type.
|
|
|
|
Examples
|
|
|
|
An object declared
|
|
|
|
extern const volatile int real_time_clock;
|
|
|
|
may be modifiable by hardware, but cannot be assigned to, incremented,
|
|
or decremented.
|
|
|
|
The following declarations and expressions illustrate the behavior
|
|
when type qualifiers modify an aggregate type:
|
|
|
|
const struct s { int mem; } cs = { 1 };
|
|
struct s ncs; /* the object ncs is modifiable */
|
|
typedef int A[2][3];
|
|
const A a = {{4, 5, 6}, {7, 8, 9}}; /* array of array of const int */
|
|
int *pi;
|
|
const int *pci;
|
|
|
|
ncs = cs; /* valid */
|
|
cs = ncs; /* violates modifiable lvalue constraint for = */
|
|
pi = &ncs.mem; /* valid */
|
|
pi = &cs.mem; /* violates type constraints for = */
|
|
pci = &cs.mem; /* valid */
|
|
pi = a[0]; /* invalid: a[0] has type ``const int * '' */
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.5.4 Declarators
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
declarator:
|
|
pointer<opt> direct-declarator
|
|
|
|
direct-declarator:
|
|
identifier
|
|
( declarator )
|
|
direct-declarator [ constant-expression<opt> ]
|
|
|
|
direct-declarator ( parameter-type-list )
|
|
direct-declarator ( identifier-list<opt> )
|
|
|
|
pointer:
|
|
* type-qualifier-list<opt>
|
|
* type-qualifier-list<opt> pointer
|
|
|
|
type-qualifier-list:
|
|
type-qualifier
|
|
type-qualifier-list type-qualifier
|
|
|
|
parameter-type-list:
|
|
parameter-list
|
|
parameter-list , ...
|
|
|
|
parameter-list:
|
|
parameter-declaration
|
|
parameter-list , parameter-declaration
|
|
|
|
parameter-declaration:
|
|
declaration-specifiers declarator
|
|
declaration-specifiers abstract-declarator<opt>
|
|
|
|
identifier-list:
|
|
identifier
|
|
identifier-list , identifier
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
Each declarator declares one identifier, and asserts that when an
|
|
operand of the same form as the declarator appears in an expression,
|
|
it designates a function or object with the scope, storage duration,
|
|
and type indicated by the declaration specifiers.
|
|
|
|
In the following subsections, consider a declaration
|
|
|
|
T D1
|
|
|
|
where T contains the declaration specifiers that specify a type T
|
|
(such as int) and D1 is a declarator that contains an identifier
|
|
ident . The type specified for the identifier ident in the various
|
|
forms of declarator is described inductively using this notation.
|
|
|
|
If, in the declaration `` T D1 ,'' D1 has the form
|
|
|
|
identifier
|
|
|
|
then the type specified for ident is T .
|
|
|
|
If, in the declaration `` T D1 ,'' D1 has the form
|
|
|
|
( D )
|
|
|
|
then ident has the type specified by the declaration `` T D .'' Thus,
|
|
a declarator in parentheses is identical to the unparenthesized
|
|
declarator, but the binding of complex declarators may be altered by
|
|
parentheses.
|
|
|
|
"Implementation limits"
|
|
|
|
The implementation shall allow the specification of types that have
|
|
at least 12 pointer, array, and function declarators (in any valid
|
|
combinations) modifying an arithmetic, a structure, a union, or an
|
|
incomplete type, either directly or via one or more typedef s.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: type definitions ($3.5.6).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.5.4.1 Pointer declarators
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
If, in the declaration `` T D1 ,'' D1 has the form
|
|
|
|
* type-qualifier-list<opt> D
|
|
|
|
and the type specified for ident in the declaration `` T D '' is ``
|
|
"derived-declarator-type-list T" ,'' then the type specified for ident
|
|
is `` "derived-declarator-type-list type-qualifier-list" pointer to T.''
|
|
For each type qualifier in the list, ident is a so-qualified pointer.
|
|
|
|
For two pointer types to be compatible, both shall be identically
|
|
qualified and both shall be pointers to compatible types.
|
|
|
|
Examples
|
|
|
|
The following pair of declarations demonstrates the difference
|
|
between a ``variable pointer to a constant value'' and a ``constant
|
|
pointer to a variable value.''
|
|
|
|
const int *ptr_to_constant;
|
|
int *const constant_ptr;
|
|
|
|
The contents of the const int pointed to by ptr_to_constant shall not
|
|
be modified, but ptr_to_constant itself may be changed to point to
|
|
another const int . Similarly, the contents of the int pointed to by
|
|
constant_ptr may be modified, but constant_ptr itself shall always
|
|
point to the same location.
|
|
|
|
The declaration of the constant pointer constant_ptr may be
|
|
clarified by including a definition for the type ``pointer to int .''
|
|
|
|
typedef int *int_ptr;
|
|
const int_ptr constant_ptr;
|
|
|
|
declares constant_ptr as an object that has type ``const-qualified
|
|
pointer to int .''
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.5.4.2 Array declarators
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
The expression that specifies the size of an array shall be an
|
|
integral constant expression that has a value greater than zero.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
If, in the declaration `` T D1 ,'' D1 has the form
|
|
|
|
D[ constant-expression<opt>]
|
|
|
|
and the type specified for ident in the declaration `` T D '' is ``
|
|
"derived-declarator-type-list T" ,'' then the type specified for ident
|
|
is `` derived-declarator-type-list array of T .''/60/ If the size is
|
|
not present, the array type is an incomplete type.
|
|
|
|
For two array types to be compatible, both shall have compatible
|
|
element types, and if both size specifiers are present, they shall
|
|
have the same value.
|
|
|
|
Examples
|
|
|
|
float fa[11], *afp[17];
|
|
|
|
declares an array of float numbers and an array of pointers to float
|
|
numbers.
|
|
|
|
Note the distinction between the declarations
|
|
|
|
extern int *x;
|
|
extern int y[];
|
|
|
|
The first declares x to be a pointer to int ; the second declares y to
|
|
be an array of int of unspecified size (an incomplete type), the
|
|
storage for which is defined elsewhere.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: function definitions ($3.7.1), initialization ($3.5.7).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.5.4.3 Function declarators (including prototypes)
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
A function declarator shall not specify a return type that is a
|
|
function type or an array type.
|
|
|
|
The only storage-class specifier that shall occur in a parameter
|
|
declaration is register.
|
|
|
|
An identifier list in a function declarator that is not part of a
|
|
function definition shall be empty.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
If, in the declaration `` T D1 ,'' D1 has the form
|
|
|
|
D( parameter-type-list)
|
|
D( identifier-list<opt>)
|
|
|
|
and the type specified for ident in the declaration `` T D '' is ``
|
|
"derived-declarator-type-list T" ,'' then the type specified for ident
|
|
is `` derived-declarator-type-list function returning T .''
|
|
|
|
A parameter type list specifies the types of, and may declare
|
|
identifiers for, the parameters of the function. If the list
|
|
terminates with an ellipsis ( , ... ), no information about the number
|
|
or types of the parameters after the comma is supplied./61/ The
|
|
special case of void as the only item in the list specifies that the
|
|
function has no parameters.
|
|
|
|
In a parameter declaration, a single typedef name in parentheses is
|
|
taken to be an abstract declarator that specifies a function with a
|
|
single parameter, not as redundant parentheses around the identifier
|
|
for a declarator.
|
|
|
|
The storage-class specifier in the declaration specifiers for a
|
|
parameter declaration, if present, is ignored unless the declared
|
|
parameter is one of the members of the parameter type list for a
|
|
function definition.
|
|
|
|
An identifier list declares only the identifiers of the parameters
|
|
of the function. An empty list in a function declarator that is part
|
|
of a function definition specifies that the function has no
|
|
parameters. The empty list in a function declarator that is not part
|
|
of a function definition specifies that no information about the
|
|
number or types of the parameters is supplied./62/
|
|
|
|
For two function types to be compatible, both shall specify
|
|
compatible return types./63/ Moreover, the parameter type lists, if
|
|
both are present, shall agree in the number of parameters and in use
|
|
of the ellipsis terminator; corresponding parameters shall have
|
|
compatible types. If one type has a parameter type list and the other
|
|
type is specified by a function declarator that is not part of a
|
|
function definition and that contains an empty identifier list, the
|
|
parameter list shall not have an ellipsis terminator and the type of
|
|
each parameter shall be compatible with the type that results from the
|
|
application of the default argument promotions. If one type has a
|
|
parameter type list and the other type is specified by a function
|
|
definition that contains a (possibly empty) identifier list, both
|
|
shall agree in the number of parameters, and the type of each
|
|
prototype parameter shall be compatible with the type that results
|
|
from the application of the default argument promotions to the type of
|
|
the corresponding identifier. (For each parameter declared with
|
|
function or array type, its type for these comparisons is the one that
|
|
results from conversion to a pointer type, as in $3.7.1. For each
|
|
parameter declared with qualified type, its type for these comparisons
|
|
is the unqualified version of its declared type.)
|
|
|
|
Examples
|
|
|
|
The declaration
|
|
|
|
int f(void), *fip(), (*pfi)();
|
|
|
|
declares a function f with no parameters returning an int , a function
|
|
fip with no parameter specification returning a pointer to an int ,
|
|
and a pointer pfi to a function with no parameter specification
|
|
returning an int . It is especially useful to compare the last two.
|
|
The binding of *fip() is *(fip()) , so that the declaration suggests,
|
|
and the same construction in an expression requires, the calling of a
|
|
function fip , and then using indirection through the pointer result
|
|
to yield an int . In the declarator (*pfi)() , the extra parentheses
|
|
are necessary to indicate that indirection through a pointer to a
|
|
function yields a function designator, which is then used to call the
|
|
function; it returns an int.
|
|
|
|
If the declaration occurs outside of any function, the identifiers
|
|
have file scope and external linkage. If the declaration occurs
|
|
inside a function, the identifiers of the functions f and fip have
|
|
block scope and external linkage, and the identifier of the pointer
|
|
pfi has block scope and no linkage.
|
|
|
|
Here are two more intricate examples.
|
|
|
|
int (*apfi[3])(int *x, int *y);
|
|
|
|
declares an array apfi of three pointers to functions returning int .
|
|
Each of these functions has two parameters that are pointers to int .
|
|
The identifiers x and y are declared for descriptive purposes only and
|
|
go out of scope at the end of the declaration of apfi . The
|
|
declaration
|
|
|
|
int (*fpfi(int (*)(long), int))(int, ...);
|
|
|
|
declares a function fpfi that returns a pointer to a function
|
|
returning an int. The function fpfi has two parameters: a pointer to
|
|
a function returning an int (with one parameter of type long ), and an
|
|
int . The pointer returned by fpfi points to a function that has at
|
|
least one parameter, which has type int .
|
|
|
|
Forward references: function definitions ($3.7.1), type names ($3.5.5).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.5.5 Type names
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
type-name:
|
|
specifier-qualifier-list abstract-declarator<opt>
|
|
|
|
abstract-declarator:
|
|
pointer
|
|
pointer<opt> direct-abstract-declarator
|
|
|
|
direct-abstract-declarator:
|
|
( abstract-declarator )
|
|
direct-abstract-declarator<opt> [ constant-expression<opt> ]
|
|
direct-abstract-declarator<opt> ( parameter-type-list<opt> )
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
In several contexts it is desired to specify a type. This is
|
|
accomplished using a type name, which is syntactically a declaration
|
|
for a function or an object of that type that omits the
|
|
identifier./64/
|
|
|
|
Examples
|
|
|
|
The constructions
|
|
|
|
(a) int
|
|
(b) int *
|
|
(c) int *[3]
|
|
(d) int (*)[3]
|
|
(e) int *()
|
|
(f) int (*)(void)
|
|
(g) int (*const [])(unsigned int, ...)
|
|
|
|
name respectively the types (a) int , (b) pointer to int , (c) array
|
|
of three pointers to int , (d) pointer to an array of three int's, (e)
|
|
function with no parameter specification returning a pointer to int ,
|
|
(f) pointer to function with no parameters returning an int , and (g)
|
|
array of an unspecified number of constant pointers to functions, each
|
|
with one parameter that has type unsigned int and an unspecified
|
|
number of other parameters, returning an int .
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.5.6 Type definitions
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
typedef-name:
|
|
identifier
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
In a declaration whose storage-class specifier is typedef , each
|
|
declarator defines an identifier to be a typedef name that specifies
|
|
the type specified for the identifier in the way described in $3.5.4.
|
|
A typedef declaration does not introduce a new type, only a synonym
|
|
for the type so specified. That is, in the following declarations:
|
|
|
|
typedef T type_ident;
|
|
type_ident D;
|
|
|
|
type_ident is defined as a typedef name with the type specified by the
|
|
declaration specifiers in T (known as T ), and the identifier in D has
|
|
the type `` "derived-declarator-type-list T" '' where the
|
|
derived-declarator-type-list is specified by the declarators of D . A
|
|
typedef name shares the same name space as other identifiers declared
|
|
in ordinary declarators. If the identifier is redeclared in an inner
|
|
scope or is declared as a member of a structure or union in the same
|
|
or an inner scope, the type specifiers shall not be omitted in the
|
|
inner declaration.
|
|
|
|
Examples
|
|
|
|
After
|
|
|
|
typedef int MILES, KLICKSP();
|
|
typedef struct { double re, im; } complex;
|
|
|
|
the constructions
|
|
|
|
MILES distance;
|
|
extern KLICKSP *metricp;
|
|
complex x;
|
|
complex z, *zp;
|
|
|
|
are all valid declarations. The type of distance is int , that of
|
|
metricp is ``pointer to function with no parameter specification
|
|
returning int ,'' and that of x and z is the specified structure; zp
|
|
is a pointer to such a structure. The object distance has a type
|
|
compatible with any other int object.
|
|
|
|
After the declarations
|
|
|
|
typedef struct s1 { int x; } t1, *tp1;
|
|
typedef struct s2 { int x; } t2, *tp2;
|
|
|
|
type t1 and the type pointed to by tp1 are compatible. Type t1 is
|
|
also compatible with type struct s1 , but not compatible with the
|
|
types struct s2 , t2 , the type pointed to by tp2 , and int .
|
|
|
|
The following constructions
|
|
|
|
typedef signed int t;
|
|
typedef int plain;
|
|
struct tag {
|
|
unsigned t:4;
|
|
const t:5;
|
|
plain r:5;
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
declare a typedef name t with type signed int , a typedef name plain
|
|
with type int , and a structure with three bit-field members, one
|
|
named t that contains values in the range [0,15], an unnamed
|
|
const-qualified bit-field which (if it could be accessed) would
|
|
contain values in at least the range [-15,+15], and one named r that
|
|
contains values in the range [0,31] or values in at least the range
|
|
[-15,+15]. (The choice of range is implementation-defined.) If these
|
|
declarations are followed in an inner scope by
|
|
|
|
t f(t (t));
|
|
long t;
|
|
|
|
then a function f is declared with type ``function returning signed
|
|
int with one unnamed parameter with type pointer to function returning
|
|
signed int with one unnamed parameter with type signed int ,'' and an
|
|
identifier t with type long .
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.5.7 Initialization
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
initializer:
|
|
assignment-expression
|
|
{ initializer-list }
|
|
{ initializer-list , }
|
|
|
|
initializer-list:
|
|
initializer
|
|
initializer-list , initializer
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
There shall be no more initializers in an initializer list than
|
|
there are objects to be initialized.
|
|
|
|
The type of the entity to be initialized shall be an object type or
|
|
an array of unknown size.
|
|
|
|
All the expressions in an initializer for an object that has static
|
|
storage duration or in an initializer list for an object that has
|
|
aggregate or union type shall be constant expressions.
|
|
|
|
If the declaration of an identifier has block scope, and the
|
|
identifier has external or internal linkage, there shall be no
|
|
initializer for the identifier.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
An initializer specifies the initial value stored in an object.
|
|
|
|
All unnamed structure or union members are ignored during initialization.
|
|
|
|
If an object that has static storage duration is not initialized
|
|
explicitly, it is initialized implicitly as if every member that has
|
|
arithmetic type were assigned 0 and every member that has pointer type
|
|
were assigned a null pointer constant. If an object that has
|
|
automatic storage duration is not initialized explicitly, its value is
|
|
indeterminate./65/
|
|
|
|
The initializer for a scalar shall be a single expression,
|
|
optionally enclosed in braces. The initial value of the object is
|
|
that of the expression; the same type constraints and conversions as
|
|
for simple assignment apply.
|
|
|
|
A brace-enclosed initializer for a union object initializes the
|
|
member that appears first in the declaration list of the union type.
|
|
|
|
The initializer for a structure or union object that has automatic
|
|
storage duration either shall be an initializer list as described
|
|
below, or shall be a single expression that has compatible structure
|
|
or union type. In the latter case, the initial value of the object is
|
|
that of the expression.
|
|
|
|
The rest of this section deals with initializers for objects that
|
|
have aggregate or union type.
|
|
|
|
An array of character type may be initialized by a character string
|
|
literal, optionally enclosed in braces. Successive characters of the
|
|
character string literal (including the terminating null character if
|
|
there is room or if the array is of unknown size) initialize the
|
|
members of the array.
|
|
|
|
An array with element type compatible with wchar_t may be
|
|
initialized by a wide string literal, optionally enclosed in braces.
|
|
Successive codes of the wide string literal (including the terminating
|
|
zero-valued code if there is room or if the array is of unknown size)
|
|
initialize the members of the array.
|
|
|
|
Otherwise, the initializer for an object that has aggregate type
|
|
shall be a brace-enclosed list of initializers for the members of the
|
|
aggregate, written in increasing subscript or member order; and the
|
|
initializer for an object that has union type shall be a
|
|
brace-enclosed initializer for the first member of the union.
|
|
|
|
If the aggregate contains members that are aggregates or unions, or
|
|
if the first member of a union is an aggregate or union, the rules
|
|
apply recursively to the subaggregates or contained unions. If the
|
|
initializer of a subaggregate or contained union begins with a left
|
|
brace, the initializers enclosed by that brace and its matching right
|
|
brace initialize the members of the subaggregate or the first member
|
|
of the contained union. Otherwise, only enough initializers from the
|
|
list are taken to account for the members of the first subaggregate or
|
|
the first member of the contained union; any remaining initializers
|
|
are left to initialize the next member of the aggregate of which the
|
|
current subaggregate or contained union is a part.
|
|
|
|
If there are fewer initializers in a list than there are members of
|
|
an aggregate, the remainder of the aggregate shall be initialized
|
|
implicitly the same as objects that have static storage duration.
|
|
|
|
If an array of unknown size is initialized, its size is determined
|
|
by the number of initializers provided for its members. At the end of
|
|
its initializer list, the array no longer has incomplete type.
|
|
|
|
Examples
|
|
|
|
The declaration
|
|
|
|
int x[] = { 1, 3, 5 };
|
|
|
|
defines and initializes x as a one-dimensional array object that has
|
|
three members, as no size was specified and there are three
|
|
initializers.
|
|
|
|
float y[4][3] = {
|
|
{ 1, 3, 5 },
|
|
{ 2, 4, 6 },
|
|
{ 3, 5, 7 },
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
is a definition with a fully bracketed initialization: 1, 3, and 5
|
|
initialize the first row of the array object y[0] , namely y[0][0] ,
|
|
y[0][1] , and y[0][2] . Likewise the next two lines initialize y[1]
|
|
and y[2] . The initializer ends early, so y[3] is initialized with
|
|
zeros. Precisely the same effect could have been achieved by
|
|
|
|
float y[4][3] = {
|
|
1, 3, 5, 2, 4, 6, 3, 5, 7
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
The initializer for y[0] does not begin with a left brace, so three
|
|
items from the list are used. Likewise the next three are taken
|
|
successively for y[1] and y[2] . Also,
|
|
|
|
float z[4][3] = {
|
|
{ 1 }, { 2 }, { 3 }, { 4 }
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
initializes the first column of z as specified and initializes the
|
|
rest with zeros.
|
|
|
|
struct { int a[3], b; } w[] = { { 1 }, 2 };
|
|
|
|
is a definition with an inconsistently bracketed initialization. It
|
|
defines an array with two member structures: w[0].a[0] is 1 and
|
|
w[1].a[0] is 2; all the other elements are zero.
|
|
|
|
The declaration
|
|
|
|
short q[4][3][2] = {
|
|
{ 1 },
|
|
{ 2, 3 },
|
|
{ 4, 5, 6 }
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
contains an incompletely but consistently bracketed initialization.
|
|
It defines a three-dimensional array object: q[0][0][0] is 1,
|
|
q[1][0][0] is 2, q[1][0][1] is 3, and 4, 5, and 6 initialize
|
|
q[2][0][0] , q[2][0][1] , and q[2][1][0] , respectively; all the rest
|
|
are zero. The initializer for q[0][0][0] does not begin with a left
|
|
brace, so up to six items from the current list may be used. There is
|
|
only one, so the values for the remaining five members are initialized
|
|
with zero. Likewise, the initializers for q[1][0][0] and q[2][0][0]
|
|
do not begin with a left brace, so each uses up to six items,
|
|
initializing their respective two-dimensional subaggregates. If there
|
|
had been more than six items in any of the lists, a diagnostic message
|
|
would occur. The same initialization result could have been achieved
|
|
by:
|
|
|
|
short q[4][3][2] = {
|
|
1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0,
|
|
2, 3, 0, 0, 0, 0,
|
|
4, 5, 6
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
or by:
|
|
|
|
short q[4][3][2] = {
|
|
{
|
|
{ 1 },
|
|
},
|
|
{
|
|
{ 2, 3 },
|
|
},
|
|
{
|
|
{ 4, 5 },
|
|
{ 6 },
|
|
}
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
in a fully-bracketed form.
|
|
|
|
Note that the fully-bracketed and minimally-bracketed forms of
|
|
initialization are, in general, less likely to cause confusion.
|
|
|
|
Finally, the declaration
|
|
|
|
char s[] = "abc", t[3] = "abc";
|
|
|
|
defines ``plain'' char array objects s and t whose members are
|
|
initialized with character string literals. This declaration is
|
|
identical to
|
|
|
|
char s[] = { 'a', 'b', 'c', '\0' },
|
|
t[] = { 'a', 'b', 'c' };
|
|
|
|
The contents of the arrays are modifiable. On the other hand, the
|
|
declaration
|
|
|
|
char *p = "abc";
|
|
|
|
defines p with type ``pointer to char '' that is initialized to point
|
|
to an object with type ``array of char '' whose members are
|
|
initialized with a character string literal. If an attempt is made to
|
|
use p to modify the contents of the array, the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: common definitions <stddef.h> ($4.1.5).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.6 STATEMENTS
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
statement:
|
|
labeled-statement
|
|
compound-statement
|
|
expression-statement
|
|
selection-statement
|
|
iteration-statement
|
|
jump-statement
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
A statement specifies an action to be performed. Except as
|
|
indicated, statements are executed in sequence.
|
|
|
|
A full expression is an expression that is not part of another
|
|
expression. Each of the following is a full expression: an
|
|
initializer; the expression in an expression statement; the
|
|
controlling expression of a selection statement ( if or switch ); the
|
|
controlling expression of a while or do statement; each of the three
|
|
expressions of a for statement; the expression in a return statement.
|
|
The end of a full expression is a sequence point.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: expression and null statements ($3.6.3), selection
|
|
statements ($3.6.4), iteration statements ($3.6.5), the return
|
|
statement ($3.6.6.4).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.6.1 Labeled statements
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
labeled-statement:
|
|
identifier : statement
|
|
case constant-expression : statement
|
|
default : statement
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
A case or default label shall appear only in a switch statement.
|
|
Further constraints on such labels are discussed under the switch
|
|
statement.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
Any statement may be preceded by a prefix that declares an
|
|
identifier as a label name. Labels in themselves do not alter the
|
|
flow of control, which continues unimpeded across them.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: the goto statement ($3.6.6.1), the switch
|
|
statement ($3.6.4.2).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.6.2 Compound statement, or block
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
compound-statement:
|
|
{ declaration-list<opt> statement-list<opt> }
|
|
|
|
declaration-list:
|
|
declaration
|
|
declaration-list declaration
|
|
|
|
statement-list:
|
|
statement
|
|
statement-list statement
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
A compound statement (also called a block )allows a set of
|
|
statements to be grouped into one syntactic unit, which may have its
|
|
own set of declarations and initializations (as discussed in
|
|
$3.1.2.4). The initializers of objects that have automatic storage
|
|
duration are evaluated and the values are stored in the objects in the
|
|
order their declarators appear in the translation unit.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.6.3 Expression and null statements
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
expression-statement:
|
|
expression<opt> ;
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
The expression in an expression statement is evaluated as a void
|
|
expression for its side effects./66/
|
|
|
|
A null statement (consisting of just a semicolon) performs no
|
|
operations.
|
|
|
|
Examples
|
|
|
|
If a function call is evaluated as an expression statement for its
|
|
side effects only, the discarding of its value may be made explicit by
|
|
converting the expression to a void expression by means of a cast:
|
|
|
|
int p(int);
|
|
/*...*/
|
|
(void)p(0);
|
|
|
|
|
|
In the program fragment
|
|
|
|
char *s;
|
|
/*...*/
|
|
while (*s++ != '\0')
|
|
;
|
|
|
|
a null statement is used to supply an empty loop body to the iteration
|
|
statement.
|
|
|
|
A null statement may also be used to carry a label just before the
|
|
closing } of a compound statement.
|
|
|
|
while (loop1) {
|
|
/*...*/
|
|
while (loop2) {
|
|
/*...*/
|
|
if (want_out)
|
|
goto end_loop1;
|
|
/*...*/
|
|
}
|
|
/*...*/
|
|
end_loop1: ;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Forward references: iteration statements ($3.6.5).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.6.4 Selection statements
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
selection-statement:
|
|
if ( expression ) statement
|
|
if ( expression ) statement else statement
|
|
switch ( expression ) statement
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
A selection statement selects among a set of statements depending
|
|
on the value of a controlling expression.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.6.4.1 The if statement
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
The controlling expression of an if statement shall have scalar type.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
In both forms, the first substatement is executed if the expression
|
|
compares unequal to 0. In the else form, the second substatement is
|
|
executed if the expression compares equal to 0. If the first
|
|
substatement is reached via a label, the second substatement is not
|
|
executed.
|
|
|
|
An else is associated with the lexically immediately preceding else
|
|
-less if that is in the same block (but not in an enclosed block).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.6.4.2 The switch statement
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
The controlling expression of a switch statement shall have
|
|
integral type. The expression of each case label shall be an integral
|
|
constant expression. No two of the case constant expressions in the
|
|
same switch statement shall have the same value after conversion.
|
|
There may be at most one default label in a switch statement. (Any
|
|
enclosed switch statement may have a default label or case constant
|
|
expressions with values that duplicate case constant expressions in
|
|
the enclosing switch statement.)
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
A switch statement causes control to jump to, into, or past the
|
|
statement that is the switch body, depending on the value of a
|
|
controlling expression, and on the presence of a default label and the
|
|
values of any case labels on or in the switch body. A case or default
|
|
label is accessible only within the closest enclosing switch
|
|
statement.
|
|
|
|
The integral promotions are performed on the controlling
|
|
expression. The constant expression in each case label is converted
|
|
to the promoted type of the controlling expression. If a converted
|
|
value matches that of the promoted controlling expression, control
|
|
jumps to the statement following the matched case label. Otherwise,
|
|
if there is a default label, control jumps to the labeled statement.
|
|
If no converted case constant expression matches and there is no
|
|
default label, no part of the switch body is executed.
|
|
|
|
"Implementation limits"
|
|
|
|
As discussed previously ($2.2.4.1), the implementation may limit
|
|
the number of case values in a switch statement.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.6.5 Iteration statements
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
iteration-statement:
|
|
while ( expression ) statement
|
|
do statement while ( expression ) ;
|
|
for ( expression<opt> ; expression<opt> ;
|
|
expression<opt> ) statement
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
The controlling expression of an iteration statement shall have scalar type.
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
An iteration statement causes a statement called the loop body to
|
|
be executed repeatedly until the controlling expression compares equal
|
|
to 0.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.6.5.1 The while statement
|
|
|
|
The evaluation of the controlling expression takes place before
|
|
each execution of the loop body.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.6.5.2 The do statement
|
|
|
|
The evaluation of the controlling expression takes place after each
|
|
execution of the loop body.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.6.5.3 The for statement
|
|
|
|
Except for the behavior of a continue statement in the loop body,
|
|
the statement
|
|
|
|
for ( expression-1 ; expression-2 ; expression-3 ) statement
|
|
|
|
and the sequence of statements
|
|
|
|
expression-1 ;
|
|
while ( expression-2) {
|
|
statement
|
|
expression-3 ;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
are equivalent./67/ expression-1 expression-2 , expression-3
|
|
|
|
Both expression-1 and expression-3 may be omitted. Each is
|
|
evaluated as a void expression. An omitted expression-2 is replaced
|
|
by a nonzero constant.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: the continue statement ($3.6.6.2).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.6.6 Jump statements
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
jump-statement:
|
|
goto identifier ;
|
|
continue ;
|
|
break ;
|
|
return expression<opt> ;
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
A jump statement causes an unconditional jump to another place.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.6.6.1 The goto statement
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
The identifier in a goto statement shall name a label located
|
|
somewhere in the current function.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
A goto statement causes an unconditional jump to the statement
|
|
prefixed by the named label in the current function.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.6.6.2 The continue statement
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
A continue statement shall appear only in or as a loop body.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
A continue statement causes a jump to the loop-continuation portion
|
|
of the smallest enclosing iteration statement; that is, to the end of
|
|
the loop body. More precisely, in each of the statements
|
|
|
|
while (/*...*/) { do { for (/*...*/) {
|
|
/*...*/ /*...*/ /*...*/
|
|
continue; continue; continue;
|
|
/*...*/ /*...*/ /*...*/
|
|
contin: ; contin: ; contin: ;
|
|
} } while (/*...*/); }
|
|
|
|
unless the continue statement shown is in an enclosed iteration
|
|
statement (in which case it is interpreted within that statement), it
|
|
is equivalent to goto contin; ./68/
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.6.6.3 The break statement
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
A break statement shall appear only in or as a switch body or loop body.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
A break statement terminates execution of the smallest enclosing
|
|
switch or iteration statement.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.6.6.4 The return statement
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
A return statement with an expression shall not appear in a
|
|
function whose return type is void .
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
A return statement terminates execution of the current function and
|
|
returns control to its caller. A function may have any number of
|
|
return statements, with and without expressions.
|
|
|
|
If a return statement with an expression is executed, the value of
|
|
the expression is returned to the caller as the value of the function
|
|
call expression. If the expression has a type different from that of
|
|
the function in which it appears, it is converted as if it were
|
|
assigned to an object of that type.
|
|
|
|
If a return statement without an expression is executed, and the
|
|
value of the function call is used by the caller, the behavior is
|
|
undefined. Reaching the } that terminates a function is equivalent to
|
|
executing a return statement without an expression.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.7 EXTERNAL DEFINITIONS
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
translation-unit:
|
|
external-declaration
|
|
translation-unit external-declaration
|
|
|
|
external-declaration:
|
|
function-definition
|
|
declaration
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
The storage-class specifiers auto and register shall not appear in
|
|
the declaration specifiers in an external declaration.
|
|
|
|
There shall be no more than one external definition for each
|
|
identifier declared with internal linkage in a translation unit.
|
|
Moreover, if an identifier declared with internal linkage is used in
|
|
an expression (other than as a part of the operand of a sizeof
|
|
operator), there shall be exactly one external definition for the
|
|
identifier in the translation unit.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
As discussed in $2.1.1.1, the unit of program text after
|
|
preprocessing is a translation unit, which consists of a sequence of
|
|
external declarations. These are described as ``external'' because
|
|
they appear outside any function (and hence have file scope). As
|
|
discussed in $3.5, a declaration that also causes storage to be
|
|
reserved for an object or a function named by the identifier is a
|
|
definition.
|
|
|
|
An external definition is an external declaration that is also a
|
|
definition of a function or an object. If an identifier declared with
|
|
external linkage is used in an expression (other than as part of the
|
|
operand of a sizeof operator), somewhere in the entire program there
|
|
shall be exactly one external definition for the identifier./69/
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.7.1 Function definitions
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
function-definition:
|
|
declaration-specifiers<opt> declarator
|
|
declaration-list<opt> compound-statement
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
The identifier declared in a function definition (which is the name
|
|
of the function) shall have a function type, as specified by the
|
|
declarator portion of the function definition./70/
|
|
|
|
The return type of a function shall be void or an object type other
|
|
than array.
|
|
|
|
The storage-class specifier, if any, in the declaration specifiers
|
|
shall be either extern or static .
|
|
|
|
If the declarator includes a parameter type list, the declaration
|
|
of each parameter shall include an identifier (except for the special
|
|
case of a parameter list consisting of a single parameter of type void,
|
|
in which there shall not be an identifier). No declaration list
|
|
shall follow.
|
|
|
|
If the declarator includes an identifier list, only the identifiers
|
|
it names shall be declared in the declaration list. An identifier
|
|
declared as a typedef name shall not be redeclared as a parameter.
|
|
The declarations in the declaration list shall contain no
|
|
storage-class specifier other than register and no initializations.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
The declarator in a function definition specifies the name of the
|
|
function being defined and the identifiers of its parameters. If the
|
|
declarator includes a parameter type list, the list also specifies the
|
|
types of all the parameters; such a declarator also serves as a
|
|
function prototype for later calls to the same function in the same
|
|
translation unit. If the declarator includes an identifier list,/71/
|
|
the types of the parameters may be declared in a following declaration
|
|
list. Any parameter that is not declared has type int .
|
|
|
|
If a function that accepts a variable number of arguments is
|
|
defined without a parameter type list that ends with the ellipsis
|
|
notation, the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
On entry to the function the value of each argument expression
|
|
shall be converted to the type of its corresponding parameter, as if
|
|
by assignment to the parameter. Array expressions and function
|
|
designators as arguments are converted to pointers before the call. A
|
|
declaration of a parameter as ``array of type '' shall be adjusted to
|
|
``pointer to type ,'' and a declaration of a parameter as ``function
|
|
returning type '' shall be adjusted to ``pointer to function returning
|
|
type ,'' as in $3.2.2.1. The resulting parameter type shall be an
|
|
object type.
|
|
|
|
Each parameter has automatic storage duration. Its identifier is
|
|
an lvalue./72/ The layout of the storage for parameters is
|
|
unspecified.
|
|
|
|
Examples
|
|
|
|
extern int max(int a, int b)
|
|
{
|
|
return a > b ? a : b;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Here extern is the storage-class specifier and int is the type
|
|
specifier (each of which may be omitted as those are the defaults);
|
|
max(int a, int b) is the function declarator; and
|
|
|
|
{ return a > b ? a : b; }
|
|
|
|
is the function body. The following similar definition uses the
|
|
identifier-list form for the parameter declarations:
|
|
|
|
extern int max(a, b)
|
|
int a, b;
|
|
{
|
|
return a > b ? a : b;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Here int a, b; is the declaration list for the parameters, which may
|
|
be omitted because those are the defaults. The difference between
|
|
these two definitions is that the first form acts as a prototype
|
|
declaration that forces conversion of the arguments of subsequent
|
|
calls to the function, whereas the second form may not.
|
|
|
|
To pass one function to another, one might say
|
|
|
|
int f(void);
|
|
/*...*/
|
|
g(f);
|
|
|
|
Note that f must be declared explicitly in the calling function, as
|
|
its appearance in the expression g(f) was not followed by ( . Then
|
|
the definition of g might read
|
|
|
|
g(int (*funcp)(void))
|
|
{
|
|
/*...*/ (*funcp)() /* or funcp() ... */
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
or, equivalently,
|
|
|
|
g(int func(void))
|
|
{
|
|
/*...*/ func() /* or (*func)() ... */
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.7.2 External object definitions
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
If the declaration of an identifier for an object has file scope
|
|
and an initializer, the declaration is an external definition for the
|
|
identifier.
|
|
|
|
A declaration of an identifier for an object that has file scope
|
|
without an initializer, and without a storage-class specifier or with
|
|
the storage-class specifier static , constitutes a tentative
|
|
definition. If a translation unit contains one or more tentative
|
|
definitions for an identifier, and the translation unit contains no
|
|
external definition for that identifier, then the behavior is exactly
|
|
as if the translation unit contains a file scope declaration of that
|
|
identifier, with the composite type as of the end of the translation
|
|
unit, with an initializer equal to 0.
|
|
|
|
If the declaration of an identifier for an object is a tentative
|
|
definition and has internal linkage, the declared type shall not be an
|
|
incomplete type.
|
|
|
|
Examples
|
|
|
|
int i1 = 1; /* definition, external linkage */
|
|
static int i2 = 2; /* definition, internal linkage */
|
|
extern int i3 = 3; /* definition, external linkage */
|
|
int i4; /* tentative definition, external linkage */
|
|
static int i5; /* tentative definition, internal linkage */
|
|
|
|
int i1; /* valid tentative definition, refers to previous */
|
|
int i2; /* $3.1.2.2 renders undefined, linkage disagreement */
|
|
int i3; /* valid tentative definition, refers to previous */
|
|
int i4; /* valid tentative definition, refers to previous */
|
|
int i5; /* $3.1.2.2 renders undefined, linkage disagreement */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
extern int i1; /* refers to previous, whose linkage is external */
|
|
extern int i2; /* refers to previous, whose linkage is internal */
|
|
extern int i3; /* refers to previous, whose linkage is external */
|
|
extern int i4; /* refers to previous, whose linkage is external */
|
|
extern int i5; /* refers to previous, whose linkage is internal */
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.8 PREPROCESSING DIRECTIVES
|
|
|
|
Syntax
|
|
|
|
preprocessing-file:
|
|
group<opt>
|
|
|
|
group:
|
|
group-part
|
|
group group-part
|
|
|
|
group-part:
|
|
pp-tokens<opt> new-line
|
|
if-section
|
|
control-line
|
|
|
|
if-section:
|
|
if-group elif-groups<opt> else-group<opt> endif-line
|
|
|
|
if-group:
|
|
# if constant-expression new-line group<opt>
|
|
# ifdef identifier new-line group<opt>
|
|
# ifndef identifier new-line group<opt>
|
|
|
|
elif-groups:
|
|
elif-group
|
|
elif-groups elif-group
|
|
|
|
elif-group:
|
|
# elif constant-expression new-line group<opt>
|
|
|
|
else-group:
|
|
# else new-line group<opt>
|
|
|
|
endif-line:
|
|
# endif new-line
|
|
|
|
control-line:
|
|
# include pp-tokens new-line
|
|
# define identifier replacement-list new-line
|
|
# define identifier lparen identifier-list<opt> )
|
|
replacement-list new-line
|
|
# undef identifier new-line
|
|
# line pp-tokens new-line
|
|
# error pp-tokens<opt> new-line
|
|
# pragma pp-tokens<opt> new-line
|
|
# new-line
|
|
|
|
lparen:
|
|
the left-parenthesis character without preceding white-space
|
|
|
|
replacement-list:
|
|
pp-tokens<opt>
|
|
|
|
pp-tokens:
|
|
preprocessing-token
|
|
pp-tokens preprocessing-token
|
|
|
|
new-line:
|
|
the new-line character
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
A preprocessing directive consists of a sequence of preprocessing
|
|
tokens that begins with a # preprocessing token that is either the
|
|
first character in the source file (optionally after white space
|
|
containing no new-line characters) or that follows white space
|
|
containing at least one new-line character, and is ended by the next
|
|
new-line character./73/
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
The only white-space characters that shall appear between
|
|
preprocessing tokens within a preprocessing directive (from just after
|
|
the introducing # preprocessing token through just before the
|
|
terminating new-line character) are space and horizontal-tab
|
|
(including spaces that have replaced comments in translation phase 3).
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
The implementation can process and skip sections of source files
|
|
conditionally, include other source files, and replace macros. These
|
|
capabilities are called preprocessing , because conceptually they
|
|
occur before translation of the resulting translation unit.
|
|
|
|
The preprocessing tokens within a preprocessing directive are not
|
|
subject to macro expansion unless otherwise stated.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.8.1 Conditional inclusion
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
The expression that controls conditional inclusion shall be an
|
|
integral constant expression except that: it shall not contain a cast;
|
|
identifiers (including those lexically identical to keywords) are
|
|
interpreted as described below;/74/ and it may contain unary operator
|
|
expressions of the form
|
|
|
|
defined identifier
|
|
defined ( identifier )
|
|
|
|
which evaluate to 1 if the identifier is currently defined as a macro
|
|
name (that is, if it is predefined or if it has been the subject of a
|
|
#define preprocessing directive without an intervening #undef
|
|
directive with the same subject identifier), 0 if it is not.
|
|
|
|
Each preprocessing token that remains after all macro replacements
|
|
have occurred shall be in the lexical form of a token.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
Preprocessing directives of the forms
|
|
|
|
# if constant-expression new-line group<opt>
|
|
# elif constant-expression new-line group<opt>
|
|
|
|
check whether the controlling constant expression evaluates to
|
|
nonzero.
|
|
|
|
Prior to evaluation, macro invocations in the list of preprocessing
|
|
tokens that will become the controlling constant expression are
|
|
replaced (except for those macro names modified by the defined unary
|
|
operator), just as in normal text. If the token defined is generated
|
|
as a result of this replacement process, the behavior is undefined.
|
|
After all replacements are finished, the resulting preprocessing
|
|
tokens are converted into tokens, and then all remaining identifiers
|
|
are replaced with 0 . The resulting tokens comprise the controlling
|
|
constant expression which is evaluated according to the rules of $3.4
|
|
using arithmetic that has at least the ranges specified in $2.2.4.2,
|
|
except that int and unsigned int act as if they have the same
|
|
representation as, respectively, long and unsigned long . This
|
|
includes interpreting character constants, which may involve
|
|
converting escape sequences into execution character set members.
|
|
Whether the numeric value for these character constants matches the
|
|
value obtained when an identical character constant occurs in an
|
|
expression (other than within a #if or #elif directive) is
|
|
implementation-defined./75/ Also, whether a single-character character
|
|
constant may have a negative value is implementation-defined.
|
|
|
|
Preprocessing directives of the forms
|
|
|
|
# ifdef identifier new-line group<opt>
|
|
# ifndef identifier new-line group<opt>
|
|
|
|
check whether the identifier is or is not currently defined as a macro
|
|
name. Their conditions are equivalent to #if defined identifier and
|
|
#if !defined identifier respectively.
|
|
|
|
Each directive's condition is checked in order. If it evaluates to
|
|
false (zero), the group that it controls is skipped: directives are
|
|
processed only through the name that determines the directive in order
|
|
to keep track of the level of nested conditionals; the rest of the
|
|
directives' preprocessing tokens are ignored, as are the other
|
|
preprocessing tokens in the group. Only the first group whose control
|
|
condition evaluates to true (nonzero) is processed. If none of the
|
|
conditions evaluates to true, and there is a #else directive, the
|
|
group controlled by the #else is processed; lacking a #else directive,
|
|
all the groups until the #endif are skipped./76/
|
|
|
|
Forward references: macro replacement ($3.8.3), source file inclusion
|
|
($3.8.2).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.8.2 Source file inclusion
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
A #include directive shall identify a header or source file that
|
|
can be processed by the implementation.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
A preprocessing directive of the form
|
|
|
|
# include <h-char-sequence> new-line
|
|
|
|
searches a sequence of implementation-defined places for a header
|
|
identified uniquely by the specified sequence between the < and >
|
|
delimiters, and causes the replacement of that directive by the entire
|
|
contents of the header. How the places are specified or the header
|
|
identified is implementation-defined.
|
|
|
|
A preprocessing directive of the form
|
|
|
|
# include "q-char-sequence" new-line
|
|
|
|
causes the replacement of that directive by the entire contents of the
|
|
source file identified by the specified sequence between the
|
|
delimiters. The named source file is searched for in an
|
|
implementation-defined manner. If this search is not supported, or if
|
|
the search fails, the directive is reprocessed as if it read
|
|
|
|
# include <h-char-sequence> new-line
|
|
|
|
with the identical contained sequence (including > characters, if any)
|
|
from the original directive.
|
|
|
|
A preprocessing directive of the form
|
|
|
|
# include pp-tokens new-line
|
|
|
|
(that does not match one of the two previous forms) is permitted. The
|
|
preprocessing tokens after include in the directive are processed just
|
|
as in normal text. (Each identifier currently defined as a macro name
|
|
is replaced by its replacement list of preprocessing tokens.) The
|
|
directive resulting after all replacements shall match one of the two
|
|
previous forms./77/ The method by which a sequence of preprocessing
|
|
tokens between a < and a > preprocessing token pair or a pair of
|
|
characters is combined into a single header name preprocessing token
|
|
is implementation-defined.
|
|
|
|
There shall be an implementation-defined mapping between the
|
|
delimited sequence and the external source file name. The
|
|
implementation shall provide unique mappings for sequences consisting
|
|
of one or more letters (as defined in $2.2.1) followed by a period (.)
|
|
and a single letter. The implementation may ignore the distinctions
|
|
of alphabetical case and restrict the mapping to six significant
|
|
characters before the period.
|
|
|
|
A #include preprocessing directive may appear in a source file that
|
|
has been read because of a #include directive in another file, up to
|
|
an implementation-defined nesting limit (see $2.2.4.1).
|
|
|
|
Examples
|
|
|
|
The most common uses of #include preprocessing directives are as in
|
|
the following:
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
#include "myprog.h"
|
|
|
|
|
|
This example illustrates a macro-replaced #include directive:
|
|
|
|
#if VERSION == 1
|
|
#define INCFILE "vers1.h"
|
|
#elif VERSION == 2
|
|
#define INCFILE "vers2.h"
|
|
/* and so on */
|
|
#else
|
|
#define INCFILE "versN.h"
|
|
#endif
|
|
/*...*/
|
|
#include INCFILE
|
|
|
|
Forward references: macro replacement ($3.8.3).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.8.3 Macro replacement
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
Two replacement lists are identical if and only if the
|
|
preprocessing tokens in both have the same number, ordering, spelling,
|
|
and white-space separation, where all white-space separations are
|
|
considered identical.
|
|
|
|
An identifier currently defined as a macro without use of lparen
|
|
(an object-like macro) may be redefined by another #define
|
|
preprocessing directive provided that the second definition is an
|
|
object-like macro definition and the two replacement lists are
|
|
identical.
|
|
|
|
An identifier currently defined as a macro using lparen (a
|
|
function-like macro) may be redefined by another #define preprocessing
|
|
directive provided that the second definition is a function-like macro
|
|
definition that has the same number and spelling of parameters, and
|
|
the two replacement lists are identical.
|
|
|
|
The number of arguments in an invocation of a function-like macro
|
|
shall agree with the number of parameters in the macro definition, and
|
|
there shall exist a ) preprocessing token that terminates the
|
|
invocation.
|
|
|
|
A parameter identifier in a function-like macro shall be uniquely
|
|
declared within its scope.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
The identifier immediately following the define is called the macro
|
|
name. Any white-space characters preceding or following the
|
|
replacement list of preprocessing tokens are not considered part of
|
|
the replacement list for either form of macro.
|
|
|
|
If a # preprocessing token, followed by an identifier, occurs
|
|
lexically at the point at which a preprocessing directive could begin,
|
|
the identifier is not subject to macro replacement.
|
|
|
|
A preprocessing directive of the form
|
|
|
|
# define identifier replacement-list new-line
|
|
|
|
defines an object-like macro that causes each subsequent instance of
|
|
the macro name/78/ to be replaced by the replacement list of
|
|
preprocessing tokens that constitute the remainder of the directive.
|
|
The replacement list is then rescanned for more macro names as
|
|
specified below.
|
|
|
|
A preprocessing directive of the form
|
|
|
|
# define identifier lparen identifier-list<opt> )
|
|
replacement-list new-line
|
|
|
|
defines a function-like macro with arguments, similar syntactically to
|
|
a function call. The parameters are specified by the optional list of
|
|
identifiers, whose scope extends from their declaration in the
|
|
identifier list until the new-line character that terminates the
|
|
#define preprocessing directive. Each subsequent instance of the
|
|
function-like macro name followed by a ( as the next preprocessing
|
|
token introduces the sequence of preprocessing tokens that is replaced
|
|
by the replacement list in the definition (an invocation of the
|
|
macro). The replaced sequence of preprocessing tokens is terminated
|
|
by the matching ) preprocessing token, skipping intervening matched
|
|
pairs of left and right parenthesis preprocessing tokens. Within the
|
|
sequence of preprocessing tokens making up an invocation of a
|
|
function-like macro, new-line is considered a normal white-space
|
|
character.
|
|
|
|
The sequence of preprocessing tokens bounded by the outside-most
|
|
matching parentheses forms the list of arguments for the function-like
|
|
macro. The individual arguments within the list are separated by
|
|
comma preprocessing tokens, but comma preprocessing tokens bounded by
|
|
nested parentheses do not separate arguments. If (before argument
|
|
substitution) any argument consists of no preprocessing tokens, the
|
|
behavior is undefined. If there are sequences of preprocessing tokens
|
|
within the list of arguments that would otherwise act as preprocessing
|
|
directives, the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.8.3.1 Argument substitution
|
|
|
|
After the arguments for the invocation of a function-like macro
|
|
have been identified, argument substitution takes place. A parameter
|
|
in the replacement list, unless preceded by a # or ## preprocessing
|
|
token or followed by a ## preprocessing token (see below), is replaced
|
|
by the corresponding argument after all macros contained therein have
|
|
been expanded. Before being substituted, each argument's
|
|
preprocessing tokens are completely macro replaced as if they formed
|
|
the rest of the source file; no other preprocessing tokens are
|
|
available.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.8.3.2 The # operator
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
Each # preprocessing token in the replacement list for a
|
|
function-like macro shall be followed by a parameter as the next
|
|
preprocessing token in the replacement list.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
If, in the replacement list, a parameter is immediately preceded by
|
|
a # preprocessing token, both are replaced by a single character
|
|
string literal preprocessing token that contains the spelling of the
|
|
preprocessing token sequence for the corresponding argument. Each
|
|
occurrence of white space between the argument's preprocessing tokens
|
|
becomes a single space character in the character string literal.
|
|
White space before the first preprocessing token and after the last
|
|
preprocessing token comprising the argument is deleted. Otherwise,
|
|
the original spelling of each preprocessing token in the argument is
|
|
retained in the character string literal, except for special handling
|
|
for producing the spelling of string literals and character constants:
|
|
a \ character is inserted before each and \ character of a character
|
|
constant or string literal (including the delimiting characters). If
|
|
the replacement that results is not a valid character string literal,
|
|
the behavior is undefined. The order of evaluation of # and ##
|
|
operators is unspecified.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.8.3.3 The ## operator
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
A ## preprocessing token shall not occur at the beginning or at the
|
|
end of a replacement list for either form of macro definition.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
If, in the replacement list, a parameter is immediately preceded or
|
|
followed by a ## preprocessing token, the parameter is replaced by the
|
|
corresponding argument's preprocessing token sequence.
|
|
|
|
For both object-like and function-like macro invocations, before
|
|
the replacement list is reexamined for more macro names to replace,
|
|
each instance of a ## preprocessing token in the replacement list (not
|
|
from an argument) is deleted and the preceding preprocessing token is
|
|
concatenated with the following preprocessing token. If the result is
|
|
not a valid preprocessing token, the behavior is undefined. The
|
|
resulting token is available for further macro replacement. The order
|
|
of evaluation of ## operators is unspecified.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.8.3.4 Rescanning and further replacement
|
|
|
|
After all parameters in the replacement list have been substituted,
|
|
the resulting preprocessing token sequence is rescanned with the rest
|
|
of the source file's preprocessing tokens for more macro names to
|
|
replace.
|
|
|
|
If the name of the macro being replaced is found during this scan
|
|
of the replacement list (not including the rest of the source file's
|
|
preprocessing tokens), it is not replaced. Further, if any nested
|
|
replacements encounter the name of the macro being replaced, it is not
|
|
replaced. These nonreplaced macro name preprocessing tokens are no
|
|
longer available for further replacement even if they are later
|
|
(re)examined in contexts in which that macro name preprocessing token
|
|
would otherwise have been replaced.
|
|
|
|
The resulting completely macro-replaced preprocessing token
|
|
sequence is not processed as a preprocessing directive even if it
|
|
resembles one.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.8.3.5 Scope of macro definitions
|
|
|
|
A macro definition lasts (independent of block structure) until a
|
|
corresponding #undef directive is encountered or (if none is
|
|
encountered) until the end of the translation unit.
|
|
|
|
A preprocessing directive of the form
|
|
|
|
# undef identifier new-line
|
|
|
|
causes the specified identifier no longer to be defined as a macro
|
|
name. It is ignored if the specified identifier is not currently
|
|
defined as a macro name.
|
|
|
|
Examples
|
|
|
|
The simplest use of this facility is to define a ``manifest
|
|
constant,'' as in
|
|
|
|
#define TABSIZE 100
|
|
|
|
int table[TABSIZE];
|
|
|
|
The following defines a function-like macro whose value is the
|
|
maximum of its arguments. It has the advantages of working for any
|
|
compatible types of the arguments and of generating in-line code
|
|
without the overhead of function calling. It has the disadvantages of
|
|
evaluating one or the other of its arguments a second time (including
|
|
side effects) and of generating more code than a function if invoked
|
|
several times.
|
|
|
|
#define max(a, b) ((a) > (b) ? (a) : (b))
|
|
|
|
The parentheses ensure that the arguments and the resulting expression
|
|
are bound properly.
|
|
|
|
To illustrate the rules for redefinition and reexamination, the
|
|
sequence
|
|
|
|
#define x 3
|
|
#define f(a) f(x * (a))
|
|
#undef x
|
|
#define x 2
|
|
#define g f
|
|
#define z z[0]
|
|
#define h g(~
|
|
#define m(a) a(w)
|
|
#define w 0,1
|
|
#define t(a) a
|
|
|
|
f(y+1) + f(f(z)) % t(t(g)(0) + t)(1);
|
|
g(x+(3,4)-w) | h 5) & m
|
|
(f)^m(m);
|
|
|
|
results in
|
|
|
|
f(2 * (y+1)) + f(2 * (f(2 * (z[0])))) % f(2 * (0)) + t(1);
|
|
f(2 * (2+(3,4)-0,1)) | f(2 * (~ 5)) & f(2 * (0,1))^m(0,1);
|
|
|
|
|
|
To illustrate the rules for creating character string literals and
|
|
concatenating tokens, the sequence
|
|
|
|
#define str(s) # s
|
|
#define xstr(s) str(s)
|
|
#define debug(s, t) printf("x" # s "= %d, x" # t "= %s", \
|
|
x ## s, x ## t)
|
|
#define INCFILE(n) vers ## n /* from previous #include example */
|
|
#define glue(a, b) a ## b
|
|
#define xglue(a, b) glue(a, b)
|
|
#define HIGHLOW "hello"
|
|
#define LOW LOW ", world"
|
|
|
|
debug(1, 2);
|
|
fputs(str(strncmp("abc\0d", "abc", '\4') /* this goes away */
|
|
== 0) str(: @\n), s);
|
|
#include xstr(INCFILE(2).h)
|
|
glue(HIGH, LOW);
|
|
xglue(HIGH, LOW)
|
|
|
|
results in
|
|
|
|
printf("x" "1" "= %d, x" "2" "= %s", x1, x2);
|
|
fputs("strncmp(\"abc\\0d\", \"abc\", '\\4') == 0" ": @\n", s);
|
|
#include "vers2.h" (after macro replacement, before file access)
|
|
"hello";
|
|
"hello" ", world"
|
|
|
|
or, after concatenation of the character string literals,
|
|
|
|
printf("x1= %d, x2= %s", x1, x2);
|
|
fputs("strncmp(\"abc\\0d\", \"abc\", '\\4') == 0: @\n", s);
|
|
#include "vers2.h" (after macro replacement, before file access)
|
|
"hello";
|
|
"hello, world"
|
|
|
|
Space around the # and ## tokens in the macro definition is optional.
|
|
|
|
And finally, to demonstrate the redefinition rules, the following
|
|
sequence is valid.
|
|
|
|
#define OBJ_LIKE (1-1)
|
|
#define OBJ_LIKE /* white space */ (1-1) /* other */
|
|
#define FTN_LIKE(a) ( a )
|
|
#define FTN_LIKE( a )( /* note the white space */ \
|
|
a /* other stuff on this line
|
|
*/ )
|
|
|
|
But the following redefinitions are invalid:
|
|
|
|
#define OBJ_LIKE (0) /* different token sequence */
|
|
#define OBJ_LIKE (1 - 1) /* different white space */
|
|
#define FTN_LIKE(b) ( a ) /* different parameter usage */
|
|
#define FTN_LIKE(b) ( b ) /* different parameter spelling */
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.8.4 Line control
|
|
|
|
Constraints
|
|
|
|
The string literal of a #line directive, if present, shall be a
|
|
character string literal.
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
The line number of the current source line is one greater than the
|
|
number of new-line characters read or introduced in translation phase
|
|
1 ($2.1.1.2) while processing the source file to the current token.
|
|
|
|
A preprocessing directive of the form
|
|
|
|
# line digit-sequence new-line
|
|
|
|
causes the implementation to behave as if the following sequence of
|
|
source lines begins with a source line that has a line number as
|
|
specified by the digit sequence (interpreted as a decimal integer).
|
|
|
|
A preprocessing directive of the form
|
|
|
|
# line digit-sequence " s-char-sequence<opt>" new-line
|
|
|
|
sets the line number similarly and changes the presumed name of the
|
|
source file to be the contents of the character string literal.
|
|
|
|
A preprocessing directive of the form
|
|
|
|
# line pp-tokens new-line
|
|
|
|
(that does not match one of the two previous forms) is permitted. The
|
|
preprocessing tokens after line on the directive are processed just as
|
|
in normal text (each identifier currently defined as a macro name is
|
|
replaced by its replacement list of preprocessing tokens). The
|
|
directive resulting after all replacements shall match one of the two
|
|
previous forms and is then processed as appropriate.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.8.5 Error directive
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
A preprocessing directive of the form
|
|
|
|
# error pp-tokens<opt> new-line
|
|
|
|
causes the implementation to produce a diagnostic message that
|
|
includes the specified sequence of preprocessing tokens.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.8.6 Pragma directive
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
A preprocessing directive of the form
|
|
|
|
# pragma pp-tokens<opt> new-line
|
|
|
|
causes the implementation to behave in an implementation-defined
|
|
manner. Any pragma that is not recognized by the implementation is
|
|
ignored.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.8.7 Null directive
|
|
|
|
Semantics
|
|
|
|
A preprocessing directive of the form
|
|
|
|
# new-line
|
|
|
|
has no effect.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.8.8 Predefined macro names
|
|
|
|
The following macro names shall be defined by the implementation:
|
|
The line number of the current source line (a decimal constant). The
|
|
presumed name of the source file (a character string literal). The
|
|
date of translation of the source file (a character string literal of
|
|
the form Mmm dd yyyy , where the names of the months are the same as
|
|
those generated by the asctime function, and the first character of dd
|
|
is a space character if the value is less than 10). If the date of
|
|
translation is not available, an implementation-defined valid date
|
|
shall be supplied. The time of translation of the source file (a
|
|
character string literal of the form hh:mm:ss as in the time generated
|
|
by the asctime function). If the time of translation is not
|
|
available, an implementation-defined valid time shall be supplied.
|
|
the decimal constant 1./79/
|
|
|
|
The values of the predefined macros (except for __LINE__ and
|
|
__FILE__ ) remain constant throughout the translation unit.
|
|
|
|
None of these macro names, nor the identifier defined , shall be
|
|
the subject of a #define or a #undef preprocessing directive. All
|
|
predefined macro names shall begin with a leading underscore followed
|
|
by an upper-case letter or a second underscore.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: the asctime function ($4.12.3.1).
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.9 FUTURE LANGUAGE DIRECTIONS
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.9.1 External names
|
|
|
|
Restriction of the significance of an external name to fewer than
|
|
31 characters or to only one case is an obsolescent feature that is a
|
|
concession to existing implementations.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.9.2 Character escape sequences
|
|
|
|
Lower-case letters as escape sequences are reserved for future
|
|
standardization. Other characters may be used in extensions.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.9.3 Storage-class specifiers
|
|
|
|
The placement of a storage-class specifier other than at the
|
|
beginning of the declaration specifiers in a declaration is an
|
|
obsolescent feature.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.9.4 Function declarators
|
|
|
|
The use of function declarators with empty parentheses (not
|
|
prototype-format parameter type declarators) is an obsolescent
|
|
feature.
|
|
|
|
|
|
3.9.5 Function definitions
|
|
|
|
The use of function definitions with separate parameter identifier
|
|
and declaration lists (not prototype-format parameter type and
|
|
identifier declarators) is an obsolescent feature.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4. LIBRARY
|
|
|
|
4.1 INTRODUCTION
|
|
|
|
4.1.1 Definitions of terms
|
|
|
|
A string is a contiguous sequence of characters terminated by and
|
|
including the first null character. It is represented by a pointer to
|
|
its initial (lowest addressed) character and its length is the number
|
|
of characters preceding the null character.
|
|
|
|
A letter is a printing character in the execution character set
|
|
corresponding to any of the 52 required lower-case and upper-case
|
|
letters in the source character set, listed in $2.2.1.
|
|
|
|
The decimal-point character is the character used by functions that
|
|
convert floating-point numbers to or from character sequences to
|
|
denote the beginning of the fractional part of such character
|
|
sequences./80/ It is represented in the text and examples by a period,
|
|
but may be changed by the setlocale function.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: character handling ($4.3), the setlocale function
|
|
($4.4.1.1).
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.1.2 Standard headers
|
|
|
|
Each library function is declared in a header, /81/ whose contents
|
|
are made available by the #include preprocessing directive. The
|
|
header declares a set of related functions, plus any necessary types
|
|
and additional macros needed to facilitate their use. Each header
|
|
declares and defines only those identifiers listed in its associated
|
|
section. All external identifiers declared in any of the headers are
|
|
reserved, whether or not the associated header is included. All
|
|
external identifiers that begin with an underscore are reserved. All
|
|
other identifiers that begin with an underscore and either an
|
|
upper-case letter or another underscore are reserved. If the program
|
|
defines an external identifier with the same name as a reserved
|
|
external identifier, even in a semantically equivalent form, the
|
|
behavior is undefined./82/
|
|
|
|
The standard headers are
|
|
|
|
<assert.h> <locale.h> <stddef.h>
|
|
<ctype.h> <math.h> <stdio.h>
|
|
<errno.h> <setjmp.h> <stdlib.h>
|
|
<float.h> <signal.h> <string.h>
|
|
<limits.h> <stdarg.h> <time.h>
|
|
|
|
|
|
If a file with the same name as one of the above < and > delimited
|
|
sequences, not provided as part of the implementation, is placed in
|
|
any of the standard places for a source file to be included, the
|
|
behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
Headers may be included in any order; each may be included more
|
|
than once in a given scope, with no effect different from being
|
|
included only once, except that the effect of including <assert.h>
|
|
depends on the definition of NDEBUG . If used, a header shall be
|
|
included outside of any external declaration or definition, and it
|
|
shall first be included before the first reference to any of the
|
|
functions or objects it declares, or to any of the types or macros it
|
|
defines. Furthermore, the program shall not have any macros with
|
|
names lexically identical to keywords currently defined prior to the
|
|
inclusion.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: diagnostics ($4.2).
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.1.3 Errors <errno.h>
|
|
|
|
The header <errno.h> defines several macros, all relating to the
|
|
reporting of error conditions.
|
|
|
|
The macros are
|
|
|
|
EDOM
|
|
ERANGE
|
|
|
|
which expand to distinct nonzero integral constant expressions; and
|
|
|
|
errno
|
|
|
|
which expands to a modifiable lvalue/83/ that has type int , the value
|
|
of which is set to a positive error number by several library
|
|
functions. It is unspecified whether errno is a macro or an
|
|
identifier declared with external linkage. If a macro definition is
|
|
suppressed in order to access an actual object, or a program defines
|
|
an external identifier with the name errno , the behavior is
|
|
undefined.
|
|
|
|
The value of errno is zero at program startup, but is never set to
|
|
zero by any library function./84/ The value of errno may be set to
|
|
nonzero by a library function call whether or not there is an error,
|
|
provided the use of errno is not documented in the description of the
|
|
function in the Standard.
|
|
|
|
Additional macro definitions, beginning with E and a digit or E and
|
|
an upper-case letter,/85/ may also be specified by the implementation.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.1.4 Limits <float.h> and <limits.h>
|
|
|
|
The headers <float.h> and <limits.h> define several macros that
|
|
expand to various limits and parameters.
|
|
|
|
The macros, their meanings, and their minimum magnitudes are listed
|
|
in $2.2.4.2.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.1.5 Common definitions <stddef.h>
|
|
|
|
The following types and macros are defined in the standard header
|
|
<stddef.h> . Some are also defined in other headers, as noted in
|
|
their respective sections.
|
|
|
|
The types are
|
|
|
|
ptrdiff_t
|
|
|
|
which is the signed integral type of the result of subtracting two
|
|
pointers;
|
|
|
|
size_t
|
|
|
|
which is the unsigned integral type of the result of the sizeof
|
|
operator; and
|
|
|
|
wchar_t
|
|
|
|
which is an integral type whose range of values can represent distinct
|
|
codes for all members of the largest extended character set specified
|
|
among the supported locales; the null character shall have the code
|
|
value zero and each member of the basic character set defined in
|
|
$2.2.1 shall have a code value equal to its value when used as the
|
|
lone character in an integer character constant.
|
|
|
|
The macros are
|
|
|
|
NULL
|
|
|
|
which expands to an implementation-defined null pointer constant; and
|
|
|
|
offsetof( type, member-designator)
|
|
|
|
which expands to an integral constant expression that has type size_t,
|
|
the value of which is the offset in bytes, to the structure member
|
|
(designated by member-designator ), from the beginning of its
|
|
structure (designated by type ). The member-designator shall be such
|
|
that given
|
|
|
|
static type t;
|
|
|
|
then the expression &(t. member-designator ) evaluates to an address
|
|
constant. (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is
|
|
undefined.)
|
|
|
|
Forward references: localization ($4.4).
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.1.6 Use of library functions
|
|
|
|
Each of the following statements applies unless explicitly stated
|
|
otherwise in the detailed descriptions that follow. If an argument to
|
|
a function has an invalid value (such as a value outside the domain of
|
|
the function, or a pointer outside the address space of the program,
|
|
or a null pointer), the behavior is undefined. Any function declared
|
|
in a header may be implemented as a macro defined in the header, so a
|
|
library function should not be declared explicitly if its header is
|
|
included. Any macro definition of a function can be suppressed
|
|
locally by enclosing the name of the function in parentheses, because
|
|
the name is then not followed by the left parenthesis that indicates
|
|
expansion of a macro function name. For the same syntactic reason, it
|
|
is permitted to take the address of a library function even if it is
|
|
also defined as a macro./86/ The use of #undef to remove any macro
|
|
definition will also ensure that an actual function is referred to.
|
|
Any invocation of a library function that is implemented as a macro
|
|
will expand to code that evaluates each of its arguments exactly once,
|
|
fully protected by parentheses where necessary, so it is generally
|
|
safe to use arbitrary expressions as arguments. Likewise, those
|
|
function-like macros described in the following sections may be
|
|
invoked in an expression anywhere a function with a compatible return
|
|
type could be called./87/
|
|
|
|
Provided that a library function can be declared without reference
|
|
to any type defined in a header, it is also permissible to declare the
|
|
function, either explicitly or implicitly, and use it without
|
|
including its associated header. If a function that accepts a
|
|
variable number of arguments is not declared (explicitly or by
|
|
including its associated header), the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
Examples
|
|
|
|
The function atoi may be used in any of several ways:
|
|
|
|
* by use of its associated header (possibly generating a macro expansion)
|
|
|
|
#include <stdlib.h>
|
|
const char *str;
|
|
/*...*/
|
|
i = atoi(str);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
* by use of its associated header (assuredly generating a true
|
|
function reference)
|
|
|
|
#include <stdlib.h>
|
|
#undef atoi
|
|
const char *str;
|
|
/*...*/
|
|
i = atoi(str);
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
#include <stdlib.h>
|
|
const char *str;
|
|
/*...*/
|
|
i = (atoi)(str);
|
|
|
|
* by explicit declaration
|
|
|
|
extern int atoi(const char *);
|
|
const char *str;
|
|
/*...*/
|
|
i = atoi(str);
|
|
|
|
* by implicit declaration
|
|
|
|
const char *str;
|
|
/*...*/
|
|
i = atoi(str);
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.2 DIAGNOSTICS <assert.h>
|
|
|
|
The header <assert.h> defines the assert macro and refers to
|
|
another macro,
|
|
|
|
NDEBUG
|
|
|
|
which is not defined by <assert.h> . If NDEBUG is defined as a macro
|
|
name at the point in the source file where <assert.h> is included, the
|
|
assert macro is defined simply as
|
|
|
|
#define assert(ignore) ((void)0)
|
|
|
|
The assert macro shall be implemented as a macro, not as an actual
|
|
function. If the macro definition is suppressed in order to access an
|
|
actual function, the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.2.1 Program diagnostics
|
|
|
|
4.2.1.1 The assert macro
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <assert.h>
|
|
void assert(int expression);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The assert macro puts diagnostics into programs. When it is
|
|
executed, if expression is false (that is, compares equal to 0), the
|
|
assert macro writes information about the particular call that failed
|
|
(including the text of the argument, the name of the source file, and
|
|
the source line number EM the latter are respectively the values of
|
|
the preprocessing macros __FILE__ and __LINE__ ) on the standard error
|
|
file in an implementation-defined format./88/
|
|
expression , xyz , nnn It then calls the abort function.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The assert macro returns no value.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: the abort function ($4.10.4.1).
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.3 CHARACTER HANDLING <ctype.h>
|
|
|
|
The header <ctype.h> declares several functions useful for testing
|
|
and mapping characters./89/ In all cases the argument is an int , the
|
|
value of which shall be representable as an unsigned char or shall
|
|
equal the value of the macro EOF . If the argument has any other
|
|
value, the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
The behavior of these functions is affected by the current locale.
|
|
Those functions that have no implementation-defined aspects in the C
|
|
locale are noted below.
|
|
|
|
The term printing character refers to a member of an
|
|
implementation-defined set of characters, each of which occupies one
|
|
printing position on a display device; the term control character
|
|
refers to a member of an implementation-defined set of characters that
|
|
are not printing characters./90/
|
|
|
|
Forward references: EOF ($4.9.1), localization ($4.4).
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.3.1 Character testing functions
|
|
|
|
The functions in this section return nonzero (true) if and only if
|
|
the value of the argument c conforms to that in the description of the
|
|
function.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.3.1.1 The isalnum function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <ctype.h>
|
|
int isalnum(int c);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The isalnum function tests for any character for which isalpha or
|
|
isdigit is true.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.3.1.2 The isalpha function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <ctype.h>
|
|
int isalpha(int c);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The isalpha function tests for any character for which isupper or
|
|
islower is true, or any of an implementation-defined set of characters
|
|
for which none of iscntrl , isdigit , ispunct , or isspace is true.
|
|
In the C locale, isalpha returns true only for the characters for
|
|
which isupper or islower is true.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.3.1.3 The iscntrl function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <ctype.h>
|
|
int iscntrl(int c);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The iscntrl function tests for any control character.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.3.1.4 The isdigit function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <ctype.h>
|
|
int isdigit(int c);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The isdigit function tests for any decimal-digit character (as
|
|
defined in $2.2.1).
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.3.1.5 The isgraph function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <ctype.h>
|
|
int isgraph(int c);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The isgraph function tests for any printing character except space (' ').
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.3.1.6 The islower function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <ctype.h>
|
|
int islower(int c);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The islower function tests for any lower-case letter or any of an
|
|
implementation-defined set of characters for which none of iscntrl ,
|
|
isdigit , ispunct , or isspace is true. In the C locale, islower
|
|
returns true only for the characters defined as lower-case letters (as
|
|
defined in $2.2.1).
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.3.1.7 The isprint function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <ctype.h>
|
|
int isprint(int c);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The isprint function tests for any printing character including
|
|
space (' ').
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.3.1.8 The ispunct function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <ctype.h>
|
|
int ispunct(int c);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The ispunct function tests for any printing character except space
|
|
(' ') or a character for which isalnum is true.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.3.1.9 The isspace function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <ctype.h>
|
|
int isspace(int c);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The isspace function tests for the standard white-space characters
|
|
or for any of an implementation-defined set of characters for which
|
|
isalnum is false. The standard white-space characters are the
|
|
following: space (' '), form feed ('\f'), new-line ('\n'), carriage
|
|
return ('\r'), horizontal tab ('\t'), and vertical tab ('\v'). In the
|
|
C locale, isspace returns true only for the standard white-space
|
|
characters.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.3.1.10 The isupper function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <ctype.h>
|
|
int isupper(int c);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The isupper function tests for any upper-case letter or any of an
|
|
implementation-defined set of characters for which none of iscntrl ,
|
|
isdigit , ispunct , or isspace is true. In the C locale, isupper
|
|
returns true only for the characters defined as upper-case letters (as
|
|
defined in $2.2.1).
|
|
|
|
4.3.1.11 The isxdigit function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <ctype.h>
|
|
int isxdigit(int c);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The isxdigit function tests for any hexadecimal-digit character (as
|
|
defined in $3.1.3.2).
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.3.2 Character case mapping functions
|
|
|
|
4.3.2.1 The tolower function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <ctype.h>
|
|
int tolower(int c);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The tolower function converts an upper-case letter to the
|
|
corresponding lower-case letter.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
If the argument is an upper-case letter, the tolower function
|
|
returns the corresponding lower-case letter if there is one; otherwise
|
|
the argument is returned unchanged. In the C locale, tolower maps
|
|
only the characters for which isupper is true to the corresponding
|
|
characters for which islower is true.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.3.2.2 The toupper function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <ctype.h>
|
|
int toupper(int c);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The toupper function converts a lower-case letter to the corresponding upper-case letter.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
If the argument is a lower-case letter, the toupper function
|
|
returns the corresponding upper-case letter if there is one; otherwise
|
|
the argument is returned unchanged. In the C locale, toupper maps
|
|
only the characters for which islower is true to the corresponding
|
|
characters for which isupper is true.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.4 LOCALIZATION <locale.h>
|
|
|
|
The header <locale.h> declares two functions, one type, and defines
|
|
several macros.
|
|
|
|
The type is
|
|
|
|
struct lconv
|
|
|
|
which contains members related to the formatting of numeric values.
|
|
The structure shall contain at least the following members, in any
|
|
order. The semantics of the members and their normal ranges is
|
|
explained in $4.4.2.1. In the C locale, the members shall have the
|
|
values specified in the comments.
|
|
|
|
char *decimal_point; /* "." */
|
|
char *thousands_sep; /* "" */
|
|
char *grouping; /* "" */
|
|
char *int_curr_symbol; /* "" */
|
|
char *currency_symbol; /* "" */
|
|
char *mon_decimal_point; /* "" */
|
|
char *mon_thousands_sep; /* "" */
|
|
char *mon_grouping; /* "" */
|
|
char *positive_sign; /* "" */
|
|
char *negative_sign; /* "" */
|
|
char int_frac_digits; /* CHAR_MAX */
|
|
char frac_digits; /* CHAR_MAX */
|
|
char p_cs_precedes; /* CHAR_MAX */
|
|
char p_sep_by_space; /* CHAR_MAX */
|
|
char n_cs_precedes; /* CHAR_MAX */
|
|
char n_sep_by_space; /* CHAR_MAX */
|
|
char p_sign_posn; /* CHAR_MAX */
|
|
char n_sign_posn; /* CHAR_MAX */
|
|
|
|
The macros defined are NULL (described in $4.1.5); and
|
|
|
|
LC_ALL
|
|
LC_COLLATE
|
|
LC_CTYPE
|
|
LC_MONETARY
|
|
LC_NUMERIC
|
|
LC_TIME
|
|
|
|
which expand to distinct integral constant expressions, suitable for
|
|
use as the first argument to the setlocale function. Additional macro
|
|
definitions, beginning with the characters LC_ and an upper-case
|
|
letter,/91/ may also be specified by the implementation.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.4.1 Locale control
|
|
|
|
4.4.1.1 The setlocale function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <locale.h>
|
|
char *setlocale(int category, const char *locale);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The setlocale function selects the appropriate portion of the
|
|
program's locale as specified by the category and locale arguments.
|
|
The setlocale function may be used to change or query the program's
|
|
entire current locale or portions thereof. The value LC_ALL for
|
|
category names the program's entire locale; the other values for
|
|
category name only a portion of the program's locale. LC_COLLATE
|
|
affects the behavior of the strcoll and strxfrm functions. LC_CTYPE
|
|
affects the behavior of the character handling functions/92/ and the
|
|
multibyte functions. LC_MONETARY affects the monetary formatting
|
|
information returned by the localeconv function. LC_NUMERIC affects
|
|
the decimal-point character for the formatted input/output functions
|
|
and the string conversion functions, as well as the non-monetary
|
|
formatting information returned by the localeconv function. LC_TIME
|
|
affects the behavior of the strftime function.
|
|
|
|
A value of "C" for locale specifies the minimal environment for C
|
|
translation; a value of "" for locale specifies the implementation-defined
|
|
native environment. Other implementation-defined strings may be passed
|
|
as the second argument to setlocale .
|
|
|
|
At program startup, the equivalent of
|
|
|
|
setlocale(LC_ALL, "C");
|
|
|
|
is executed.
|
|
|
|
The implementation shall behave as if no library function calls the
|
|
setlocale function.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
If a pointer to a string is given for locale and the selection can
|
|
be honored, the setlocale function returns the string associated with
|
|
the specified category for the new locale. If the selection cannot be
|
|
honored, the setlocale function returns a null pointer and the
|
|
program's locale is not changed.
|
|
|
|
A null pointer for locale causes the setlocale function to return
|
|
the string associated with the category for the program's current
|
|
locale; the program's locale is not changed.
|
|
|
|
The string returned by the setlocale function is such that a
|
|
subsequent call with that string and its associated category will
|
|
restore that part of the program's locale. The string returned shall
|
|
not be modified by the program, but may be overwritten by a subsequent
|
|
call to the setlocale function.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: formatted input/output functions ($4.9.6), the
|
|
multibyte character functions ($4.10.7), the multibyte string
|
|
functions ($4.10.8), string conversion functions ($4.10.1), the
|
|
strcoll function ($4.11.4.3), the strftime function ($4.12.3.5), the
|
|
strxfrm function ($4.11.4.5).
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.4.2 Numeric formatting convention inquiry
|
|
|
|
4.4.2.1 The localeconv function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <locale.h>
|
|
struct lconv *localeconv(void);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The localeconv function sets the components of an object with type
|
|
struct lconv with values appropriate for the formatting of numeric
|
|
quantities (monetary and otherwise) according to the rules of the
|
|
current locale.
|
|
|
|
The members of the structure with type char * are strings, any of
|
|
which (except decimal_point ) can point to , to indicate that the
|
|
value is not available in the current locale or is of zero length.
|
|
The members with type char are nonnegative numbers, any of which can
|
|
be CHAR_MAX to indicate that the value is not available in the current
|
|
locale. The members include the following: The decimal-point
|
|
character used to format non-monetary quantities. The character used
|
|
to separate groups of digits to the left of the decimal-point
|
|
character in formatted non-monetary quantities. A string whose
|
|
elements indicate the size of each group of digits in formatted
|
|
non-monetary quantities. The international currency symbol applicable
|
|
to the current locale. The first three characters contain the
|
|
alphabetic international currency symbol in accordance with those
|
|
specified in ISO 4217 Codes for the Representation of Currency and
|
|
Funds .The fourth character (immediately preceding the null character)
|
|
is the character used to separate the international currency symbol
|
|
from the monetary quantity. The local currency symbol applicable to
|
|
the current locale. The decimal-point used to format monetary
|
|
quantities. The separator for groups of digits to the left of the
|
|
decimal-point in formatted monetary quantities. A string whose
|
|
elements indicate the size of each group of digits in formatted
|
|
monetary quantities. The string used to indicate a nonnegative-valued
|
|
formatted monetary quantity. The string used to indicate a
|
|
negative-valued formatted monetary quantity. The number of fractional
|
|
digits (those to the right of the decimal-point) to be displayed in a
|
|
internationally formatted monetary quantity. The number of fractional
|
|
digits (those to the right of the decimal-point) to be displayed in a
|
|
formatted monetary quantity. Set to 1 or 0 if the currency_symbol
|
|
respectively precedes or succeeds the value for a nonnegative
|
|
formatted monetary quantity. Set to 1 or 0 if the currency_symbol
|
|
respectively is or is not separated by a space from the value for a
|
|
nonnegative formatted monetary quantity. Set to 1 or 0 if the
|
|
currency_symbol respectively precedes or succeeds the value for a
|
|
negative formatted monetary quantity. Set to 1 or 0 if the
|
|
currency_symbol respectively is or is not separated by a space from
|
|
the value for a negative formatted monetary quantity. Set to a value
|
|
indicating the positioning of the positive_sign for a nonnegative
|
|
formatted monetary quantity. Set to a value indicating the
|
|
positioning of the negative_sign for a negative formatted monetary
|
|
quantity.
|
|
|
|
The elements of grouping and mon_grouping are interpreted according
|
|
to the following: No further grouping is to be performed. The
|
|
previous element is to be repeatedly used for the remainder of the
|
|
digits. The value is the number of digits that comprise the current
|
|
group. The next element is examined to determine the size of the next
|
|
group of digits to the left of the current group.
|
|
|
|
The value of p_sign_posn and n_sign_posn is interpreted according
|
|
to the following: Parentheses surround the quantity and
|
|
currency_symbol. The sign string precedes the quantity and
|
|
currency_symbol. The sign string succeeds the quantity and
|
|
currency_symbol. The sign string immediately precedes the
|
|
currency_symbol. The sign string immediately succeeds the
|
|
currency_symbol.
|
|
|
|
The implementation shall behave as if no library function calls the
|
|
localeconv function.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The localeconv function returns a pointer to the filled-in object.
|
|
The structure pointed to by the return value shall not be modified by
|
|
the program, but may be overwritten by a subsequent call to the
|
|
localeconv function. In addition, calls to the setlocale function
|
|
with categories LC_ALL , LC_MONETARY , or LC_NUMERIC may overwrite the
|
|
contents of the structure.
|
|
|
|
Examples
|
|
|
|
The following table illustrates the rules used by four countries to
|
|
format monetary quantities.
|
|
|
|
Country Positive format Negative format International format
|
|
|
|
Italy L.1.234 -L.1.234 ITL.1.234
|
|
Netherlands F 1.234,56 F -1.234,56 NLG 1.234,56
|
|
Norway kr1.234,56 kr1.234,56- NOK 1.234,56
|
|
Switzerland SFrs.1,234.56 SFrs.1,234.56C CHF 1,234.56
|
|
|
|
|
|
For these four countries, the respective values for the monetary
|
|
members of the structure returned by localeconv are:
|
|
|
|
Italy Netherlands Norway Switzerland
|
|
|
|
int_curr_symbol "ITL." "NLG " "NOK " "CHF "
|
|
currency_symbol "L." "F" "kr" "SFrs."
|
|
mon_decimal_point "" "," "," "."
|
|
mon_thousands_sep "." "." "." ","
|
|
mon_grouping "\3" "\3" "\3" "\3"
|
|
positive_sign "" "" "" ""
|
|
negative_sign "-" "-" "-" "C"
|
|
int_frac_digits 0 2 2 2
|
|
frac_digits 0 2 2 2
|
|
p_cs_precedes 1 1 1 1
|
|
p_sep_by_space 0 1 0 0
|
|
n_cs_precedes 1 1 1 1
|
|
n_sep_by_space 0 1 0 0
|
|
p_sign_posn 1 1 1 1
|
|
n_sign_posn 1 4 2 2
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.5 MATHEMATICS <math.h>
|
|
|
|
The header <math.h> declares several mathematical functions and
|
|
defines one macro. The functions take double-precision arguments and
|
|
return double-precision values./93/ Integer arithmetic functions and
|
|
conversion functions are discussed later.
|
|
|
|
The macro defined is
|
|
|
|
HUGE_VAL
|
|
|
|
which expands to a positive double expression, not necessarily
|
|
representable as a float .
|
|
|
|
Forward references: integer arithmetic functions ($4.10.6), the atof
|
|
function ($4.10.1.1), the strtod function ($4.10.1.4).
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.5.1 Treatment of error conditions
|
|
|
|
The behavior of each of these functions is defined for all
|
|
representable values of its input arguments. Each function shall
|
|
execute as if it were a single operation, without generating any
|
|
externally visible exceptions.
|
|
|
|
For all functions, a domain error occurs if an input argument is
|
|
outside the domain over which the mathematical function is defined.
|
|
The description of each function lists any required domain errors; an
|
|
implementation may define additional domain errors, provided that such
|
|
errors are consistent with the mathematical definition of the
|
|
function./94/ On a domain error, the function returns an
|
|
implementation-defined value; the value of the macro EDOM is stored in
|
|
errno .
|
|
|
|
Similarly, a range error occurs if the result of the function
|
|
cannot be represented as a double value. If the result overflows (the
|
|
magnitude of the result is so large that it cannot be represented in
|
|
an object of the specified type), the function returns the value of
|
|
the macro HUGE_VAL , with the same sign as the correct value of the
|
|
function; the value of the macro ERANGE is stored in errno . If the
|
|
result underflows (the magnitude of the result is so small that it
|
|
cannot be represented in an object of the specified type), the
|
|
function returns zero; whether the integer expression errno acquires
|
|
the value of the macro ERANGE is implementation-defined.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.5.2 Trigonometric functions
|
|
|
|
4.5.2.1 The acos function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <math.h>
|
|
double acos(double x);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The acos function computes the principal value of the arc cosine of x.
|
|
A domain error occurs for arguments not in the range [-1, +1].
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The acos function returns the arc cosine in the range [0, PI] radians.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.5.2.2 The asin function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <math.h>
|
|
double asin(double x);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The asin function computes the principal value of the arc sine of x.
|
|
A domain error occurs for arguments not in the range [-1, +1].
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The asin function returns the arc sine in the range [-PI/2, +PI/2]
|
|
radians.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.5.2.3 The atan function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <math.h>
|
|
double atan(double x);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The atan function computes the principal value of the arc tangent of x.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The atan function returns the arc tangent in the range [-PI/2, +PI/2]
|
|
radians.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.5.2.4 The atan2 function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <math.h>
|
|
double atan2(double y, double x);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The atan2 function computes the principal value of the arc tangent
|
|
of y/x , using the signs of both arguments to determine the quadrant
|
|
of the return value. A domain error may occur if both arguments are
|
|
zero.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The atan2 function returns the arc tangent of y/x , in the range
|
|
[-PI, +PI] radians.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.5.2.5 The cos function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <math.h>
|
|
double cos(double x);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The cos function computes the cosine of x (measured in radians). A
|
|
large magnitude argument may yield a result with little or no
|
|
significance.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The cos function returns the cosine value.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.5.2.6 The sin function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <math.h>
|
|
double sin(double x);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The sin function computes the sine of x (measured in radians). A
|
|
large magnitude argument may yield a result with little or no
|
|
significance.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The sin function returns the sine value.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.5.2.7 The tan function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <math.h>
|
|
double tan(double x);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The tan function returns the tangent of x (measured in radians). A large magnitude argument may yield a result with little or no significance.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The tan function returns the tangent value.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.5.3 Hyperbolic functions
|
|
|
|
4.5.3.1 The cosh function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <math.h>
|
|
double cosh(double x);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The cosh function computes the hyperbolic cosine of x. A range
|
|
error occurs if the magnitude of x is too large.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The cosh function returns the hyperbolic cosine value.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.5.3.2 The sinh function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <math.h>
|
|
double sinh(double x);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The sinh function computes the hyperbolic sine of x . A range error occurs if the magnitude of x is too large.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The sinh function returns the hyperbolic sine value.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.5.3.3 The tanh function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <math.h>
|
|
double tanh(double x);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The tanh function computes the hyperbolic tangent of x .
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The tanh function returns the hyperbolic tangent value.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.5.4 Exponential and logarithmic functions
|
|
|
|
4.5.4.1 The exp function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <math.h>
|
|
double exp(double x);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The exp function computes the exponential function of x . A range
|
|
error occurs if the magnitude of x is too large.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The exp function returns the exponential value.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.5.4.2 The frexp function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <math.h>
|
|
double frexp(double value, int *exp);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The frexp function breaks a floating-point number into a normalized
|
|
fraction and an integral power of 2. It stores the integer in the int
|
|
object pointed to by exp .
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The frexp function returns the value x , such that x is a double
|
|
with magnitude in the interval [1/2, 1) or zero, and value equals x
|
|
times 2 raised to the power *exp . If value is zero, both parts of
|
|
the result are zero.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.5.4.3 The ldexp function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <math.h>
|
|
double ldexp(double x, int exp);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The ldexp function multiplies a floating-point number by an
|
|
integral power of 2. A range error may occur.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The ldexp function returns the value of x times 2 raised to the
|
|
power exp .
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.5.4.4 The log function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <math.h>
|
|
double log(double x);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The log function computes the natural logarithm of x. A domain
|
|
error occurs if the argument is negative. A range error occurs if the
|
|
argument is zero and the logarithm of zero cannot be represented.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The log function returns the natural logarithm.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.5.4.5 The log10 function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <math.h>
|
|
double log10(double x);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The log10 function computes the base-ten logarithm of x . A domain
|
|
error occurs if the argument is negative. A range error occurs if the
|
|
argument is zero and the logarithm of zero cannot be represented.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The log10 function returns the base-ten logarithm.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.5.4.6 The modf function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <math.h>
|
|
double modf(double value, double *iptr);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The modf function breaks the argument value into integral and
|
|
fractional parts, each of which has the same sign as the argument. It
|
|
stores the integral part as a double in the object pointed to by iptr.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The modf function returns the signed fractional part of value .
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.5.5 Power functions
|
|
|
|
4.5.5.1 The pow function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <math.h>
|
|
double pow(double x, double y);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The pow function computes x raised to the power y . A domain error
|
|
occurs if x is negative and y is not an integer. A domain error
|
|
occurs if the result cannot be represented when x is zero and y is
|
|
less than or equal to zero. A range error may occur.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The pow function returns the value of x raised to the power y .
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.5.5.2 The sqrt function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <math.h>
|
|
double sqrt(double x);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The sqrt function computes the nonnegative square root of x . A
|
|
domain error occurs if the argument is negative.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The sqrt function returns the value of the square root.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.5.6 Nearest integer, absolute value, and remainder functions
|
|
|
|
4.5.6.1 The ceil function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <math.h>
|
|
double ceil(double x);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The ceil function computes the smallest integral value not less than x .
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The ceil function returns the smallest integral value not less than
|
|
x , expressed as a double.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.5.6.2 The fabs function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <math.h>
|
|
double fabs(double x);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The fabs function computes the absolute value of a floating-point
|
|
number x .
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The fabs function returns the absolute value of x.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.5.6.3 The floor function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <math.h>
|
|
double floor(double x);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The floor function computes the largest integral value not greater
|
|
than x .
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The floor function returns the largest integral value not greater
|
|
than x , expressed as a double.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.5.6.4 The fmod function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <math.h>
|
|
double fmod(double x, double y);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The fmod function computes the floating-point remainder of x/y .
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The fmod function returns the value x i y , for some integer i such
|
|
that, if y is nonzero, the result has the same sign as x and magnitude
|
|
less than the magnitude of y . If y is zero, whether a domain error
|
|
occurs or the fmod function returns zero is implementation-defined.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.6 NON-LOCAL JUMPS <setjmp.h>
|
|
|
|
The header <setjmp.h> defines the macro setjmp , and declares one
|
|
function and one type, for bypassing the normal function call and
|
|
return discipline./95/
|
|
|
|
The type declared is
|
|
|
|
jmp_buf
|
|
|
|
which is an array type suitable for holding the information needed to
|
|
restore a calling environment.
|
|
|
|
It is unspecified whether setjmp is a macro or an identifier
|
|
declared with external linkage. If a macro definition is suppressed
|
|
in order to access an actual function, or a program defines an
|
|
external identifier with the name setjmp , the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.6.1 Save calling environment
|
|
|
|
4.6.1.1 The setjmp macro
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <setjmp.h>
|
|
int setjmp(jmp_buf env);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The setjmp macro saves its calling environment in its jmp_buf
|
|
argument for later use by the longjmp function.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
If the return is from a direct invocation, the setjmp macro returns
|
|
the value zero. If the return is from a call to the longjmp function,
|
|
the setjmp macro returns a nonzero value.
|
|
|
|
"Environmental constraint"
|
|
|
|
An invocation of the setjmp macro shall appear only in one of the
|
|
following contexts:
|
|
|
|
* the entire controlling expression of a selection or iteration statement;
|
|
|
|
* one operand of a relational or equality operator with the other
|
|
operand an integral constant expression, with the resulting expression
|
|
being the entire controlling expression of a selection or iteration
|
|
statement;
|
|
|
|
* the operand of a unary ! operator with the resulting expression
|
|
being the entire controlling expression of a selection or iteration
|
|
statement; or
|
|
|
|
* the entire expression of an expression statement (possibly cast to void).
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.6.2 Restore calling environment
|
|
|
|
4.6.2.1 The longjmp function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <setjmp.h>
|
|
void longjmp(jmp_buf env, int val);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The longjmp function restores the environment saved by the most
|
|
recent invocation of the setjmp macro in the same invocation of the
|
|
program, with the corresponding jmp_buf argument. If there has been
|
|
no such invocation, or if the function containing the invocation of
|
|
the setjmp macro has terminated execution/96/ in the interim, the
|
|
behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
All accessible objects have values as of the time longjmp was
|
|
called, except that the values of objects of automatic storage
|
|
duration that do not have volatile type and have been changed between
|
|
the setjmp invocation and longjmp call are indeterminate.
|
|
|
|
As it bypasses the usual function call and return mechanisms, the
|
|
longjmp function shall execute correctly in contexts of interrupts,
|
|
signals and any of their associated functions. However, if the
|
|
longjmp function is invoked from a nested signal handler (that is,
|
|
from a function invoked as a result of a signal raised during the
|
|
handling of another signal), the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
After longjmp is completed, program execution continues as if the
|
|
corresponding invocation of the setjmp macro had just returned the
|
|
value specified by val . The longjmp function cannot cause the setjmp
|
|
macro to return the value 0; if val is 0, the setjmp macro returns the
|
|
value 1.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.7 SIGNAL HANDLING <signal.h>
|
|
|
|
The header <signal.h> declares a type and two functions and defines
|
|
several macros, for handling various signals (conditions that may be
|
|
reported during program execution).
|
|
|
|
The type defined is
|
|
|
|
sig_atomic_t
|
|
|
|
which is the integral type of an object that can be accessed as an
|
|
atomic entity, even in the presence of asynchronous interrupts.
|
|
|
|
The macros defined are
|
|
|
|
SIG_DFL
|
|
SIG_ERR
|
|
SIG_IGN
|
|
|
|
which expand to distinct constant expressions that have type
|
|
compatible with the second argument to and the return value of the
|
|
signal function, and whose value compares unequal to the address of
|
|
any declarable function; and the following, each of which expands to a
|
|
positive integral constant expression that is the signal number
|
|
corresponding to the specified condition:
|
|
|
|
SIGABRT abnormal termination, such as is initiated by the abort function
|
|
|
|
SIGFPE an erroneous arithmetic operation, such as zero divide or an
|
|
operation resulting in overflow
|
|
|
|
SIGILL detection of an invalid function image, such as an illegal
|
|
instruction
|
|
|
|
SIGINT receipt of an interactive attention signal
|
|
|
|
SIGSEGV an invalid access to storage
|
|
|
|
SIGTERM a termination request sent to the program
|
|
|
|
An implementation need not generate any of these signals, except as
|
|
a result of explicit calls to the raise function. Additional signals
|
|
and pointers to undeclarable functions, with macro definitions
|
|
beginning, respectively, with the letters SIG and an upper-case letter
|
|
or with SIG_ and an upper-case letter,/97/ may also be specified by
|
|
the implementation. The complete set of signals, their semantics, and
|
|
their default handling is implementation-defined; all signal values
|
|
shall be positive.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.7.1 Specify signal handling
|
|
|
|
4.7.1.1 The signal function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <signal.h>
|
|
void (*signal(int sig, void (*func)(int)))(int);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The signal function chooses one of three ways in which receipt of
|
|
the signal number sig is to be subsequently handled. If the value of
|
|
func is SIG_DFL , default handling for that signal will occur. If the
|
|
value of func is SIG_IGN , the signal will be ignored. Otherwise,
|
|
func shall point to a function to be called when that signal occurs.
|
|
Such a function is called a signal handler .
|
|
|
|
When a signal occurs, if func points to a function, first the
|
|
equivalent of signal(sig, SIG_DFL); is executed or an
|
|
implementation-defined blocking of the signal is performed. (If the
|
|
value of sig is SIGILL, whether the reset to SIG_DFL occurs is
|
|
implementation-defined.) Next the equivalent of (*func)(sig); is
|
|
executed. The function func may terminate by executing a return
|
|
statement or by calling the abort , exit , or longjmp function. If
|
|
func executes a return statement and the value of sig was SIGFPE or
|
|
any other implementation-defined value corresponding to a
|
|
computational exception, the behavior is undefined. Otherwise, the
|
|
program will resume execution at the point it was interrupted.
|
|
|
|
If the signal occurs other than as the result of calling the abort
|
|
or raise function, the behavior is undefined if the signal handler
|
|
calls any function in the standard library other than the signal
|
|
function itself or refers to any object with static storage duration
|
|
other than by assigning a value to a static storage duration variable
|
|
of type volatile sig_atomic_t . Furthermore, if such a call to the
|
|
signal function results in a SIG_ERR return, the value of errno is
|
|
indeterminate.
|
|
|
|
At program startup, the equivalent of
|
|
|
|
signal(sig, SIG_IGN);
|
|
|
|
may be executed for some signals selected in an implementation-defined
|
|
manner; the equivalent of
|
|
|
|
signal(sig, SIG_DFL);
|
|
|
|
is executed for all other signals defined by the implementation.
|
|
|
|
The implementation shall behave as if no library function calls the
|
|
signal function.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
If the request can be honored, the signal function returns the
|
|
value of func for the most recent call to signal for the specified
|
|
signal sig . Otherwise, a value of SIG_ERR is returned and a positive
|
|
value is stored in errno .
|
|
|
|
Forward references: the abort function ($4.10.4.1).
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.7.2 Send signal
|
|
|
|
4.7.2.1 The raise function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <signal.h>
|
|
int raise(int sig);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The raise function sends the signal sig to the executing program.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The raise function returns zero if successful, nonzero if unsuccessful.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.8 VARIABLE ARGUMENTS <stdarg.h>
|
|
|
|
The header <stdarg.h> declares a type and defines three macros, for
|
|
advancing through a list of arguments whose number and types are not
|
|
known to the called function when it is translated.
|
|
|
|
A function may be called with a variable number of arguments of
|
|
varying types. As described in $3.7.1, its parameter list contains
|
|
one or more parameters. The rightmost parameter plays a special role
|
|
in the access mechanism, and will be designated parmN in this
|
|
description.
|
|
|
|
The type declared is
|
|
|
|
va_list
|
|
|
|
which is a type suitable for holding information needed by the macros
|
|
va_start , va_arg , and va_end . If access to the varying arguments
|
|
is desired, the called function shall declare an object (referred to
|
|
as ap in this section) having type va_list . The object ap may be
|
|
passed as an argument to another function; if that function invokes
|
|
the va_arg macro with parameter ap , the value of ap in the calling
|
|
function is indeterminate and shall be passed to the va_end macro
|
|
prior to any further reference to ap .
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.8.1 Variable argument list access macros
|
|
|
|
The va_start and va_arg macros described in this section shall be
|
|
implemented as macros, not as actual functions. It is unspecified
|
|
whether va_end is a macro or an identifier declared with external
|
|
linkage. If a macro definition is suppressed in order to access an
|
|
actual function, or a program defines an external identifier with the
|
|
name va_end , the behavior is undefined. The va_start and va_end
|
|
macros shall be invoked in the function accepting a varying number of
|
|
arguments, if access to the varying arguments is desired.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.8.1.1 The va_start macro
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdarg.h>
|
|
void va_start(va_list ap, parmN);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The va_start macro shall be invoked before any access to the
|
|
unnamed arguments.
|
|
|
|
The va_start macro initializes ap for subsequent use by va_arg and
|
|
va_end .
|
|
|
|
The parameter parmN is the identifier of the rightmost parameter in
|
|
the variable parameter list in the function definition (the one just
|
|
before the , ... ). If the parameter parmN is declared with the
|
|
register storage class, with a function or array type, or with a type
|
|
that is not compatible with the type that results after application of
|
|
the default argument promotions, the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The va_start macro returns no value.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.8.1.2 The va_arg macro
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdarg.h>
|
|
type va_arg(va_list ap, type);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The va_arg macro expands to an expression that has the type and
|
|
value of the next argument in the call. The parameter ap shall be the
|
|
same as the va_list ap initialized by va_start . Each invocation of
|
|
va_arg modifies ap so that the values of successive arguments are
|
|
returned in turn. The parameter type is a type name specified such
|
|
that the type of a pointer to an object that has the specified type
|
|
can be obtained simply by postfixing a * to type . If there is no
|
|
actual next argument, or if type is not compatible with the type of
|
|
the actual next argument (as promoted according to the default
|
|
argument promotions), the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The first invocation of the va_arg macro after that of the va_start
|
|
macro returns the value of the argument after that specified by parmN.
|
|
Successive invocations return the values of the remaining arguments
|
|
in succession.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.8.1.3 The va_end macro
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdarg.h>
|
|
void va_end(va_list ap);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The va_end macro facilitates a normal return from the function
|
|
whose variable argument list was referred to by the expansion of
|
|
va_start that initialized the va_list ap . The va_end macro may
|
|
modify ap so that it is no longer usable (without an intervening
|
|
invocation of va_start ). If there is no corresponding invocation of
|
|
the va_start macro, or if the va_end macro is not invoked before the
|
|
return, the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The va_end macro returns no value.
|
|
|
|
Example
|
|
|
|
The function f1 gathers into an array a list of arguments that are
|
|
pointers to strings (but not more than MAXARGS arguments), then passes
|
|
the array as a single argument to function f2 . The number of
|
|
pointers is specified by the first argument to f1 .
|
|
|
|
#include <stdarg.h>
|
|
#define MAXARGS 31
|
|
|
|
void f1(int n_ptrs, ...)
|
|
{
|
|
va_list ap;
|
|
char *array[MAXARGS];
|
|
int ptr_no = 0;
|
|
|
|
if (n_ptrs > MAXARGS)
|
|
n_ptrs = MAXARGS;
|
|
va_start(ap, n_ptrs);
|
|
while (ptr_no < n_ptrs)
|
|
array[ptr_no++] = va_arg(ap, char *);
|
|
va_end(ap);
|
|
f2(n_ptrs, array);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Each call to f1 shall have visible the definition of the function or a
|
|
declaration such as
|
|
|
|
void f1(int, ...);
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9 INPUT/OUTPUT <stdio.h>
|
|
|
|
4.9.1 Introduction
|
|
|
|
The header <stdio.h> declares three types, several macros, and many
|
|
functions for performing input and output.
|
|
|
|
The types declared are size_t (described in $4.1.5);
|
|
|
|
FILE
|
|
|
|
which is an object type capable of recording all the information
|
|
needed to control a stream, including its file position indicator, a
|
|
pointer to its associated buffer, an error indicator that records
|
|
whether a read/write error has occurred, and an end-of-file indicator
|
|
that records whether the end of the file has been reached; and
|
|
|
|
fpos_t
|
|
|
|
which is an object type capable of recording all the information
|
|
needed to specify uniquely every position within a file.
|
|
|
|
The macros are NULL (described in $4.1.5);
|
|
|
|
_IOFBF
|
|
_IOLBF
|
|
_IONBF
|
|
|
|
which expand to distinct integral constant expressions, suitable for
|
|
use as the third argument to the setvbuf function;
|
|
|
|
BUFSIZ
|
|
|
|
which expands to an integral constant expression, which is the size of
|
|
the buffer used by the setbuf function;
|
|
|
|
EOF
|
|
|
|
which expands to a negative integral constant expression that is
|
|
returned by several functions to indicate end-of-file ,that is, no
|
|
more input from a stream;
|
|
|
|
FOPEN_MAX
|
|
|
|
which expands to an integral constant expression that is the minimum
|
|
number of files that the implementation guarantees can be open
|
|
simultaneously;
|
|
|
|
FILENAME_MAX
|
|
|
|
which expands to an integral constant expression that is the maximum
|
|
length for a file name string that the implementation guarantees can
|
|
be opened;/98/
|
|
|
|
L_tmpnam
|
|
|
|
which expands to an integral constant expression that is the size of
|
|
an array of char large enough to hold a temporary file name string
|
|
generated by the tmpnam function;
|
|
|
|
SEEK_CUR
|
|
SEEK_END
|
|
SEEK_SET
|
|
|
|
which expand to distinct integral constant expressions, suitable for
|
|
use as the third argument to the fseek function;
|
|
|
|
TMP_MAX
|
|
|
|
which expands to an integral constant expression that is the minimum
|
|
number of unique file names that shall be generated by the tmpnam
|
|
function;
|
|
|
|
stderr
|
|
stdin
|
|
stdout
|
|
|
|
which are expressions of type ``pointer to FILE '' that point to the
|
|
FILE objects associated, respectively, with the standard error, input,
|
|
and output streams.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: files ($4.9.3), the fseek function ($4.9.9.2),
|
|
streams ($4.9.2), the tmpnam function ($4.9.4.4).
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.2 Streams
|
|
|
|
Input and output, whether to or from physical devices such as
|
|
terminals and tape drives, or whether to or from files supported on
|
|
structured storage devices, are mapped into logical data streams
|
|
,whose properties are more uniform than their various inputs and
|
|
outputs. Two forms of mapping are supported, for text streams and for
|
|
binary streams ./99/
|
|
|
|
A text stream is an ordered sequence of characters composed into
|
|
lines , each line consisting of zero or more characters plus a
|
|
terminating new-line character. Whether the last line requires a
|
|
terminating new-line character is implementation-defined. Characters
|
|
may have to be added, altered, or deleted on input and output to
|
|
conform to differing conventions for representing text in the host
|
|
environment. Thus, there need not be a one-to-one correspondence
|
|
between the characters in a stream and those in the external
|
|
representation. Data read in from a text stream will necessarily
|
|
compare equal to the data that were earlier written out to that stream
|
|
only if: the data consist only of printable characters and the control
|
|
characters horizontal tab and new-line; no new-line character is
|
|
immediately preceded by space characters; and the last character is a
|
|
new-line character. Whether space characters that are written out
|
|
immediately before a new-line character appear when read in is
|
|
implementation-defined.
|
|
|
|
A binary stream is an ordered sequence of characters that can
|
|
transparently record internal data. Data read in from a binary stream
|
|
shall compare equal to the data that were earlier written out to that
|
|
stream, under the same implementation. Such a stream may, however,
|
|
have an implementation-defined number of null characters appended.
|
|
|
|
"Environmental limits"
|
|
|
|
An implementation shall support text files with lines containing at
|
|
least 254 characters, including the terminating new-line character.
|
|
The value of the macro BUFSIZ shall be at least 256.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.3 Files
|
|
|
|
A stream is associated with an external file (which may be a
|
|
physical device) by opening a file, which may involve creating a new
|
|
file. Creating an existing file causes its former contents to be
|
|
discarded, if necessary, so that it appears as if newly created. If a
|
|
file can support positioning requests (such as a disk file, as opposed
|
|
to a terminal), then a file position indicator /100/ associated with
|
|
the stream is positioned at the start (character number zero) of the
|
|
file, unless the file is opened with append mode in which case it is
|
|
implementation-defined whether the file position indicator is
|
|
positioned at the beginning or the end of the file. The file position
|
|
indicator is maintained by subsequent reads, writes, and positioning
|
|
requests, to facilitate an orderly progression through the file. All
|
|
input takes place as if characters were read by successive calls to the
|
|
fgetc function; all output takes place as if characters were written by
|
|
successive calls to the fputc function.
|
|
|
|
Binary files are not truncated, except as defined in $4.9.5.3.
|
|
Whether a write on a text stream causes the associated file to be
|
|
truncated beyond that point is implementation-defined.
|
|
|
|
When a stream is unbuffered, characters are intended to appear
|
|
from the source or at the destination as soon as possible. Otherwise
|
|
characters may be accumulated and transmitted to or from the host
|
|
environment as a block. When a stream is fully buffered, characters
|
|
are intended to be transmitted to or from the host environment as a
|
|
block when a buffer is filled. When a stream is line buffered,
|
|
characters are intended to be transmitted to or from the host
|
|
environment as a block when a new-line character is encountered.
|
|
Furthermore, characters are intended to be transmitted as a block to
|
|
the host environment when a buffer is filled, when input is requested
|
|
on an unbuffered stream, or when input is requested on a line buffered
|
|
stream that requires the transmission of characters from the host
|
|
environment. Support for these characteristics is
|
|
implementation-defined, and may be affected via the setbuf and setvbuf
|
|
functions.
|
|
|
|
A file may be disassociated from its controlling stream by closing
|
|
the file. Output streams are flushed (any unwritten buffer contents
|
|
are transmitted to the host environment) before the stream is
|
|
disassociated from the file. The value of a pointer to a FILE object
|
|
is indeterminate after the associated file is closed (including the
|
|
standard text streams). Whether a file of zero length (on which no
|
|
characters have been written by an output stream) actually exists is
|
|
implementation-defined.
|
|
|
|
The file may be subsequently reopened, by the same or another
|
|
program execution, and its contents reclaimed or modified (if it can
|
|
be repositioned at its start). If the main function returns to its
|
|
original caller, or if the exit function is called, all open files are
|
|
closed (hence all output streams are flushed) before program
|
|
termination. Other paths to program termination, such as calling the
|
|
abort function, need not close all files properly.
|
|
|
|
The address of the FILE object used to control a stream may be
|
|
significant; a copy of a FILE object may not necessarily serve in
|
|
place of the original.
|
|
|
|
At program startup, three text streams are predefined and need not
|
|
be opened explicitly --- standard input (for reading conventional
|
|
input), standard output (for writing conventional output), and
|
|
standard error (for writing diagnostic output). When opened, the
|
|
standard error stream is not fully buffered; the standard input and
|
|
standard output streams are fully buffered if and only if the stream
|
|
can be determined not to refer to an interactive device.
|
|
|
|
Functions that open additional (nontemporary) files require a file
|
|
name, which is a string. The rules for composing valid file names are
|
|
implementation-defined. Whether the same file can be simultaneously
|
|
open multiple times is also implementation-defined.
|
|
|
|
"Environmental limits"
|
|
|
|
The value of the macro FOPEN_MAX shall be at least eight, including
|
|
the three standard text streams.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: the exit function ($4.10.4.3), the fgetc function
|
|
($4.9.7.1), the fopen function ($4.9.5.3), the fputc function
|
|
($4.9.7.3), the setbuf function ($4.9.5.5), the setvbuf function
|
|
($4.9.5.6).
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.4 Operations on files
|
|
|
|
4.9.4.1 The remove function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
int remove(const char *filename);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The remove function causes the file whose name is the string
|
|
pointed to by filename to be no longer accessible by that name. A
|
|
subsequent attempt to open that file using that name will fail, unless
|
|
it is created anew. If the file is open, the behavior of the remove
|
|
function is implementation-defined.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The remove function returns zero if the operation succeeds, nonzero
|
|
if it fails.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.4.2 The rename function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
int rename(const char *old, const char *new);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The rename function causes the file whose name is the string
|
|
pointed to by old to be henceforth known by the name given by the
|
|
string pointed to by new . The file named old is effectively removed.
|
|
If a file named by the string pointed to by new exists prior to the
|
|
call to the rename function, the behavior is implementation-defined.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The rename function returns zero if the operation succeeds, nonzero
|
|
if it fails,/101/ in which case if the file existed previously it is
|
|
still known by its original name.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.4.3 The tmpfile function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
FILE *tmpfile(void);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The tmpfile function creates a temporary binary file that will
|
|
automatically be removed when it is closed or at program termination.
|
|
If the program terminates abnormally, whether an open temporary file
|
|
is removed is implementation-defined. The file is opened for update
|
|
with wb+ mode.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The tmpfile function returns a pointer to the stream of the file
|
|
that it created. If the file cannot be created, the tmpfile function
|
|
returns a null pointer.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: the fopen function ($4.9.5.3).
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.4.4 The tmpnam function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
char *tmpnam(char *s);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The tmpnam function generates a string that is a valid file name
|
|
and that is not the same as the name of an existing file./102/
|
|
|
|
The tmpnam function generates a different string each time it is
|
|
called, up to TMP_MAX times. If it is called more than TMP_MAX times,
|
|
the behavior is implementation-defined.
|
|
|
|
The implementation shall behave as if no library function calls the
|
|
tmpnam function.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
If the argument is a null pointer, the tmpnam function leaves its
|
|
result in an internal static object and returns a pointer to that
|
|
object. Subsequent calls to the tmpnam function may modify the same
|
|
object. If the argument is not a null pointer, it is assumed to point
|
|
to an array of at least L_tmpnam char s; the tmpnam function writes
|
|
its result in that array and returns the argument as its value.
|
|
|
|
"Environmental limits"
|
|
|
|
The value of the macro TMP_MAX shall be at least 25.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.5 File access functions
|
|
|
|
4.9.5.1 The fclose function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
int fclose(FILE *stream);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The fclose function causes the stream pointed to by stream to be
|
|
flushed and the associated file to be closed. Any unwritten buffered
|
|
data for the stream are delivered to the host environment to be
|
|
written to the file; any unread buffered data are discarded. The
|
|
stream is disassociated from the file. If the associated buffer was
|
|
automatically allocated, it is deallocated.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The fclose function returns zero if the stream was successfully
|
|
closed, or EOF if any errors were detected.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.5.2 The fflush function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
int fflush(FILE *stream);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
If stream points to an output stream or an update stream in which
|
|
the most recent operation was output, the fflush function causes any
|
|
unwritten data for that stream to be delivered to the host environment
|
|
to be written to the file; otherwise, the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
If stream is a null pointer, the fflush function performs this
|
|
flushing action on all streams for which the behavior is defined
|
|
above.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The fflush function returns EOF if a write error occurs, otherwise zero.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: the ungetc function ($4.9.7.11).
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.5.3 The fopen function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
FILE *fopen(const char *filename, const char *mode);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The fopen function opens the file whose name is the string pointed
|
|
to by filename , and associates a stream with it.
|
|
|
|
The argument mode points to a string beginning with one of the
|
|
following sequences:/103/
|
|
|
|
"r" open text file for reading
|
|
"w" truncate to zero length or create text file for writing
|
|
"a" append; open or create text file for writing at end-of-file
|
|
"rb" open binary file for reading
|
|
"wb" truncate to zero length or create binary file for writing
|
|
"ab" append; open or create binary file for writing at end-of-file
|
|
"r+" open text file for update (reading and writing)
|
|
"w+" truncate to zero length or create text file for update
|
|
"a+" append; open or create text file for update, writing at
|
|
end-of-file
|
|
"r+b" or "rb+" open binary file for update (reading and writing)
|
|
"w+b" or "wb+" truncate to zero length or create binary file for update
|
|
"a+b" or "ab+" append; open or create binary file for update, writing at
|
|
end-of-file
|
|
|
|
|
|
Opening a file with read mode ('r' as the first character in the
|
|
mode argument) fails if the file does not exist or cannot be read.
|
|
|
|
Opening a file with append mode ('a' as the first character in the
|
|
mode argument) causes all subsequent writes to the file to be forced
|
|
to the then current end-of-file, regardless of intervening calls to
|
|
the fseek function. In some implementations, opening a binary file
|
|
with append mode ('b' as the second or third character in the mode
|
|
argument) may initially position the file position indicator for the
|
|
stream beyond the last data written, because of null character
|
|
padding.
|
|
|
|
When a file is opened with update mode ('+' as the second or third
|
|
character in the mode argument), both input and output may be
|
|
performed on the associated stream. However, output may not be
|
|
directly followed by input without an intervening call to the fflush
|
|
function or to a file positioning function ( fseek , fsetpos , or
|
|
rewind ), and input may not be directly followed by output without an
|
|
intervening call to a file positioning function, unless the input
|
|
operation encounters end-of-file. Opening a file with update mode may
|
|
open or create a binary stream in some implementations.
|
|
|
|
When opened, a stream is fully buffered if and only if it can be
|
|
determined not to refer to an interactive device. The error and
|
|
end-of-file indicators for the stream are cleared.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The fopen function returns a pointer to the object controlling the
|
|
stream. If the open operation fails, fopen returns a null pointer.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: file positioning functions ($4.9.9).
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.5.4 The freopen function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
FILE *freopen(const char *filename, const char *mode,
|
|
FILE *stream);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The freopen function opens the file whose name is the string
|
|
pointed to by filename and associates the stream pointed to by stream
|
|
with it. The mode argument is used just as in the fopen
|
|
function./104/
|
|
|
|
The freopen function first attempts to close any file that is
|
|
associated with the specified stream. Failure to close the file
|
|
successfully is ignored. The error and end-of-file indicators for the
|
|
stream are cleared.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The freopen function returns a null pointer if the open operation
|
|
fails. Otherwise, freopen returns the value of stream .
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.5.5 The setbuf function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
void setbuf(FILE *stream, char *buf);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
Except that it returns no value, the setbuf function is equivalent
|
|
to the setvbuf function invoked with the values _IOFBF for mode and
|
|
BUFSIZ for size , or (if buf is a null pointer), with the value _IONBF
|
|
for mode .
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The setbuf function returns no value.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: the setvbuf function ($4.9.5.6).
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.5.6 The setvbuf function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
int setvbuf(FILE *stream, char *buf, int mode, size_t size);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The setvbuf function may be used after the stream pointed to by
|
|
stream has been associated with an open file but before any other
|
|
operation is performed on the stream. The argument mode determines
|
|
how stream will be buffered, as follows: _IOFBF causes input/output to
|
|
be fully buffered; _IOLBF causes output to be line buffered; _IONBF
|
|
causes input/output to be unbuffered. If buf is not a null pointer,
|
|
the array it points to may be used instead of a buffer allocated by
|
|
the setvbuf function./105/ The argument size specifies the size of the
|
|
array. The contents of the array at any time are indeterminate.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The setvbuf function returns zero on success, or nonzero if an
|
|
invalid value is given for mode or if the request cannot be honored.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.6 Formatted input/output functions
|
|
|
|
4.9.6.1 The fprintf function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
int fprintf(FILE *stream, const char *format, ...);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The fprintf function writes output to the stream pointed to by
|
|
stream , under control of the string pointed to by format that
|
|
specifies how subsequent arguments are converted for output. If there
|
|
are insufficient arguments for the format, the behavior is undefined.
|
|
If the format is exhausted while arguments remain, the excess
|
|
arguments are evaluated (as always) but are otherwise ignored. The
|
|
fprintf function returns when the end of the format string is
|
|
encountered.
|
|
|
|
The format shall be a multibyte character sequence, beginning and
|
|
ending in its initial shift state. The format is composed of zero or
|
|
more directives: ordinary multibyte characters (not % ), which are
|
|
copied unchanged to the output stream; and conversion specifications,
|
|
each of which results in fetching zero or more subsequent arguments.
|
|
Each conversion specification is introduced by the character % .
|
|
After the % , the following appear in sequence:
|
|
|
|
* Zero or more flags that modify the meaning of the conversion
|
|
specification.
|
|
|
|
* An optional decimal integer specifying a minimum field width ./106/
|
|
If the converted value has fewer characters than the field width, it
|
|
will be padded with spaces on the left (or right, if the left
|
|
adjustment flag, described later, has been given) to the field width.
|
|
|
|
* An optional precision that gives the minimum number of digits to
|
|
appear for the d , i , o , u , x , and X conversions, the number of
|
|
digits to appear after the decimal-point character for e , E , and f
|
|
conversions, the maximum number of significant digits for the g and G
|
|
conversions, or the maximum number of characters to be written from a
|
|
string in s conversion. The precision takes the form of a period (.)
|
|
followed by an optional decimal integer; if the integer is
|
|
omitted, it is treated as zero.
|
|
|
|
* An optional h specifying that a following d , i , o , u , x , or X
|
|
conversion specifier applies to a short int or unsigned short int
|
|
argument (the argument will have been promoted according to the
|
|
integral promotions, and its value shall be converted to short int or
|
|
unsigned short int before printing); an optional h specifying that a
|
|
following n conversion specifier applies to a pointer to a short int
|
|
argument; an optional l (ell) specifying that a following d , i , o ,
|
|
u , x , or X conversion specifier applies to a long int or unsigned
|
|
long int argument; an optional l specifying that a following n
|
|
conversion specifier applies to a pointer to a long int argument; or
|
|
an optional L specifying that a following e , E , f , g , or G
|
|
conversion specifier applies to a long double argument. If an h , l ,
|
|
or L appears with any other conversion specifier, the behavior is
|
|
undefined.
|
|
|
|
* A character that specifies the type of conversion to be applied.
|
|
|
|
A field width or precision, or both, may be indicated by an
|
|
asterisk * instead of a digit string. In this case, an int argument
|
|
supplies the field width or precision. The arguments specifying field
|
|
width or precision, or both, shall appear (in that order) before the
|
|
argument (if any) to be converted. A negative field width argument is
|
|
taken as a - flag followed by a positive field width. A negative
|
|
precision argument is taken as if it were missing.
|
|
|
|
The flag characters and their meanings are
|
|
|
|
- The result of the conversion will be left-justified within the field.
|
|
|
|
+ The result of a signed conversion will always begin with a plus or
|
|
minus sign.
|
|
|
|
space If the first character of a signed conversion is not a sign,
|
|
or if a signed conversion results in no characters, a space will be
|
|
prepended to the result. If the space and + flags both appear, the
|
|
space flag will be ignored.
|
|
|
|
# The result is to be converted to an ``alternate form.'' For
|
|
o conversion, it increases the precision to force the first digit of
|
|
the result to be a zero. For x (or X ) conversion, a nonzero result
|
|
will have 0x (or 0X ) prepended to it. For e , E , f , g , and G
|
|
conversions, the result will always contain a decimal-point character,
|
|
even if no digits follow it (normally, a decimal-point character
|
|
appears in the result of these conversions only if a digit follows
|
|
it). For g and G conversions, trailing zeros will not be removed from
|
|
the result. For other conversions, the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
0 For d, i, o, u, x, X, e, E, f, g and G conversions, leading zeros
|
|
(following any indication of sign or base) are used to pad to the
|
|
field width; no space padding is performed. If the 0 and - flags
|
|
both appear, the 0 flag will be ignored. For d, i, o, u, x and X
|
|
conversions, if a precision is specified, the 0 flag will be
|
|
ignored. For other conversions, the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
The conversion specifiers and their meanings are
|
|
|
|
d, i, o, u, x, X The int argument is converted to signed decimal ( d
|
|
or i ), unsigned octal ( o ), unsigned decimal ( u ), or unsigned
|
|
hexadecimal notation ( x or X ); the letters abcdef are used for x
|
|
conversion and the letters ABCDEF for X conversion. The precision
|
|
specifies the minimum number of digits to appear; if the value being
|
|
converted can be represented in fewer digits, it will be expanded with
|
|
leading zeros. The default precision is 1. The result of converting
|
|
a zero value with an explicit precision of zero is no characters.
|
|
|
|
f The double argument is converted to decimal notation in the style
|
|
[-]ddd.ddd , where the number of digits after the decimal-point
|
|
character is equal to the precision specification. If the precision
|
|
is missing, it is taken as 6; if the precision is explicitly zero, no
|
|
decimal-point character appears. If a decimal-point character
|
|
appears, at least one digit appears before it. The value is rounded
|
|
to the appropriate number of digits.
|
|
|
|
e, E The double argument is converted in the style [-]d.ddde+- dd ,
|
|
where there is one digit before the decimal-point character (which is
|
|
nonzero if the argument is nonzero) and the number of digits after it
|
|
is equal to the precision; if the precision is missing, it is taken as
|
|
6; if the precision is zero, no decimal-point character appears. The
|
|
value is rounded to the appropriate number of digits. The E
|
|
conversion specifier will produce a number with E instead of e
|
|
introducing the exponent. The exponent always contains at least two
|
|
digits. If the value is zero, the exponent is zero.
|
|
|
|
g, G The double argument is converted in style f or e (or in style E
|
|
in the case of a G conversion specifier), with the precision
|
|
specifying the number of significant digits. If an explicit precision
|
|
is zero, it is taken as 1. The style used depends on the value
|
|
converted; style e will be used only if the exponent resulting from
|
|
such a conversion is less than -4 or greater than or equal to the
|
|
precision. Trailing zeros are removed from the fractional portion of
|
|
the result; a decimal-point character appears only if it is followed
|
|
by a digit.
|
|
|
|
c The int argument is converted to an unsigned char , and the resulting
|
|
character is written.
|
|
|
|
s The argument shall be a pointer to an array of character type./107/
|
|
Characters from the array are written up to (but not including) a
|
|
terminating null character; if the precision is specified, no more
|
|
than that many characters are written. If the precision is not
|
|
specified or is greater than the size of the array, the array shall
|
|
contain a null character.
|
|
|
|
p The argument shall be a pointer to void . The value of the pointer
|
|
is converted to a sequence of printable characters, in an
|
|
implementation-defined manner.
|
|
|
|
n The argument shall be a pointer to an integer into which is written
|
|
the number of characters written to the output stream so far by this
|
|
call to fprintf . No argument is converted.
|
|
|
|
% A % is written. No argument is converted. The complete conversion
|
|
specification shall be %% .
|
|
|
|
If a conversion specification is invalid, the behavior is
|
|
undefined./108/
|
|
|
|
If any argument is, or points to, a union or an aggregate (except
|
|
for an array of character type using %s conversion, or a pointer cast
|
|
to be a pointer to void using %p conversion), the behavior is
|
|
undefined.
|
|
|
|
In no case does a nonexistent or small field width cause truncation
|
|
of a field; if the result of a conversion is wider than the field
|
|
width, the field is expanded to contain the conversion result.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The fprintf function returns the number of characters transmitted,
|
|
or a negative value if an output error occurred.
|
|
|
|
"Environmental limit"
|
|
|
|
The minimum value for the maximum number of characters produced by
|
|
any single conversion shall be 509.
|
|
|
|
Examples
|
|
|
|
To print a date and time in the form ``Sunday, July 3, 10:02,''
|
|
where weekday and month are pointers to strings:
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
fprintf(stdout, "%s, %s %d, %.2d:%.2d\n",
|
|
weekday, month, day, hour, min);
|
|
|
|
To print PI to five decimal places:
|
|
|
|
#include <math.h>
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
fprintf(stdout, "pi = %.5f\n", 4 * atan(1.0));
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.6.2 The fscanf function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
int fscanf(FILE *stream, const char *format, ...);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The fscanf function reads input from the stream pointed to by
|
|
stream , under control of the string pointed to by format that
|
|
specifies the admissible input sequences and how they are to be
|
|
converted for assignment, using subsequent arguments as pointers to
|
|
the objects to receive the converted input. If there are insufficient
|
|
arguments for the format, the behavior is undefined. If the format is
|
|
exhausted while arguments remain, the excess arguments are evaluated
|
|
(as always) but are otherwise ignored.
|
|
|
|
The format shall be a multibyte character sequence, beginning and
|
|
ending in its initial shift state. The format is composed of zero or
|
|
more directives: one or more white-space characters; an ordinary
|
|
multibyte character (not % ); or a conversion specification. Each
|
|
conversion specification is introduced by the character % . After the %,
|
|
the following appear in sequence:
|
|
|
|
* An optional assignment-suppressing character * .
|
|
|
|
* An optional decimal integer that specifies the maximum field width.
|
|
|
|
* An optional h , l (ell) or L indicating the size of the receiving
|
|
object. The conversion specifiers d , i , and n shall be preceded by
|
|
h if the corresponding argument is a pointer to short int rather than
|
|
a pointer to int , or by l if it is a pointer to long int .
|
|
Similarly, the conversion specifiers o , u , and x shall be preceded
|
|
by h if the corresponding argument is a pointer to unsigned short int
|
|
rather than a pointer to unsigned int , or by l if it is a pointer to
|
|
unsigned long int . Finally, the conversion specifiers e , f , and g
|
|
shall be preceded by l if the corresponding argument is a pointer to
|
|
double rather than a pointer to float , or by L if it is a pointer to
|
|
long double . If an h , l , or L appears with any other conversion
|
|
specifier, the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
* A character that specifies the type of conversion to be applied.
|
|
The valid conversion specifiers are described below.
|
|
|
|
The fscanf function executes each directive of the format in turn.
|
|
If a directive fails, as detailed below, the fscanf function returns.
|
|
Failures are described as input failures (due to the unavailability of
|
|
input characters), or matching failures (due to inappropriate input).
|
|
|
|
A directive composed of white space is executed by reading input up
|
|
to the first non-white-space character (which remains unread), or
|
|
until no more characters can be read.
|
|
|
|
A directive that is an ordinary multibyte character is executed by
|
|
reading the next characters of the stream. If one of the characters
|
|
differs from one comprising the directive, the directive fails, and
|
|
the differing and subsequent characters remain unread.
|
|
|
|
A directive that is a conversion specification defines a set of
|
|
matching input sequences, as described below for each specifier. A
|
|
conversion specification is executed in the following steps:
|
|
|
|
Input white-space characters (as specified by the isspace function)
|
|
are skipped, unless the specification includes a [ , c , or n
|
|
specifier.
|
|
|
|
An input item is read from the stream, unless the specification
|
|
includes an n specifier. An input item is defined as the longest
|
|
sequence of input characters (up to any specified maximum field width)
|
|
which is an initial subsequence of a matching sequence. The first
|
|
character, if any, after the input item remains unread. If the length
|
|
of the input item is zero, the execution of the directive fails: this
|
|
condition is a matching failure, unless an error prevented input from
|
|
the stream, in which case it is an input failure.
|
|
|
|
Except in the case of a % specifier, the input item (or, in the
|
|
case of a %n directive, the count of input characters) is converted to
|
|
a type appropriate to the conversion specifier. If the input item is
|
|
not a matching sequence, the execution of the directive fails: this
|
|
condition is a matching failure. Unless assignment suppression was
|
|
indicated by a * , the result of the conversion is placed in the
|
|
object pointed to by the first argument following the format argument
|
|
that has not already received a conversion result. If this object
|
|
does not have an appropriate type, or if the result of the conversion
|
|
cannot be represented in the space provided, the behavior is
|
|
undefined.
|
|
|
|
The following conversion specifiers are valid:
|
|
|
|
d Matches an optionally signed decimal integer, whose format is the
|
|
same as expected for the subject sequence of the strtol function with
|
|
the value 10 for the base argument. The corresponding argument shall
|
|
be a pointer to integer.
|
|
|
|
i Matches an optionally signed integer, whose format is the same as
|
|
expected for the subject sequence of the strtol function with the
|
|
value 0 for the base argument. The corresponding argument shall be a
|
|
pointer to integer.
|
|
|
|
o Matches an optionally signed octal integer, whose format is the same
|
|
as expected for the subject sequence of the strtoul function with the
|
|
value 8 for the base argument. The corresponding argument shall be a
|
|
pointer to unsigned integer.
|
|
|
|
u Matches an optionally signed decimal integer, whose format is the same
|
|
as expected for the subject sequence of the strtoul function with the
|
|
value 10 for the base argument. The corresponding argument shall be a
|
|
pointer to unsigned integer.
|
|
|
|
x Matches an optionally signed hexadecimal integer, whose format is the
|
|
same as expected for the subject sequence of the strtoul function with
|
|
the value 16 for the base argument. The corresponding argument shall
|
|
be a pointer to unsigned integer.
|
|
|
|
e,f,g Matches an optionally signed floating-point number, whose format is
|
|
the same as expected for the subject string of the strtod function.
|
|
The corresponding argument shall be a pointer to floating.
|
|
|
|
s Matches a sequence of non-white-space characters. The corresponding
|
|
argument shall be a pointer to the initial character of an array large
|
|
enough to accept the sequence and a terminating null character, which
|
|
will be added automatically.
|
|
|
|
[ Matches a nonempty sequence of characters from a set of expected
|
|
characters (the scanset ). The corresponding argument shall be a
|
|
pointer to the initial character of an array large enough to accept
|
|
the sequence and a terminating null character, which will be added
|
|
automatically. The conversion specifier includes all subsequent
|
|
characters in the format string, up to and including the matching
|
|
right bracket ( ] ). The characters between the brackets (the
|
|
scanlist ) comprise the scanset, unless the character after the left
|
|
bracket is a circumflex ( ^ ), in which case the scanset contains all
|
|
characters that do not appear in the scanlist between the circumflex
|
|
and the right bracket. As a special case, if the conversion specifier
|
|
begins with [] or [^] , the right bracket character is in the scanlist
|
|
and the next right bracket character is the matching right bracket
|
|
that ends the specification. If a - character is in the scanlist and
|
|
is not the first, nor the second where the first character is a ^ ,
|
|
nor the last character, the behavior is implementation-defined.
|
|
|
|
c Matches a sequence of characters of the number specified by the
|
|
field width (1 if no field width is present in the directive). The
|
|
corresponding argument shall be a pointer to the initial character of
|
|
an array large enough to accept the sequence. No null character is
|
|
added.
|
|
|
|
p Matches an implementation-defined set of sequences, which should be
|
|
the same as the set of sequences that may be produced by the %p
|
|
conversion of the fprintf function. The corresponding argument shall
|
|
be a pointer to a pointer to void . The interpretation of the input
|
|
item is implementation-defined; however, for any input item other than
|
|
a value converted earlier during the same program execution, the
|
|
behavior of the %p conversion is undefined.
|
|
|
|
n No input is consumed. The corresponding argument shall be a pointer
|
|
to integer into which is to be written the number of characters read
|
|
from the input stream so far by this call to the fscanf function.
|
|
Execution of a %n directive does not increment the assignment count
|
|
returned at the completion of execution of the fscanf function.
|
|
|
|
% Matches a single % ; no conversion or assignment occurs. The complete
|
|
conversion specification shall be %% .
|
|
|
|
If a conversion specification is invalid, the behavior is
|
|
undefined./110/
|
|
|
|
The conversion specifiers E , G , and X are also valid and behave
|
|
the same as, respectively, e , g , and x .
|
|
|
|
If end-of-file is encountered during input, conversion is
|
|
terminated. If end-of-file occurs before any characters matching the
|
|
current directive have been read (other than leading white space,
|
|
where permitted), execution of the current directive terminates with
|
|
an input failure; otherwise, unless execution of the current directive
|
|
is terminated with a matching failure, execution of the following
|
|
directive (if any) is terminated with an input failure.
|
|
|
|
If conversion terminates on a conflicting input character, the
|
|
offending input character is left unread in the input stream.
|
|
Trailing white space (including new-line characters) is left unread
|
|
unless matched by a directive. The success of literal matches and
|
|
suppressed assignments is not directly determinable other than via the
|
|
%n directive.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The fscanf function returns the value of the macro EOF if an input
|
|
failure occurs before any conversion. Otherwise, the fscanf function
|
|
returns the number of input items assigned, which can be fewer than
|
|
provided for, or even zero, in the event of an early matching failure.
|
|
|
|
Examples
|
|
|
|
The call:
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
int n, i; float x; char name[50];
|
|
n = fscanf(stdin, "%d%f%s", &i, &x, name);
|
|
|
|
with the input line:
|
|
|
|
25 54.32E-1 thompson
|
|
|
|
will assign to n the value 3, to i the value 25, to x the value 5.432,
|
|
and name will contain thompson\0 . Or:
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
int i; float x; char name[50];
|
|
fscanf(stdin, "%2d%f%*d %[0123456789]", &i, &x, name);
|
|
|
|
with input:
|
|
|
|
56789 0123 56a72
|
|
|
|
will assign to i the value 56 and to x the value 789.0, will skip
|
|
0123, and name will contain 56\0 . The next character read from the
|
|
input stream will be a .
|
|
|
|
To accept repeatedly from stdin a quantity, a unit of measure and
|
|
an item name:
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
int count; float quant; char units[21], item[21];
|
|
while (!feof(stdin) && !ferror(stdin)) {
|
|
count = fscanf(stdin, "%f%20s of %20s",
|
|
&quant, units, item);
|
|
fscanf(stdin,"%*[^\n]");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the stdin stream contains the following lines:
|
|
|
|
2 quarts of oil
|
|
-12.8degrees Celsius
|
|
lots of luck
|
|
10.0LBS of fertilizer
|
|
100ergs of energy
|
|
|
|
the execution of the above example will be equivalent to the following
|
|
assignments:
|
|
|
|
quant = 2; strcpy(units, "quarts"); strcpy(item, "oil");
|
|
count = 3;
|
|
quant = -12.8; strcpy(units, "degrees");
|
|
count = 2; /* "C" fails to match "o" */
|
|
count = 0; /* "l" fails to match "%f" */
|
|
quant = 10.0; strcpy(units, "LBS"); strcpy(item, "fertilizer");
|
|
count = 3;
|
|
count = 0; /* "100e" fails to match "%f" */
|
|
count = EOF;
|
|
|
|
Forward references: the strtod function ($4.10.1.4), the strtol
|
|
function ($4.10.1.5), the strtoul function ($4.10.1.6).
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.6.3 The printf function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
int printf(const char *format, ...);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The printf function is equivalent to fprintf with the argument
|
|
stdout interposed before the arguments to printf .
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The printf function returns the number of characters transmitted,
|
|
or a negative value if an output error occurred.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.6.4 The scanf function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
int scanf(const char *format, ...);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The scanf function is equivalent to fscanf with the argument stdin
|
|
interposed before the arguments to scanf .
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The scanf function returns the value of the macro EOF if an input
|
|
failure occurs before any conversion. Otherwise, the scanf function
|
|
returns the number of input items assigned, which can be fewer than
|
|
provided for, or even zero, in the event of an early matching failure.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.6.5 The sprintf function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
int sprintf(char *s, const char *format, ...);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The sprintf function is equivalent to fprintf , except that the
|
|
argument s specifies an array into which the generated output is to be
|
|
written, rather than to a stream. A null character is written at the
|
|
end of the characters written; it is not counted as part of the
|
|
returned sum. If copying takes place between objects that overlap,
|
|
the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The sprintf function returns the number of characters written in
|
|
the array, not counting the terminating null character.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.6.6 The sscanf function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
int sscanf(const char *s, const char *format, ...);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The sscanf function is equivalent to fscanf , except that the
|
|
argument s specifies a string from which the input is to be obtained,
|
|
rather than from a stream. Reaching the end of the string is
|
|
equivalent to encountering end-of-file for the fscanf function. If
|
|
copying takes place between objects that overlap, the behavior is
|
|
undefined.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The sscanf function returns the value of the macro EOF if an input
|
|
failure occurs before any conversion. Otherwise, the sscanf function
|
|
returns the number of input items assigned, which can be fewer than
|
|
provided for, or even zero, in the event of an early matching failure.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.6.7 The vfprintf function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdarg.h>
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
int vfprintf(FILE *stream, const char *format, va_list arg);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The vfprintf function is equivalent to fprintf , with the variable
|
|
argument list replaced by arg , which has been initialized by the
|
|
va_start macro (and possibly subsequent va_arg calls). The vfprintf
|
|
function does not invoke the va_end macro.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The vfprintf function returns the number of characters transmitted,
|
|
or a negative value if an output error occurred.
|
|
|
|
Example
|
|
|
|
The following shows the use of the vfprintf function in a general
|
|
error-reporting routine.
|
|
|
|
#include <stdarg.h>
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
|
|
void error(char *function_name, char *format, ...)
|
|
{
|
|
va_list args;
|
|
|
|
va_start(args, format);
|
|
/* print out name of function causing error */
|
|
fprintf(stderr, "ERROR in %s: ", function_name);
|
|
/* print out remainder of message */
|
|
vfprintf(stderr, format, args);
|
|
va_end(args);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.6.8 The vprintf function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdarg.h>
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
int vprintf(const char *format, va_list arg);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The vprintf function is equivalent to printf , with the variable
|
|
argument list replaced by arg , which has been initialized by the
|
|
va_start macro (and possibly subsequent va_arg calls). The vprintf
|
|
function does not invoke the va_end macro.rN
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The vprintf function returns the number of characters transmitted,
|
|
or a negative value if an output error occurred.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.6.9 The vsprintf function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdarg.h>
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
int vsprintf(char *s, const char *format, va_list arg);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The vsprintf function is equivalent to sprintf , with the variable
|
|
argument list replaced by arg , which has been initialized by the
|
|
va_start macro (and possibly subsequent va_arg calls). The vsprintf
|
|
function does not invoke the va_end macro.rN If copying takes place
|
|
between objects that overlap, the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The vsprintf function returns the number of characters written in
|
|
the array, not counting the terminating null character.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.7 Character input/output functions
|
|
|
|
4.9.7.1 The fgetc function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
int fgetc(FILE *stream);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The fgetc function obtains the next character (if present) as an
|
|
unsigned char converted to an int , from the input stream pointed to
|
|
by stream , and advances the associated file position indicator for
|
|
the stream (if defined).
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The fgetc function returns the next character from the input stream
|
|
pointed to by stream . If the stream is at end-of-file, the
|
|
end-of-file indicator for the stream is set and fgetc returns EOF .
|
|
If a read error occurs, the error indicator for the stream is set and
|
|
fgetc returns EOF ./112/
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.7.2 The fgets function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
char *fgets(char *s, int n, FILE *stream);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The fgets function reads at most one less than the number of
|
|
characters specified by n from the stream pointed to by stream into
|
|
the array pointed to by s . No additional characters are read after a
|
|
new-line character (which is retained) or after end-of-file. A null
|
|
character is written immediately after the last character read into
|
|
the array.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The fgets function returns s if successful. If end-of-file is
|
|
encountered and no characters have been read into the array, the
|
|
contents of the array remain unchanged and a null pointer is returned.
|
|
If a read error occurs during the operation, the array contents are
|
|
indeterminate and a null pointer is returned.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.7.3 The fputc function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
int fputc(int c, FILE *stream);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The fputc function writes the character specified by c (converted
|
|
to an unsigned char ) to the output stream pointed to by stream , at
|
|
the position indicated by the associated file position indicator for
|
|
the stream (if defined), and advances the indicator appropriately. If
|
|
the file cannot support positioning requests, or if the stream was
|
|
opened with append mode, the character is appended to the output
|
|
stream.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The fputc function returns the character written. If a write error
|
|
occurs, the error indicator for the stream is set and fputc returns EOF.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.7.4 The fputs function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
int fputs(const char *s, FILE *stream);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The fputs function writes the string pointed to by s to the stream
|
|
pointed to by stream . The terminating null character is not written.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The fputs function returns EOF if a write error occurs; otherwise
|
|
it returns a nonnegative value.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.7.5 The getc function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
int getc(FILE *stream);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The getc function is equivalent to fgetc , except that if it is
|
|
implemented as a macro, it may evaluate stream more than once, so the
|
|
argument should never be an expression with side effects.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The getc function returns the next character from the input stream
|
|
pointed to by stream . If the stream is at end-of-file, the
|
|
end-of-file indicator for the stream is set and getc returns EOF . If
|
|
a read error occurs, the error indicator for the stream is set and
|
|
getc returns EOF .
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.7.6 The getchar function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
int getchar(void);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The getchar function is equivalent to getc with the argument stdin .
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The getchar function returns the next character from the input
|
|
stream pointed to by stdin . If the stream is at end-of-file, the
|
|
end-of-file indicator for the stream is set and getchar returns EOF .
|
|
If a read error occurs, the error indicator for the stream is set and
|
|
getchar returns EOF .
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.7.7 The gets function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
char *gets(char *s);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The gets function reads characters from the input stream pointed to
|
|
by stdin , into the array pointed to by s , until end-of-file is
|
|
encountered or a new-line character is read. Any new-line character
|
|
is discarded, and a null character is written immediately after the
|
|
last character read into the array.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The gets function returns s if successful. If end-of-file is
|
|
encountered and no characters have been read into the array, the
|
|
contents of the array remain unchanged and a null pointer is returned.
|
|
If a read error occurs during the operation, the array contents are
|
|
indeterminate and a null pointer is returned.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.7.8 The putc function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
int putc(int c, FILE *stream);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The putc function is equivalent to fputc , except that if it is
|
|
implemented as a macro, it may evaluate stream more than once, so the
|
|
argument should never be an expression with side effects.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The putc function returns the character written. If a write error
|
|
occurs, the error indicator for the stream is set and putc returns EOF.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.7.9 The putchar function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
int putchar(int c);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The putchar function is equivalent to putc with the second argument
|
|
stdout.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The putchar function returns the character written. If a write
|
|
error occurs, the error indicator for the stream is set and putchar
|
|
returns EOF.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.7.10 The puts function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
int puts(const char *s);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The puts function writes the string pointed to by s to the stream
|
|
pointed to by stdout , and appends a new-line character to the output.
|
|
The terminating null character is not written.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The puts function returns EOF if a write error occurs; otherwise it
|
|
returns a nonnegative value.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.7.11 The ungetc function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
int ungetc(int c, FILE *stream);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The ungetc function pushes the character specified by c (converted
|
|
to an unsigned char ) back onto the input stream pointed to by stream.
|
|
The pushed-back characters will be returned by subsequent reads on
|
|
that stream in the reverse order of their pushing. A successful
|
|
intervening call (with the stream pointed to by stream ) to a file
|
|
positioning function ( fseek , fsetpos , or rewind ) discards any
|
|
pushed-back characters for the stream. The external storage
|
|
corresponding to the stream is unchanged.
|
|
|
|
One character of pushback is guaranteed. If the ungetc function is
|
|
called too many times on the same stream without an intervening read
|
|
or file positioning operation on that stream, the operation may fail.
|
|
|
|
If the value of c equals that of the macro EOF , the operation
|
|
fails and the input stream is unchanged.
|
|
|
|
A successful call to the ungetc function clears the end-of-file
|
|
indicator for the stream. The value of the file position indicator
|
|
for the stream after reading or discarding all pushed-back characters
|
|
shall be the same as it was before the characters were pushed back.
|
|
For a text stream, the value of its file position indicator after a
|
|
successful call to the ungetc function is unspecified until all
|
|
pushed-back characters are read or discarded. For a binary stream,
|
|
its file position indicator is decremented by each successful call to
|
|
the ungetc function; if its value was zero before a call, it is
|
|
indeterminate after the call.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The ungetc function returns the character pushed back after
|
|
conversion, or EOF if the operation fails.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: file positioning functions ($4.9.9).
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.8 Direct input/output functions
|
|
|
|
4.9.8.1 The fread function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
size_t fread(void *ptr, size_t size, size_t nmemb,
|
|
FILE *stream);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The fread function reads, into the array pointed to by ptr , up to
|
|
nmemb members whose size is specified by size , from the stream
|
|
pointed to by stream . The file position indicator for the stream (if
|
|
defined) is advanced by the number of characters successfully read.
|
|
If an error occurs, the resulting value of the file position indicator
|
|
for the stream is indeterminate. If a partial member is read, its
|
|
value is indeterminate.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The fread function returns the number of members successfully read,
|
|
which may be less than nmemb if a read error or end-of-file is
|
|
encountered. If size or nmemb is zero, fread returns zero and the
|
|
contents of the array and the state of the stream remain unchanged.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.8.2 The fwrite function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
size_t fwrite(const void *ptr, size_t size, size_t nmemb,
|
|
FILE *stream);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The fwrite function writes, from the array pointed to by ptr , up
|
|
to nmemb members whose size is specified by size , to the stream
|
|
pointed to by stream . The file position indicator for the stream (if
|
|
defined) is advanced by the number of characters successfully written.
|
|
If an error occurs, the resulting value of the file position indicator
|
|
for the stream is indeterminate.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The fwrite function returns the number of members successfully
|
|
written, which will be less than nmemb only if a write error is
|
|
encountered.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.9 File positioning functions
|
|
|
|
4.9.9.1 The fgetpos function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
int fgetpos(FILE *stream, fpos_t *pos);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The fgetpos function stores the current value of the file position
|
|
indicator for the stream pointed to by stream in the object pointed to
|
|
by pos . The value stored contains unspecified information usable by
|
|
the fsetpos function for repositioning the stream to its position at
|
|
the time of the call to the fgetpos function.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
If successful, the fgetpos function returns zero; on failure, the
|
|
fgetpos function returns nonzero and stores an implementation-defined
|
|
positive value in errno .
|
|
|
|
Forward references: the fsetpos function ($4.9.9.3).
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.9.2 The fseek function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
int fseek(FILE *stream, long int offset, int whence);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The fseek function sets the file position indicator for the stream
|
|
pointed to by stream .
|
|
|
|
For a binary stream, the new position, measured in characters from
|
|
the beginning of the file, is obtained by adding offset to the
|
|
position specified by whence. The specified point is the beginning
|
|
of the file for SEEK_SET, the current value of the file position
|
|
indicator for SEEK_CUR, or end-of-file for SEEK_END. A binary
|
|
stream need not meaningfully support fseek calls with a whence value
|
|
of SEEK_END.
|
|
|
|
For a text stream, either offset shall be zero, or offset shall be
|
|
a value returned by an earlier call to the ftell function on the same
|
|
stream and whence shall be SEEK_SET .
|
|
|
|
A successful call to the fseek function clears the end-of-file
|
|
indicator for the stream and undoes any effects of the ungetc function
|
|
on the same stream. After an fseek call, the next operation on an
|
|
update stream may be either input or output.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The fseek function returns nonzero only for a request that cannot
|
|
be satisfied.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: the ftell function ($4.9.9.4).
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.9.3 The fsetpos function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
int fsetpos(FILE *stream, const fpos_t *pos);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The fsetpos function sets the file position indicator for the
|
|
stream pointed to by stream according to the value of the object
|
|
pointed to by pos , which shall be a value returned by an earlier call
|
|
to the fgetpos function on the same stream.
|
|
|
|
A successful call to the fsetpos function clears the end-of-file
|
|
indicator for the stream and undoes any effects of the ungetc function
|
|
on the same stream. After an fsetpos call, the next operation on an
|
|
update stream may be either input or output.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
If successful, the fsetpos function returns zero; on failure, the
|
|
fsetpos function returns nonzero and stores an implementation-defined
|
|
positive value in errno .
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.9.4 The ftell function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
long int ftell(FILE *stream);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The ftell function obtains the current value of the file position
|
|
indicator for the stream pointed to by stream . For a binary stream,
|
|
the value is the number of characters from the beginning of the file.
|
|
For a text stream, its file position indicator contains unspecified
|
|
information, usable by the fseek function for returning the file
|
|
position indicator for the stream to its position at the time of the
|
|
ftell call; the difference between two such return values is not
|
|
necessarily a meaningful measure of the number of characters written
|
|
or read.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
If successful, the ftell function returns the current value of the
|
|
file position indicator for the stream. On failure, the ftell
|
|
function returns -1L and stores an implementation-defined positive
|
|
value in errno .
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.9.5 The rewind function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
void rewind(FILE *stream);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The rewind function sets the file position indicator for the stream
|
|
pointed to by stream to the beginning of the file. It is equivalent to
|
|
|
|
(void)fseek(stream, 0L, SEEK_SET)
|
|
|
|
except that the error indicator for the stream is also cleared.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The rewind function returns no value.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.10 Error-handling functions
|
|
|
|
4.9.10.1 The clearerr function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
void clearerr(FILE *stream);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The clearerr function clears the end-of-file and error indicators
|
|
for the stream pointed to by stream .
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The clearerr function returns no value.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.10.2 The feof function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
int feof(FILE *stream);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The feof function tests the end-of-file indicator for the stream
|
|
pointed to by stream .
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The feof function returns nonzero if and only if the end-of-file
|
|
indicator is set for stream .
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.10.3 The ferror function
|
|
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
int ferror(FILE *stream);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The ferror function tests the error indicator for the stream
|
|
pointed to by stream .
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The ferror function returns nonzero if and only if the error
|
|
indicator is set for stream .
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.9.10.4 The perror function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
void perror(const char *s);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The perror function maps the error number in the integer expression
|
|
errno to an error message. It writes a sequence of characters to the
|
|
standard error stream thus: first (if s is not a null pointer and the
|
|
character pointed to by s is not the null character), the string
|
|
pointed to by s followed by a colon and a space; then an appropriate
|
|
error message string followed by a new-line character. The contents
|
|
of the error message strings are the same as those returned by the
|
|
strerror function with argument errno , which are
|
|
implementation-defined.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The perror function returns no value.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: the strerror function ($4.11.6.2).
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.10 GENERAL UTILITIES <stdlib.h>
|
|
|
|
The header <stdlib.h> declares four types and several functions of
|
|
general utility, and defines several macros./113/
|
|
|
|
The types declared are size_t and wchar_t (both described in $4.1.5),
|
|
|
|
div_t
|
|
|
|
which is a structure type that is the type of the value returned by
|
|
the div function, and
|
|
|
|
ldiv_t
|
|
|
|
which is a structure type that is the type of the value returned by
|
|
the ldiv function.
|
|
|
|
The macros defined are NULL (described in $4.1.5);
|
|
|
|
EXIT_FAILURE
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
EXIT_SUCCESS
|
|
|
|
which expand to integral expressions that may be used as the argument
|
|
to the exit function to return unsuccessful or successful termination
|
|
status, respectively, to the host environment;
|
|
|
|
RAND_MAX
|
|
|
|
which expands to an integral constant expression, the value of which
|
|
is the maximum value returned by the rand function; and
|
|
|
|
MB_CUR_MAX
|
|
|
|
which expands to a positive integer expression whose value is the
|
|
maximum number of bytes in a multibyte character for the extended
|
|
character set specified by the current locale (category LC_CTYPE ),
|
|
and whose value is never greater than MB_LEN_MAX .
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.10.1 String conversion functions
|
|
|
|
The functions atof , atoi , and atol need not affect the value of
|
|
the integer expression errno on an error. If the value of the result
|
|
cannot be represented, the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.10.1.1 The atof function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdlib.h>
|
|
double atof(const char *nptr);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The atof function converts the initial portion of the string
|
|
pointed to by nptr to double representation. Except for the behavior
|
|
on error, it is equivalent to
|
|
|
|
strtod(nptr, (char **)NULL)
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The atof function returns the converted value.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: the strtod function ($4.10.1.4).
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.10.1.2 The atoi function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdlib.h>
|
|
int atoi(const char *nptr);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The atoi function converts the initial portion of the string
|
|
pointed to by nptr to int representation. Except for the behavior on
|
|
error, it is equivalent to
|
|
|
|
(int)strtol(nptr, (char **)NULL, 10)
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The atoi function returns the converted value.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: the strtol function ($4.10.1.5).
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.10.1.3 The atol function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdlib.h>
|
|
long int atol(const char *nptr);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The atol function converts the initial portion of the string
|
|
pointed to by nptr to long int representation. Except for the
|
|
behavior on error, it is equivalent to
|
|
|
|
strtol(nptr, (char **)NULL, 10)
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The atol function returns the converted value.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: the strtol function ($4.10.1.5).
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.10.1.4 The strtod function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdlib.h>
|
|
double strtod(const char *nptr, char **endptr);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The strtod function converts the initial portion of the string
|
|
pointed to by nptr to double representation. First it decomposes the
|
|
input string into three parts: an initial, possibly empty, sequence of
|
|
white-space characters (as specified by the isspace function), a
|
|
subject sequence resembling a floating-point constant; and a final
|
|
string of one or more unrecognized characters, including the
|
|
terminating null character of the input string. Then it attempts to
|
|
convert the subject sequence to a floating-point number, and returns
|
|
the result.
|
|
|
|
The expected form of the subject sequence is an optional plus or
|
|
minus sign, then a nonempty sequence of digits optionally containing a
|
|
decimal-point character, then an optional exponent part as defined in
|
|
$3.1.3.1, but no floating suffix. The subject sequence is defined as
|
|
the longest subsequence of the input string, starting with the first
|
|
non-white-space character, that is an initial subsequence of a
|
|
sequence of the expected form. The subject sequence contains no
|
|
characters if the input string is empty or consists entirely of white
|
|
space, or if the first non-white-space character is other than a sign,
|
|
a digit, or a decimal-point character.
|
|
|
|
If the subject sequence has the expected form, the sequence of
|
|
characters starting with the first digit or the decimal-point
|
|
character (whichever occurs first) is interpreted as a floating
|
|
constant according to the rules of $3.1.3.1, except that the
|
|
decimal-point character is used in place of a period, and that if
|
|
neither an exponent part nor a decimal-point character appears, a
|
|
decimal point is assumed to follow the last digit in the string. If
|
|
the subject sequence begins with a minus sign, the value resulting
|
|
from the conversion is negated. A pointer to the final string is
|
|
stored in the object pointed to by endptr , provided that endptr is
|
|
not a null pointer.
|
|
|
|
In other than the C locale, additional implementation-defined
|
|
subject sequence forms may be accepted.
|
|
|
|
If the subject sequence is empty or does not have the expected
|
|
form, no conversion is performed; the value of nptr is stored in the
|
|
object pointed to by endptr , provided that endptr is not a null
|
|
pointer.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The strtod function returns the converted value, if any. If no
|
|
conversion could be performed, zero is returned. If the correct value
|
|
would cause overflow, plus or minus HUGE_VAL is returned (according to
|
|
the sign of the value), and the value of the macro ERANGE is stored in
|
|
errno . If the correct value would cause underflow, zero is returned
|
|
and the value of the macro ERANGE is stored in errno .
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.10.1.5 The strtol function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdlib.h>
|
|
long int strtol(const char *nptr, char **endptr, int base);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The strtol function converts the initial portion of the string
|
|
pointed to by nptr to long int representation. First it decomposes
|
|
the input string into three parts: an initial, possibly empty,
|
|
sequence of white-space characters (as specified by the isspace
|
|
function), a subject sequence resembling an integer represented in
|
|
some radix determined by the value of base , and a final string of one
|
|
or more unrecognized characters, including the terminating null
|
|
character of the input string. Then it attempts to convert the
|
|
subject sequence to an integer, and returns the result.
|
|
|
|
If the value of base is zero, the expected form of the subject
|
|
sequence is that of an integer constant as described in $3.1.3.2,
|
|
optionally preceded by a plus or minus sign, but not including an
|
|
integer suffix. If the value of base is between 2 and 36, the
|
|
expected form of the subject sequence is a sequence of letters and
|
|
digits representing an integer with the radix specified by base ,
|
|
optionally preceded by a plus or minus sign, but not including an
|
|
integer suffix. The letters from a (or A ) through z (or Z ) are
|
|
ascribed the values 10 to 35; only letters whose ascribed values are
|
|
less than that of base are permitted. If the value of base is 16, the
|
|
characters 0x or 0X may optionally precede the sequence of letters and
|
|
digits, following the sign if present.
|
|
|
|
The subject sequence is defined as the longest subsequence of the
|
|
input string, starting with the first non-white-space character, that
|
|
is an initial subsequence of a sequence of the expected form. The
|
|
subject sequence contains no characters if the input string is empty
|
|
or consists entirely of white space, or if the first non-white-space
|
|
character is other than a sign or a permissible letter or digit.
|
|
|
|
If the subject sequence has the expected form and the value of base
|
|
is zero, the sequence of characters starting with the first digit is
|
|
interpreted as an integer constant according to the rules of $3.1.3.2.
|
|
If the subject sequence has the expected form and the value of base is
|
|
between 2 and 36, it is used as the base for conversion, ascribing to
|
|
each letter its value as given above. If the subject sequence begins
|
|
with a minus sign, the value resulting from the conversion is negated.
|
|
A pointer to the final string is stored in the object pointed to by
|
|
endptr , provided that endptr is not a null pointer.
|
|
|
|
In other than the C locale, additional implementation-defined
|
|
subject sequence forms may be accepted.
|
|
|
|
If the subject sequence is empty or does not have the expected
|
|
form, no conversion is performed; the value of nptr is stored in the
|
|
object pointed to by endptr , provided that endptr is not a null
|
|
pointer.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The strtol function returns the converted value, if any. If no
|
|
conversion could be performed, zero is returned. If the correct value
|
|
would cause overflow, LONG_MAX or LONG_MIN is returned (according to
|
|
the sign of the value), and the value of the macro ERANGE is stored in
|
|
errno .
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.10.1.6 The strtoul function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdlib.h>
|
|
unsigned long int strtoul(const char *nptr, char **endptr,
|
|
int base);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The strtoul function converts the initial portion of the string
|
|
pointed to by nptr to unsigned long int representation. First it
|
|
decomposes the input string into three parts: an initial, possibly
|
|
empty, sequence of white-space characters (as specified by the isspace
|
|
function), a subject sequence resembling an unsigned integer
|
|
represented in some radix determined by the value of base , and a
|
|
final string of one or more unrecognized characters, including the
|
|
terminating null character of the input string. Then it attempts to
|
|
convert the subject sequence to an unsigned integer, and returns the
|
|
result.
|
|
|
|
If the value of base is zero, the expected form of the subject
|
|
sequence is that of an integer constant as described in $3.1.3.2,
|
|
optionally preceded by a plus or minus sign, but not including an
|
|
integer suffix. If the value of base is between 2 and 36, the
|
|
expected form of the subject sequence is a sequence of letters and
|
|
digits representing an integer with the radix specified by base ,
|
|
optionally preceded by a plus or minus sign, but not including an
|
|
integer suffix. The letters from a (or A ) through z (or Z ) are
|
|
ascribed the values 10 to 35; only letters whose ascribed values are
|
|
less than that of base are permitted. If the value of base is 16, the
|
|
characters 0x or 0X may optionally precede the sequence of letters and
|
|
digits, following the sign if present.
|
|
|
|
The subject sequence is defined as the longest subsequence of the
|
|
input string, starting with the first non-white-space character, that
|
|
is an initial subsequence of a sequence of the expected form. The
|
|
subject sequence contains no characters if the input string is empty
|
|
or consists entirely of white space, or if the first non-white-space
|
|
character is other than a sign or a permissible letter or digit.
|
|
|
|
If the subject sequence has the expected form and the value of base
|
|
is zero, the sequence of characters starting with the first digit is
|
|
interpreted as an integer constant according to the rules of $3.1.3.2.
|
|
If the subject sequence has the expected form and the value of base is
|
|
between 2 and 36, it is used as the base for conversion, ascribing to
|
|
each letter its value as given above. If the subject sequence begins
|
|
with a minus sign, the value resulting from the conversion is negated.
|
|
A pointer to the final string is stored in the object pointed to by
|
|
endptr , provided that endptr is not a null pointer.
|
|
|
|
In other than the C locale, additional implementation-defined
|
|
subject sequence forms may be accepted.
|
|
|
|
If the subject sequence is empty or does not have the expected
|
|
form, no conversion is performed; the value of nptr is stored in the
|
|
object pointed to by endptr , provided that endptr is not a null
|
|
pointer.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The strtoul function returns the converted value, if any. If no
|
|
conversion could be performed, zero is returned. If the correct value
|
|
would cause overflow, ULONG_MAX is returned, and the value of the
|
|
macro ERANGE is stored in errno .
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.10.2 Pseudo-random sequence generation functions
|
|
|
|
4.10.2.1 The rand function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdlib.h>
|
|
int rand(void);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The rand function computes a sequence of pseudo-random integers in
|
|
the range 0 to RAND_MAX .
|
|
|
|
The implementation shall behave as if no library function calls the
|
|
rand function.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The rand function returns a pseudo-random integer.
|
|
|
|
"Environmental limit"
|
|
|
|
The value of the RAND_MAX macro shall be at least 32767.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.10.2.2 The srand function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdlib.h>
|
|
void srand(unsigned int seed);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The srand function uses the argument as a seed for a new sequence
|
|
of pseudo-random numbers to be returned by subsequent calls to rand .
|
|
If srand is then called with the same seed value, the sequence of
|
|
pseudo-random numbers shall be repeated. If rand is called before any
|
|
calls to srand have been made, the same sequence shall be generated as
|
|
when srand is first called with a seed value of 1.
|
|
|
|
The implementation shall behave as if no library function calls the
|
|
srand function.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The srand function returns no value.
|
|
|
|
Example
|
|
|
|
The following functions define a portable implementation of rand
|
|
and srand. Specifying the semantics makes it possible to determine
|
|
reproducibly the behavior of programs that use pseudo-random
|
|
sequences. This facilitates the testing of portable applications in
|
|
different implementations.
|
|
|
|
static unsigned long int next = 1;
|
|
|
|
int rand(void) /* RAND_MAX assumed to be 32767 */
|
|
{
|
|
next = next * 1103515245 + 12345;
|
|
return (unsigned int)(next/65536) % 32768;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void srand(unsigned int seed)
|
|
{
|
|
next = seed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.10.3 Memory management functions
|
|
|
|
The order and contiguity of storage allocated by successive calls
|
|
to the calloc , malloc , and realloc functions is unspecified. The
|
|
pointer returned if the allocation succeeds is suitably aligned so
|
|
that it may be assigned to a pointer to any type of object and then
|
|
used to access such an object in the space allocated (until the space
|
|
is explicitly freed or reallocated). Each such allocation shall yield
|
|
a pointer to an object disjoint from any other object. The pointer
|
|
returned points to the start (lowest byte address) of the allocated
|
|
space. If the space cannot be allocated, a null pointer is returned.
|
|
If the size of the space requested is zero, the behavior is
|
|
implementation-defined; the value returned shall be either a null
|
|
pointer or a unique pointer. The value of a pointer that refers to
|
|
freed space is indeterminate.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.10.3.1 The calloc function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdlib.h>
|
|
void *calloc(size_t nmemb, size_t size);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The calloc function allocates space for an array of nmemb objects,
|
|
each of whose size is size . The space is initialized to all bits
|
|
zero./114/
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The calloc function returns either a null pointer or a pointer to
|
|
the allocated space.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.10.3.2 The free function
|
|
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdlib.h>
|
|
void free(void *ptr);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The free function causes the space pointed to by ptr to be
|
|
deallocated, that is, made available for further allocation. If ptr
|
|
is a null pointer, no action occurs. Otherwise, if the argument does
|
|
not match a pointer earlier returned by the calloc , malloc , or
|
|
realloc function, or if the space has been deallocated by a call to
|
|
free or realloc , the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The free function returns no value.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.10.3.3 The malloc function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdlib.h>
|
|
void *malloc(size_t size);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The malloc function allocates space for an object whose size is
|
|
specified by size and whose value is indeterminate.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The malloc function returns either a null pointer or a pointer to
|
|
the allocated space.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.10.3.4 The realloc function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdlib.h>
|
|
void *realloc(void *ptr, size_t size);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The realloc function changes the size of the object pointed to by
|
|
ptr to the size specified by size . The contents of the object shall
|
|
be unchanged up to the lesser of the new and old sizes. If the new
|
|
size is larger, the value of the newly allocated portion of the object
|
|
is indeterminate. If ptr is a null pointer, the realloc function
|
|
behaves like the malloc function for the specified size. Otherwise,
|
|
if ptr does not match a pointer earlier returned by the calloc ,
|
|
malloc , or realloc function, or if the space has been deallocated by
|
|
a call to the free or realloc function, the behavior is undefined. If
|
|
the space cannot be allocated, the object pointed to by ptr is
|
|
unchanged. If size is zero and ptr is not a null pointer, the object
|
|
it points to is freed.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The realloc function returns either a null pointer or a pointer to
|
|
the possibly moved allocated space.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.10.4 Communication with the environment
|
|
|
|
4.10.4.1 The abort function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdlib.h>
|
|
void abort(void);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The abort function causes abnormal program termination to occur,
|
|
unless the signal SIGABRT is being caught and the signal handler does
|
|
not return. Whether open output streams are flushed or open streams
|
|
closed or temporary files removed is implementation-defined. An
|
|
implementation-defined form of the status unsuccessful termination is
|
|
returned to the host environment by means of the function call
|
|
raise(SIGABRT) .
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The abort function cannot return to its caller.
|
|
|
|
4.10.4.2 The atexit function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdlib.h>
|
|
int atexit(void (*func)(void));
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The atexit function registers the function pointed to by func , to
|
|
be called without arguments at normal program termination.
|
|
|
|
"Implementation limits"
|
|
|
|
The implementation shall support the registration of at least 32
|
|
functions.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The atexit function returns zero if the registration succeeds,
|
|
nonzero if it fails.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: the exit function ($4.10.4.3).
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.10.4.3 The exit function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdlib.h>
|
|
void exit(int status);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The exit function causes normal program termination to occur. If
|
|
more than one call to the exit function is executed by a program, the
|
|
behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
First, all functions registered by the atexit function are called,
|
|
in the reverse order of their registration./115/
|
|
|
|
Next, all open output streams are flushed, all open streams are
|
|
closed, and all files created by the tmpfile function are removed.
|
|
|
|
Finally, control is returned to the host environment. If the value
|
|
of status is zero or EXIT_SUCCESS , an implementation-defined form of
|
|
the status successful termination is returned. If the value of status
|
|
is EXIT_FAILURE , an implementation-defined form of the status
|
|
unsuccessful termination is returned. Otherwise the status returned
|
|
is implementation-defined.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The exit function cannot return to its caller.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.10.4.4 The getenv function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdlib.h>
|
|
char *getenv(const char *name);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The getenv function searches an environment list, provided by the
|
|
host environment, for a string that matches the string pointed to by
|
|
name . The set of environment names and the method for altering the
|
|
environment list are implementation-defined.
|
|
|
|
The implementation shall behave as if no library function calls the
|
|
getenv function.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The getenv function returns a pointer to a string associated with
|
|
the matched list member. The array pointed to shall not be modified
|
|
by the program, but may be overwritten by a subsequent call to the
|
|
getenv function. If the specified name cannot be found, a null
|
|
pointer is returned.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.10.4.5 The system function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdlib.h>
|
|
int system(const char *string);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The system function passes the string pointed to by string to the
|
|
host environment to be executed by a command processor in an
|
|
implementation-defined manner. A null pointer may be used for string
|
|
to inquire whether a command processor exists.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
If the argument is a null pointer, the system function returns
|
|
nonzero only if a command processor is available. If the argument is
|
|
not a null pointer, the system function returns an
|
|
implementation-defined value.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.10.5 Searching and sorting utilities
|
|
|
|
4.10.5.1 The bsearch function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdlib.h>
|
|
void *bsearch(const void *key, const void *base,
|
|
size_t nmemb, size_t size,
|
|
int (*compar)(const void *, const void *));
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The bsearch function searches an array of nmemb objects, the
|
|
initial member of which is pointed to by base , for a member that
|
|
matches the object pointed to by key . The size of each member of the
|
|
array is specified by size .
|
|
|
|
The contents of the array shall be in ascending sorted order
|
|
according to a comparison function pointed to by compar ,/116/ induces
|
|
which is called with two arguments that point to the key object and to
|
|
an array member, in that order. The function shall return an integer
|
|
less than, equal to, or greater than zero if the key object is
|
|
considered, respectively, to be less than, to match, or to be greater
|
|
than the array member.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The bsearch function returns a pointer to a matching member of the
|
|
array, or a null pointer if no match is found. If two members compare
|
|
as equal, which member is matched is unspecified.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.10.5.2 The qsort function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdlib.h>
|
|
void qsort(void *base, size_t nmemb, size_t size,
|
|
int (*compar)(const void *, const void *));
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The qsort function sorts an array of nmemb objects, the initial
|
|
member of which is pointed to by base . The size of each object is
|
|
specified by size .
|
|
|
|
The contents of the array are sorted in ascending order according
|
|
to a comparison function pointed to by compar , which is called with
|
|
two arguments that point to the objects being compared. The function
|
|
shall return an integer less than, equal to, or greater than zero if
|
|
the first argument is considered to be respectively less than, equal
|
|
to, or greater than the second.
|
|
|
|
If two members compare as equal, their order in the sorted array is
|
|
unspecified.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The qsort function returns no value.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.10.6 Integer arithmetic functions
|
|
|
|
4.10.6.1 The abs function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdlib.h>
|
|
int abs(int j);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The abs function computes the absolute value of an integer j . If
|
|
the result cannot be represented, the behavior is undefined./117/
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The abs function returns the absolute value.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.10.6.2 The div function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdlib.h>
|
|
div_t div(int numer, int denom);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The div function computes the quotient and remainder of the
|
|
division of the numerator numer by the denominator denom . If the
|
|
division is inexact, the sign of the resulting quotient is that of the
|
|
algebraic quotient, and the magnitude of the resulting quotient is the
|
|
largest integer less than the magnitude of the algebraic quotient. If
|
|
the result cannot be represented, the behavior is undefined;
|
|
otherwise, quot * denom + rem shall equal numer .
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The div function returns a structure of type div_t , comprising
|
|
both the quotient and the remainder. The structure shall contain the
|
|
following members, in either order.
|
|
|
|
int quot; /* quotient */
|
|
int rem; /* remainder */
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.10.6.3 The labs function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdlib.h>
|
|
long int labs(long int j);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The labs function is similar to the abs function, except that the
|
|
argument and the returned value each have type long int .
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.10.6.4 The ldiv function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdlib.h>
|
|
ldiv_t ldiv(long int numer, long int denom);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The ldiv function is similar to the div function, except that the
|
|
arguments and the members of the returned structure (which has type
|
|
ldiv_t ) all have type long int .
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.10.7 Multibyte character functions
|
|
|
|
The behavior of the multibyte character functions is affected by
|
|
the LC_CTYPE category of the current locale. For a state-dependent
|
|
encoding, each function is placed into its initial state by a call for
|
|
which its character pointer argument, s , is a null pointer.
|
|
Subsequent calls with s as other than a null pointer cause the
|
|
internal state of the function to be altered as necessary. A call
|
|
with s as a null pointer causes these functions to return a nonzero
|
|
value if encodings have state dependency, and zero otherwise. After
|
|
the LC_CTYPE category is changed, the shift state of these functions
|
|
is indeterminate.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.10.7.1 The mblen function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdlib.h>
|
|
int mblen(const char *s, size_t n);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
If s is not a null pointer, the mblen function determines the
|
|
number of bytes comprising the multibyte character pointed to by s .
|
|
Except that the shift state of the mbtowc function is not affected, it
|
|
is equivalent to
|
|
|
|
mbtowc((wchar_t *)0, s, n);
|
|
|
|
|
|
The implementation shall behave as if no library function calls the
|
|
mblen function.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
If s is a null pointer, the mblen function returns a nonzero or
|
|
zero value, if multibyte character encodings, respectively, do or do
|
|
not have state-dependent encodings. If s is not a null pointer, the
|
|
mblen function either returns 0 (if s points to the null character),
|
|
or returns the number of bytes that comprise the multibyte character
|
|
(if the next n or fewer bytes form a valid multibyte character), or
|
|
returns -1 (if they do not form a valid multibyte character).
|
|
|
|
Forward references: the mbtowc function ($4.10.7.2).
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.10.7.2 The mbtowc function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdlib.h>
|
|
int mbtowc(wchar_t *pwc, const char *s, size_t n);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
If s is not a null pointer, the mbtowc function determines the
|
|
number of bytes that comprise the multibyte character pointed to by s.
|
|
It then determines the code for value of type wchar_t that
|
|
corresponds to that multibyte character. (The value of the code
|
|
corresponding to the null character is zero.) If the multibyte
|
|
character is valid and pwc is not a null pointer, the mbtowc function
|
|
stores the code in the object pointed to by pwc . At most n bytes of
|
|
the array pointed to by s will be examined.
|
|
|
|
The implementation shall behave as if no library function calls the
|
|
mbtowc function.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
If s is a null pointer, the mbtowc function returns a nonzero or zero
|
|
value, if multibyte character encodings, respectively, do or do not
|
|
have state-dependent encodings. If s is not a null pointer, the
|
|
mbtowc function either returns 0 (if s points to the null character),
|
|
or returns the number of bytes that comprise the converted multibyte
|
|
character (if the next n or fewer bytes form a valid multibyte
|
|
character), or returns -1 (if they do not form a valid multibyte
|
|
character).
|
|
|
|
In no case will the value returned be greater than n or the value
|
|
of the MB_CUR_MAX macro.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.10.7.3 The wctomb function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdlib.h>
|
|
int wctomb(char *s, wchar_t wchar);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The wctomb function determines the number of bytes needed to
|
|
represent the multibyte character corresponding to the code whose
|
|
value is wchar (including any change in shift state). It stores the
|
|
multibyte character representation in the array object pointed to by s
|
|
(if s is not a null pointer). At most MB_CUR_MAX characters are
|
|
stored. If the value of wchar is zero, the wctomb function is left in
|
|
the initial shift state.
|
|
|
|
The implementation shall behave as if no library function calls the
|
|
wctomb function.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
If s is a null pointer, the wctomb function returns a nonzero or
|
|
zero value, if multibyte character encodings, respectively, do or do
|
|
not have state-dependent encodings. If s is not a null pointer, the
|
|
wctomb function returns -1 if the value of wchar does not correspond
|
|
to a valid multibyte character, or returns the number of bytes that
|
|
comprise the multibyte character corresponding to the value of wchar .
|
|
|
|
In no case will the value returned be greater than the value of the
|
|
MB_CUR_MAX macro.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.10.8 Multibyte string functions
|
|
|
|
The behavior of the multibyte string functions is affected by the
|
|
LC_CTYPE category of the current locale.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.10.8.1 The mbstowcs function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdlib.h>
|
|
size_t mbstowcs(wchar_t *pwcs, const char *s, size_t n);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The mbstowcs function converts a sequence of multibyte characters
|
|
that begins in the initial shift state from the array pointed to by s
|
|
into a sequence of corresponding codes and stores not more than n
|
|
codes into the array pointed to by pwcs . No multibyte characters
|
|
that follow a null character (which is converted into a code with
|
|
value zero) will be examined or converted. Each multibyte character
|
|
is converted as if by a call to the mbtowc function, except that the
|
|
shift state of the mbtowc function is not affected.
|
|
|
|
No more than n elements will be modified in the array pointed to by
|
|
pwcs . If copying takes place between objects that overlap, the
|
|
behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
If an invalid multibyte character is encountered, the mbstowcs
|
|
function returns (size_t)-1 . Otherwise, the mbstowcs function
|
|
returns the number of array elements modified, not including a
|
|
terminating zero code, if any.rN
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.10.8.2 The wcstombs function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <stdlib.h>
|
|
size_t wcstombs(char *s, const wchar_t *pwcs, size_t n);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The wcstombs function converts a sequence of codes that correspond
|
|
to multibyte characters from the array pointed to by pwcs into a
|
|
sequence of multibyte characters that begins in the initial shift
|
|
state and stores these multibyte characters into the array pointed to
|
|
by s , stopping if a multibyte character would exceed the limit of n
|
|
total bytes or if a null character is stored. Each code is converted
|
|
as if by a call to the wctomb function, except that the shift state of
|
|
the wctomb function is not affected.
|
|
|
|
No more than n bytes will be modified in the array pointed to by s
|
|
. If copying takes place between objects that overlap, the behavior
|
|
is undefined.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
If a code is encountered that does not correspond to a valid
|
|
multibyte character, the wcstombs function returns (size_t)-1 .
|
|
Otherwise, the wcstombs function returns the number of bytes modified,
|
|
not including a terminating null character, if any.rN
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.11 STRING HANDLING <string.h>
|
|
|
|
4.11.1 String function conventions
|
|
|
|
The header <string.h> declares one type and several functions, and
|
|
defines one macro useful for manipulating arrays of character type and
|
|
other objects treated as arrays of character type./119/ The type is
|
|
size_t and the macro is NULL (both described in $4.1.5). Various
|
|
methods are used for determining the lengths of the arrays, but in all
|
|
cases a char * or void * argument points to the initial (lowest
|
|
addressed) character of the array. If an array is accessed beyond the
|
|
end of an object, the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.11.2 Copying functions
|
|
|
|
4.11.2.1 The memcpy function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <string.h>
|
|
void *memcpy(void *s1, const void *s2, size_t n);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The memcpy function copies n characters from the object pointed to
|
|
by s2 into the object pointed to by s1 . If copying takes place
|
|
between objects that overlap, the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The memcpy function returns the value of s1 .
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.11.2.2 The memmove function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <string.h>
|
|
void *memmove(void *s1, const void *s2, size_t n);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The memmove function copies n characters from the object pointed to
|
|
by s2 into the object pointed to by s1 . Copying takes place as if
|
|
the n characters from the object pointed to by s2 are first copied
|
|
into a temporary array of n characters that does not overlap the
|
|
objects pointed to by s1 and s2 , and then the n characters from the
|
|
temporary array are copied into the object pointed to by s1 .
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The memmove function returns the value of s1 .
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.11.2.3 The strcpy function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <string.h>
|
|
char *strcpy(char *s1, const char *s2);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The strcpy function copies the string pointed to by s2 (including
|
|
the terminating null character) into the array pointed to by s1 . If
|
|
copying takes place between objects that overlap, the behavior is
|
|
undefined.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The strcpy function returns the value of s1 .
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.11.2.4 The strncpy function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <string.h>
|
|
char *strncpy(char *s1, const char *s2, size_t n);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The strncpy function copies not more than n characters (characters
|
|
that follow a null character are not copied) from the array pointed to
|
|
by s2 to the array pointed to by s1 ./120/ If copying takes place
|
|
between objects that overlap, the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
If the array pointed to by s2 is a string that is shorter than n
|
|
characters, null characters are appended to the copy in the array
|
|
pointed to by s1 , until n characters in all have been written.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The strncpy function returns the value of s1 .
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.11.3 Concatenation functions
|
|
|
|
4.11.3.1 The strcat function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <string.h>
|
|
char *strcat(char *s1, const char *s2);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The strcat function appends a copy of the string pointed to by s2
|
|
(including the terminating null character) to the end of the string
|
|
pointed to by s1 . The initial character of s2 overwrites the null
|
|
character at the end of s1 . If copying takes place between objects
|
|
that overlap, the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The strcat function returns the value of s1 .
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.11.3.2 The strncat function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <string.h>
|
|
char *strncat(char *s1, const char *s2, size_t n);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The strncat function appends not more than n characters (a null
|
|
character and characters that follow it are not appended) from the
|
|
array pointed to by s2 to the end of the string pointed to by s1 .
|
|
The initial character of s2 overwrites the null character at the end
|
|
of s1 . A terminating null character is always appended to the
|
|
result./121/ If copying takes place between objects that overlap, the
|
|
behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The strncat function returns the value of s1 .
|
|
|
|
Forward references: the strlen function ($4.11.6.3).
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.11.4 Comparison functions
|
|
|
|
The sign of a nonzero value returned by the comparison functions is
|
|
determined by the sign of the difference between the values of the
|
|
first pair of characters (both interpreted as unsigned char ) that
|
|
differ in the objects being compared.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.11.4.1 The memcmp function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <string.h>
|
|
int memcmp(const void *s1, const void *s2, size_t n);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The memcmp function compares the first n characters of the object
|
|
pointed to by s1 to the first n characters of the object pointed to by
|
|
s2 ./122/
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The memcmp function returns an integer greater than, equal to, or
|
|
less than zero, according as the object pointed to by s1 is greater
|
|
than, equal to, or less than the object pointed to by s2 .
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.11.4.2 The strcmp function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <string.h>
|
|
int strcmp(const char *s1, const char *s2);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The strcmp function compares the string pointed to by s1 to the
|
|
string pointed to by s2 .
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The strcmp function returns an integer greater than, equal to, or
|
|
less than zero, according as the string pointed to by s1 is greater
|
|
than, equal to, or less than the string pointed to by s2 .
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.11.4.3 The strcoll function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <string.h>
|
|
int strcoll(const char *s1, const char *s2);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The strcoll function compares the string pointed to by s1 to the
|
|
string pointed to by s2 , both interpreted as appropriate to the
|
|
LC_COLLATE category of the current locale.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The strcoll function returns an integer greater than, equal to, or
|
|
less than zero, according as the string pointed to by s1 is greater
|
|
than, equal to, or less than the string pointed to by s2 when both are
|
|
interpreted as appropriate to the current locale.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.11.4.4 The strncmp function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <string.h>
|
|
int strncmp(const char *s1, const char *s2, size_t n);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The strncmp function compares not more than n characters
|
|
(characters that follow a null character are not compared) from the
|
|
array pointed to by s1 to the array pointed to by s2 .
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The strncmp function returns an integer greater than, equal to, or
|
|
less than zero, according as the possibly null-terminated array
|
|
pointed to by s1 is greater than, equal to, or less than the possibly
|
|
null-terminated array pointed to by s2 .
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.11.4.5 The strxfrm function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <string.h>
|
|
size_t strxfrm(char *s1, const char *s2, size_t n);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The strxfrm function transforms the string pointed to by s2 and
|
|
places the resulting string into the array pointed to by s1 . The
|
|
transformation is such that if the strcmp function is applied to two
|
|
transformed strings, it returns a value greater than, equal to, or
|
|
less than zero, corresponding to the result of the strcoll function
|
|
applied to the same two original strings. No more than n characters
|
|
are placed into the resulting array pointed to by s1 , including the
|
|
terminating null character. If n is zero, s1 is permitted to be a
|
|
null pointer. If copying takes place between objects that overlap,
|
|
the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The strxfrm function returns the length of the transformed string
|
|
(not including the terminating null character). If the value returned
|
|
is n or more, the contents of the array pointed to by s1 are
|
|
indeterminate.
|
|
|
|
Example
|
|
|
|
The value of the following expression is the size of the array
|
|
needed to hold the transformation of the string pointed to by s .
|
|
|
|
1 + strxfrm(NULL, s, 0)
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.11.5 Search functions
|
|
|
|
4.11.5.1 The memchr function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <string.h>
|
|
void *memchr(const void *s, int c, size_t n);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The memchr function locates the first occurrence of c (converted to
|
|
an unsigned char ) in the initial n characters (each interpreted as
|
|
unsigned char ) of the object pointed to by s .
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The memchr function returns a pointer to the located character, or
|
|
a null pointer if the character does not occur in the object.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.11.5.2 The strchr function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <string.h>
|
|
char *strchr(const char *s, int c);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The strchr function locates the first occurrence of c (converted to
|
|
a char ) in the string pointed to by s . The terminating null
|
|
character is considered to be part of the string.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The strchr function returns a pointer to the located character, or
|
|
a null pointer if the character does not occur in the string.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.11.5.3 The strcspn function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <string.h>
|
|
size_t strcspn(const char *s1, const char *s2);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The strcspn function computes the length of the maximum initial
|
|
segment of the string pointed to by s1 which consists entirely of
|
|
characters not from the string pointed to by s2 .
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The strcspn function returns the length of the segment.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.11.5.4 The strpbrk function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <string.h>
|
|
char *strpbrk(const char *s1, const char *s2);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The strpbrk function locates the first occurrence in the string
|
|
pointed to by s1 of any character from the string pointed to by s2 .
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The strpbrk function returns a pointer to the character, or a null
|
|
pointer if no character from s2 occurs in s1 .
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.11.5.5 The strrchr function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <string.h>
|
|
char *strrchr(const char *s, int c);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The strrchr function locates the last occurrence of c (converted to
|
|
a char ) in the string pointed to by s . The terminating null
|
|
character is considered to be part of the string.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The strrchr function returns a pointer to the character, or a null
|
|
pointer if c does not occur in the string.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.11.5.6 The strspn function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <string.h>
|
|
size_t strspn(const char *s1, const char *s2);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The strspn function computes the length of the maximum initial
|
|
segment of the string pointed to by s1 which consists entirely of
|
|
characters from the string pointed to by s2 .
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The strspn function returns the length of the segment.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.11.5.7 The strstr function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <string.h>
|
|
char *strstr(const char *s1, const char *s2);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The strstr function locates the first occurrence in the string
|
|
pointed to by s1 of the sequence of characters (excluding the
|
|
terminating null character) in the string pointed to by s2
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The strstr function returns a pointer to the located string, or a
|
|
null pointer if the string is not found. If s2 points to a string
|
|
with zero length, the function returns s1 .
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.11.5.8 The strtok function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <string.h>
|
|
char *strtok(char *s1, const char *s2);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
A sequence of calls to the strtok function breaks the string
|
|
pointed to by s1 into a sequence of tokens, each of which is delimited
|
|
by a character from the string pointed to by s2 . The first call in
|
|
the sequence has s1 as its first argument, and is followed by calls
|
|
with a null pointer as their first argument. The separator string
|
|
pointed to by s2 may be different from call to call.
|
|
|
|
The first call in the sequence searches the string pointed to by s1
|
|
for the first character that is not contained in the current separator
|
|
string pointed to by s2 . If no such character is found, then there
|
|
are no tokens in the string pointed to by s1 and the strtok function
|
|
returns a null pointer. If such a character is found, it is the start
|
|
of the first token.
|
|
|
|
The strtok function then searches from there for a character that
|
|
is contained in the current separator string. If no such character is
|
|
found, the current token extends to the end of the string pointed to
|
|
by s1 , and subsequent searches for a token will return a null
|
|
pointer. If such a character is found, it is overwritten by a null
|
|
character, which terminates the current token. The strtok function
|
|
saves a pointer to the following character, from which the next search
|
|
for a token will start.
|
|
|
|
Each subsequent call, with a null pointer as the value of the first
|
|
argument, starts searching from the saved pointer and behaves as
|
|
described above.
|
|
|
|
The implementation shall behave as if no library function calls the
|
|
strtok function.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The strtok function returns a pointer to the first character of a
|
|
token, or a null pointer if there is no token.
|
|
|
|
Example
|
|
|
|
#include <string.h>
|
|
static char str[] = "?a???b,,,#c";
|
|
char *t;
|
|
|
|
t = strtok(str, "?"); /* t points to the token "a" */
|
|
t = strtok(NULL, ","); /* t points to the token "??b" */
|
|
t = strtok(NULL, "#,"); /* t points to the token "c" */
|
|
t = strtok(NULL, "?"); /* t is a null pointer */
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.11.6 Miscellaneous functions
|
|
|
|
4.11.6.1 The memset function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <string.h>
|
|
void *memset(void *s, int c, size_t n);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The memset function copies the value of c (converted to an unsigned
|
|
char ) into each of the first n characters of the object pointed to by
|
|
s .
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The memset function returns the value of s .
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.11.6.2 The strerror function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <string.h>
|
|
char *strerror(int errnum);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The strerror function maps the error number in errnum to an error
|
|
message string.
|
|
|
|
The implementation shall behave as if no library function calls the
|
|
strerror function.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The strerror function returns a pointer to the string, the contents
|
|
of which are implementation-defined. The array pointed to shall not
|
|
be modified by the program, but may be overwritten by a subsequent
|
|
call to the strerror function.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.11.6.3 The strlen function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <string.h>
|
|
size_t strlen(const char *s);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The strlen function computes the length of the string pointed to by s .
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The strlen function returns the number of characters that precede
|
|
the terminating null character.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.12 DATE AND TIME <time.h>
|
|
|
|
4.12.1 Components of time
|
|
|
|
The header <time.h> defines two macros, and declares four types and
|
|
several functions for manipulating time. Many functions deal with a
|
|
calendar time that represents the current date (according to the
|
|
Gregorian calendar) and time. Some functions deal with local time,
|
|
which is the calendar time expressed for some specific time zone, and
|
|
with Daylight Saving Time, which is a temporary change in the
|
|
algorithm for determining local time. The local time zone and
|
|
Daylight Saving Time are implementation-defined.
|
|
|
|
The macros defined are NULL (described in $4.1.5); and
|
|
|
|
CLK_TCK
|
|
|
|
which is the number per second of the value returned by the clock function.
|
|
|
|
The types declared are size_t (described in $4.1.5);
|
|
|
|
clock_t
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
time_t
|
|
|
|
which are arithmetic types capable of representing times; and
|
|
|
|
struct tm
|
|
|
|
which holds the components of a calendar time, called the broken-down
|
|
time. The structure shall contain at least the following members, in
|
|
any order. The semantics of the members and their normal ranges are
|
|
expressed in the comments./123/
|
|
|
|
int tm_sec; /* seconds after the minute --- [0, 60] */
|
|
int tm_min; /* minutes after the hour --- [0, 59] */
|
|
int tm_hour; /* hours since midnight --- [0, 23] */
|
|
int tm_mday; /* day of the month --- [1, 31] */
|
|
int tm_mon; /* months since January --- [0, 11] */
|
|
int tm_year; /* years since 1900 */
|
|
int tm_wday; /* days since Sunday --- [0, 6] */
|
|
int tm_yday; /* days since January 1 --- [0, 365] */
|
|
int tm_isdst; /* Daylight Saving Time flag */
|
|
|
|
The value of tm_isdst is positive if Daylight Saving Time is in
|
|
effect, zero if Daylight Saving Time is not in effect, and negative if
|
|
the information is not available.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.12.2 Time manipulation functions
|
|
|
|
4.12.2.1 The clock function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <time.h>
|
|
clock_t clock(void);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The clock function determines the processor time used.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The clock function returns the implementation's best approximation
|
|
to the processor time used by the program since the beginning of an
|
|
implementation-defined era related only to the program invocation. To
|
|
determine the time in seconds, the value returned by the clock
|
|
function should be divided by the value of the macro CLK_TCK . If the
|
|
processor time used is not available or its value cannot be
|
|
represented, the function returns the value (clock_t)-1 .
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.12.2.2 The difftime function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <time.h>
|
|
double difftime(time_t time1, time_t time0);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The difftime function computes the difference between two calendar
|
|
times: time1 - time0 .
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The difftime function returns the difference expressed in seconds
|
|
as a double .
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.12.2.3 The mktime function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <time.h>
|
|
time_t mktime(struct tm *timeptr);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The mktime function converts the broken-down time, expressed as
|
|
local time, in the structure pointed to by timeptr into a calendar
|
|
time value with the same encoding as that of the values returned by
|
|
the time function. The original values of the tm_wday and tm_yday
|
|
components of the structure are ignored, and the original values of
|
|
the other components are not restricted to the ranges indicated
|
|
above./124/ On successful completion, the values of the tm_wday and
|
|
tm_yday components of the structure are set appropriately, and the
|
|
other components are set to represent the specified calendar time, but
|
|
with their values forced to the ranges indicated above; the final
|
|
value of tm_mday is not set until tm_mon and tm_year are determined.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The mktime function returns the specified calendar time encoded as
|
|
a value of type time_t . If the calendar time cannot be represented,
|
|
the function returns the value (time_t)-1 .
|
|
|
|
Example
|
|
|
|
What day of the week is July 4, 2001?
|
|
|
|
|
|
#include <stdio.h>
|
|
#include <time.h>
|
|
static const char *const wday[] = {
|
|
"Sunday", "Monday", "Tuesday", "Wednesday",
|
|
"Thursday", "Friday", "Saturday", "-unknown-"
|
|
};
|
|
struct tm time_str;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
time_str.tm_year = 2001 - 1900;
|
|
time_str.tm_mon = 7 - 1;
|
|
time_str.tm_mday = 4;
|
|
time_str.tm_hour = 0;
|
|
time_str.tm_min = 0;
|
|
time_str.tm_sec = 1;
|
|
time_str.tm_isdst = -1;
|
|
if (mktime(&time_str) == -1)
|
|
time_str.tm_wday = 7;
|
|
printf("%s\n", wday[time_str.tm_wday]);
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.12.2.4 The time function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <time.h>
|
|
time_t time(time_t *timer);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The time function determines the current calendar time. The
|
|
encoding of the value is unspecified.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The time function returns the implementation's best approximation
|
|
to the current calendar time. The value (time_t)-1 is returned if the
|
|
calendar time is not available. If timer is not a null pointer, the
|
|
return value is also assigned to the object it points to.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.12.3 Time conversion functions
|
|
|
|
Except for the strftime function, these functions return values in
|
|
one of two static objects: a broken-down time structure and an array
|
|
of char . Execution of any of the functions may overwrite the
|
|
information returned in either of these objects by any of the other
|
|
functions. The implementation shall behave as if no other library
|
|
functions call these functions.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.12.3.1 The asctime function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <time.h>
|
|
char *asctime(const struct tm *timeptr);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The asctime function converts the broken-down time in the structure
|
|
pointed to by timeptr into a string in the form
|
|
|
|
Sun Sep 16 01:03:52 1973\n\0
|
|
|
|
using the equivalent of the following algorithm.
|
|
|
|
char *asctime(const struct tm *timeptr)
|
|
{
|
|
static const char wday_name[7][3] = {
|
|
"Sun", "Mon", "Tue", "Wed", "Thu", "Fri", "Sat"
|
|
};
|
|
static const char mon_name[12][3] = {
|
|
"Jan", "Feb", "Mar", "Apr", "May", "Jun",
|
|
"Jul", "Aug", "Sep", "Oct", "Nov", "Dec"
|
|
};
|
|
static char result[26];
|
|
|
|
sprintf(result, "%.3s %.3s%3d %.2d:%.2d:%.2d %d\n",
|
|
wday_name[timeptr->tm_wday],
|
|
mon_name[timeptr->tm_mon],
|
|
timeptr->tm_mday, timeptr->tm_hour,
|
|
timeptr->tm_min, timeptr->tm_sec,
|
|
1900 + timeptr->tm_year);
|
|
return result;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The asctime function returns a pointer to the string.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.12.3.2 The ctime function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <time.h>
|
|
char *ctime(const time_t *timer);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The ctime function converts the calendar time pointed to by timer to local time in the form of a string. It is equivalent to
|
|
|
|
asctime(localtime(timer))
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The ctime function returns the pointer returned by the asctime
|
|
function with that broken-down time as argument.
|
|
|
|
Forward references: the localtime function ($4.12.3.4).
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.12.3.3 The gmtime function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <time.h>
|
|
struct tm *gmtime(const time_t *timer);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The gmtime function converts the calendar time pointed to by timer
|
|
into a broken-down time, expressed as Coordinated Universal Time
|
|
(UTC).
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The gmtime function returns a pointer to that object, or a null
|
|
pointer if UTC is not available.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.12.3.4 The localtime function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <time.h>
|
|
struct tm *localtime(const time_t *timer);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The localtime function converts the calendar time pointed to by
|
|
timer into a broken-down time, expressed as local time.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
The localtime function returns a pointer to that object.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.12.3.5 The strftime function
|
|
|
|
Synopsis
|
|
|
|
#include <time.h>
|
|
size_t strftime(char *s, size_t maxsize,
|
|
const char *format, const struct tm *timeptr);
|
|
|
|
Description
|
|
|
|
The strftime function places characters into the array pointed to
|
|
by s as controlled by the string pointed to by format . The format
|
|
shall be a multibyte character sequence, beginning and ending in its
|
|
initial shift state. The format string consists of zero or more
|
|
conversion specifications and ordinary multibyte characters. A
|
|
conversion specification consists of a % character followed by a
|
|
character that determines the conversion specification's behavior.
|
|
All ordinary multibyte characters (including the terminating null
|
|
character) are copied unchanged into the array. If copying takes
|
|
place between objects that overlap, the behavior is undefined. No
|
|
more than maxsize characters are placed into the array. Each
|
|
conversion specification is replaced by appropriate characters as
|
|
described in the following list. The appropriate characters are
|
|
determined by the program's locale and by the values contained in the
|
|
structure pointed to by timeptr .
|
|
|
|
"%a" is replaced by the locale's abbreviated weekday name.
|
|
"%A" is replaced by the locale's full weekday name.
|
|
"%b" is replaced by the locale's abbreviated month name.
|
|
"%B" is replaced by the locale's full month name.
|
|
"%c" is replaced by the locale's appropriate date and time representation.
|
|
"%d" is replaced by the day of the month as a decimal number (01-31).
|
|
"%H" is replaced by the hour (24-hour clock) as a decimal number (00-23).
|
|
"%I" is replaced by the hour (12-hour clock) as a decimal number (01-12).
|
|
"%j" is replaced by the day of the year as a decimal number (001-366 ).
|
|
"%m" is replaced by the month as a decimal number (01-12).
|
|
"%M" is replaced by the minute as a decimal number (00-59).
|
|
"%p" is replaced by the locale's equivalent of either AM or PM .
|
|
"%S" is replaced by the second as a decimal number (00-60).
|
|
"%U" is replaced by the week number of the year (ithe first Sunday as the
|
|
first day of week 1) as a decimal number (00-53).
|
|
"%w" is replaced by the weekday as a decimal number (0-6), where Sunday is
|
|
0.
|
|
"%W" is replaced by the week number of the year (the first Monday as the
|
|
first day of week 1) as a decimal number (00-53).
|
|
"%x" is replaced by the locale's appropriate date representation.
|
|
"%X" is replaced by the locale's appropriate time representation.
|
|
"%y" is replaced by the year without century as a decimal number (00-99).
|
|
"%Y" is replaced by the year with century as a decimal number.
|
|
"%Z" is replaced by the time zone name, or by no characters if no time
|
|
zone is determinable.
|
|
"%%" is replaced by %.
|
|
|
|
If a conversion specification is not one of the above, the behavior
|
|
is undefined.
|
|
|
|
Returns
|
|
|
|
If the total number of resulting characters including the
|
|
terminating null character is not more than maxsize , the strftime
|
|
function returns the number of characters placed into the array
|
|
pointed to by s not including the terminating null character.
|
|
Otherwise, zero is returned and the contents of the array are
|
|
indeterminate.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.13 FUTURE LIBRARY DIRECTIONS
|
|
|
|
The following names are grouped under individual headers for
|
|
convenience. All external names described below are reserved no
|
|
matter what headers are included by the program.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.13.1 Errors <errno.h>
|
|
|
|
Macros that begin with E and a digit or E and an upper-case letter
|
|
(followed by any combination of digits, letters and underscore) may be
|
|
added to the declarations in the <errno.h> header.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.13.2 Character handling <ctype.h>
|
|
|
|
Function names that begin with either is or to , and a lower-case
|
|
letter (followed by any combination of digits, letters and underscore)
|
|
may be added to the declarations in the <ctype.h> header.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.13.3 Localization <locale.h>
|
|
|
|
Macros that begin with LC_ and an upper-case letter (followed by
|
|
any combination of digits, letters and underscore) may be added to the
|
|
definitions in the <locale.h> header.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.13.4 Mathematics <math.h>
|
|
|
|
The names of all existing functions declared in the <math.h>
|
|
header, suffixed with f or l , are reserved respectively for
|
|
corresponding functions with float and long double arguments and
|
|
return values.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.13.5 Signal handling <signal.h>
|
|
|
|
Macros that begin with either SIG and an upper-case letter or SIG_
|
|
and an upper-case letter (followed by any combination of digits,
|
|
letters and underscore) may be added to the definitions in the
|
|
<signal.h> header.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.13.6 Input/output <stdio.h>
|
|
|
|
Lower-case letters may be added to the conversion specifiers in
|
|
fprintf and fscanf . Other characters may be used in extensions.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.13.7 General utilities <stdlib.h>
|
|
|
|
Function names that begin with str and a lower-case letter
|
|
(followed by any combination of digits, letters and underscore) may be
|
|
added to the declarations in the <stdlib.h> header.
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.13.8 String handling <string.h>
|
|
|
|
Function names that begin with str , mem , or wcs and a lower-case
|
|
letter (followed by any combination of digits, letters and underscore)
|
|
may be added to the declarations in the <string.h> header.
|
|
|
|
|
|
A. APPENDICES
|
|
|
|
(These appendices are not a part of American National Standard for
|
|
Information Systems --- Programming Language C, X3.???-1988.)
|
|
|
|
These appendices collect information that appears in the Standard,
|
|
and are not necessarily complete.
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.1 LANGUAGE SYNTAX SUMMARY
|
|
|
|
The notation is described in the introduction to $3 (Language).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.1.1 Lexical grammar
|
|
|
|
A.1.1.1 Tokens
|
|
|
|
keyword
|
|
identifier
|
|
constant
|
|
string-literal
|
|
operator
|
|
punctuator
|
|
header-name
|
|
identifier
|
|
pp-number
|
|
character-constant
|
|
string-literal
|
|
operator
|
|
punctuator
|
|
each non-white-space character that cannot be one of
|
|
the above
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.1.1.2 Keywords
|
|
|
|
auto double int struct
|
|
break else long switch
|
|
case enum register typedef
|
|
char extern return union
|
|
const float short unsigned
|
|
continue for signed void
|
|
default goto sizeof volatile
|
|
do if static while
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.1.1.3 Identifiers
|
|
|
|
nondigit
|
|
identifier nondigit
|
|
identifier digit
|
|
|
|
_ a b c d e f g h i j k l m
|
|
n o p q r s t u v w x y z
|
|
A B C D E F G H I J K L M
|
|
N O P Q R S T U V W X Y Z
|
|
|
|
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.1.1.4 Constants
|
|
|
|
floating-constant
|
|
integer-constant
|
|
enumeration-constant
|
|
character-constant
|
|
|
|
fractional-constant exponent-part<opt> floating-suffix<opt>
|
|
digit-sequence exponent-part floating-suffix<opt>
|
|
|
|
digit-sequence<opt> . digit-sequence
|
|
digit-sequence .
|
|
|
|
e sign<opt> digit-sequence
|
|
E sign<opt> digit-sequence
|
|
|
|
+ -
|
|
|
|
digit
|
|
digit-sequence digit
|
|
|
|
f l F L
|
|
|
|
decimal-constant integer-suffix<opt>
|
|
octal-constant integer-suffix<opt>
|
|
hexadecimal-constant integer-suffix<opt>
|
|
|
|
nonzero-digit
|
|
decimal-constant digit
|
|
|
|
0
|
|
octal-constant octal-digit
|
|
|
|
0x hexadecimal-digit
|
|
0X hexadecimal-digit
|
|
hexadecimal-constant hexadecimal-digit
|
|
|
|
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
|
|
|
|
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
|
|
|
|
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
|
|
a b c d e f
|
|
A B C D E F
|
|
|
|
unsigned-suffix long-suffix<opt>
|
|
long-suffix unsigned-suffix<opt>
|
|
|
|
u U
|
|
|
|
l L
|
|
|
|
identifier
|
|
|
|
' c-char-sequence'
|
|
L' c-char-sequence'
|
|
|
|
c-char
|
|
c-char-sequence c-char
|
|
|
|
any member of the source character set except
|
|
the single-quote ', backslash \, or new-line character
|
|
escape-sequence
|
|
|
|
simple-escape-sequence
|
|
octal-escape-sequence
|
|
hexadecimal-escape-sequence
|
|
|
|
\' \" \? \\
|
|
\a \b \f \n \r \t \v
|
|
|
|
\ octal-digit
|
|
\ octal-digit octal-digit
|
|
\ octal-digit octal-digit octal-digit
|
|
|
|
\x hexadecimal-digit
|
|
hexadecimal-escape-sequence hexadecimal-digit
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.1.1.5 String literals
|
|
|
|
" s-char-sequence<opt>"
|
|
L" s-char-sequence<opt>"
|
|
|
|
s-char
|
|
s-char-sequence s-char
|
|
|
|
any member of the source character set except
|
|
the double-quote ", backslash \, or new-line character
|
|
escape-sequence
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.1.1.6 Operators
|
|
|
|
[ ] ( ) . ->
|
|
++ -- & * + - ~ ! sizeof
|
|
/ % << >> < > <= >= == != ^ | && ||
|
|
? :
|
|
= *= /= %= += -= <<= >>= &= ^= |=
|
|
, # ##
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.1.1.7 Punctuators
|
|
|
|
[ ] ( ) { } * , : = ; ... #
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.1.1.8 Header names
|
|
|
|
< h-char-sequence>
|
|
" q-char-sequence"
|
|
|
|
h-char
|
|
h-char-sequence h-char
|
|
|
|
any member of the source character set except
|
|
the new-line character and >
|
|
|
|
q-char
|
|
q-char-sequence q-char
|
|
|
|
any member of the source character set except
|
|
the new-line character and "
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.1.1.9 Preprocessing numbers
|
|
|
|
digit
|
|
. digit
|
|
pp-number digit
|
|
pp-number nondigit
|
|
pp-number e sign
|
|
pp-number E sign
|
|
pp-number .
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.1.2 Phrase structure grammar
|
|
|
|
A.1.2.1 Expressions
|
|
|
|
identifier
|
|
constant
|
|
string-literal
|
|
( expression )
|
|
|
|
primary-expression
|
|
postfix-expression [ expression ]
|
|
postfix-expression ( argument-expression-list<opt> )
|
|
postfix-expression . identifier
|
|
postfix-expression -> identifier
|
|
postfix-expression ++
|
|
postfix-expression --
|
|
|
|
assignment-expression
|
|
argument-expression-list , assignment-expression
|
|
|
|
postfix-expression
|
|
++ unary-expression
|
|
-- unary-expression
|
|
unary-operator cast-expression
|
|
sizeof unary-expression
|
|
sizeof ( type-name )
|
|
|
|
& * + - ~ !
|
|
|
|
unary-expression
|
|
( type-name ) cast-expression
|
|
|
|
cast-expression
|
|
multiplicative-expression * cast-expression
|
|
multiplicative-expression / cast-expression
|
|
multiplicative-expression % cast-expression
|
|
|
|
multiplicative-expression
|
|
additive-expression + multiplicative-expression
|
|
additive-expression - multiplicative-expression
|
|
|
|
additive-expression
|
|
shift-expression << additive-expression
|
|
shift-expression >> additive-expression
|
|
|
|
shift-expression
|
|
relational-expression < shift-expression
|
|
relational-expression > shift-expression
|
|
relational-expression <= shift-expression
|
|
relational-expression >= shift-expression
|
|
|
|
relational-expression
|
|
equality-expression == relational-expression
|
|
equality-expression != relational-expression
|
|
|
|
equality-expression
|
|
AND-expression & equality-expression
|
|
|
|
AND-expression
|
|
exclusive-OR-expression ^ AND-expression
|
|
|
|
exclusive-OR-expression
|
|
inclusive-OR-expression | exclusive-OR-expression
|
|
|
|
inclusive-OR-expression
|
|
logical-AND-expression && inclusive-OR-expression
|
|
|
|
logical-AND-expression
|
|
logical-OR-expression || logical-AND-expression
|
|
|
|
logical-OR-expression
|
|
logical-OR-expression ? expression : conditional-expression
|
|
|
|
conditional-expression
|
|
unary-expression assignment-operator assignment-expression
|
|
|
|
= *= /= %= += -= <<= >>= &= ^= |=
|
|
|
|
assignment-expression
|
|
expression , assignment-expression
|
|
|
|
conditional-expression
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.1.2.2 Declarations
|
|
|
|
declaration-specifiers init-declarator-list<opt> ;
|
|
|
|
storage-class-specifier declaration-specifiers<opt>
|
|
type-specifier declaration-specifiers<opt>
|
|
type-qualifier declaration-specifiers<opt>
|
|
|
|
init-declarator
|
|
init-declarator-list , init-declarator
|
|
|
|
declarator
|
|
declarator = initializer
|
|
|
|
typedef
|
|
extern
|
|
static
|
|
auto
|
|
register
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
char
|
|
short
|
|
int
|
|
long
|
|
float
|
|
double
|
|
signed
|
|
unsigned
|
|
struct-or-union-specifier
|
|
enum-specifier
|
|
typedef-name
|
|
|
|
struct-or-union identifier<opt> { struct-declaration-list }
|
|
struct-or-union identifier
|
|
|
|
struct
|
|
union
|
|
|
|
struct-declaration
|
|
struct-declaration-list struct-declaration
|
|
|
|
specifier-qualifier-list struct-declarator-list ;
|
|
|
|
type-specifier specifier-qualifier-list<opt>
|
|
type-qualifier specifier-qualifier-list<opt>
|
|
|
|
struct-declarator
|
|
struct-declarator-list , struct-declarator
|
|
|
|
declarator
|
|
declarator<opt> : constant-expression
|
|
|
|
enum identifier<opt> { enumerator-list }
|
|
enum identifier
|
|
|
|
enumerator
|
|
enumerator-list , enumerator
|
|
|
|
enumeration-constant
|
|
enumeration-constant = constant-expression
|
|
|
|
const
|
|
volatile
|
|
|
|
pointer<opt> direct-declarator
|
|
|
|
identifier
|
|
( declarator )
|
|
direct-declarator [ constant-expression<opt> ]
|
|
|
|
direct-declarator ( parameter-type-list )
|
|
direct-declarator ( identifier-list<opt> )
|
|
|
|
* type-qualifier-list<opt>
|
|
* type-qualifier-list<opt> pointer
|
|
|
|
type-qualifier
|
|
type-qualifier-list type-qualifier
|
|
|
|
parameter-list
|
|
parameter-list , ...
|
|
|
|
parameter-declaration
|
|
parameter-list , parameter-declaration
|
|
|
|
declaration-specifiers declarator
|
|
declaration-specifiers abstract-declarator<opt>
|
|
|
|
identifier
|
|
identifier-list , identifier
|
|
|
|
specifier-qualifier-list abstract-declarator<opt>
|
|
|
|
pointer
|
|
pointer<opt> direct-abstract-declarator
|
|
|
|
( abstract-declarator )
|
|
direct-abstract-declarator<opt> [ constant-expression<opt> ]
|
|
direct-abstract-declarator<opt> ( parameter-type-list<opt> )
|
|
|
|
identifier
|
|
|
|
assignment-expression
|
|
{ initializer-list }
|
|
{ initializer-list , }
|
|
|
|
initializer
|
|
initializer-list , initializer
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.1.2.3 Statements
|
|
|
|
labeled-statement
|
|
compound-statement
|
|
expression-statement
|
|
selection-statement
|
|
iteration-statement
|
|
jump-statement
|
|
|
|
identifier : statement
|
|
case constant-expression : statement
|
|
default : statement
|
|
|
|
{ declaration-list<opt> statement-list<opt> }
|
|
|
|
declaration
|
|
declaration-list declaration
|
|
|
|
statement
|
|
statement-list statement
|
|
|
|
expression<opt> ;
|
|
|
|
if ( expression ) statement
|
|
if ( expression ) statement else statement
|
|
switch ( expression ) statement
|
|
|
|
while ( expression ) statement
|
|
do statement while ( expression ) ;
|
|
for ( expression<opt> ; expression<opt> ;
|
|
expression<opt> ) statement
|
|
|
|
goto identifier ;
|
|
continue ;
|
|
break ;
|
|
return expression<opt> ;
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.1.2.4 External definitions
|
|
|
|
external-declaration
|
|
translation-unit external-declaration
|
|
|
|
function-definition
|
|
declaration
|
|
|
|
declaration-specifiers<opt> declarator
|
|
declaration-list<opt> compound-statement
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.1.3 Preprocessing directives
|
|
|
|
group<opt>
|
|
|
|
group-part
|
|
group group-part
|
|
|
|
pp-tokens<opt> new-line
|
|
if-section
|
|
control-line
|
|
|
|
if-group elif-groups<opt> else-group<opt> endif-line
|
|
|
|
# if constant-expression new-line group<opt>
|
|
# ifdef identifier new-line group<opt>
|
|
# ifndef identifier new-line group<opt>
|
|
|
|
elif-group
|
|
elif-groups elif-group
|
|
|
|
# elif constant-expression new-line group<opt>
|
|
|
|
# else new-line group<opt>
|
|
|
|
# endif new-line
|
|
|
|
control-line:
|
|
|
|
the left-parenthesis character without preceding white space
|
|
|
|
pp-tokens<opt>
|
|
|
|
preprocessing-token
|
|
pp-tokens preprocessing-token
|
|
|
|
the new-line character
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.2 SEQUENCE POINTS
|
|
|
|
The following are the sequence points described in $2.1.2.3.
|
|
|
|
|
|
* The call to a function, after the arguments have been evaluated
|
|
($3.3.2.2).
|
|
|
|
* The end of the first operand of the following operators: logical
|
|
AND && ($3.3.13); logical OR || ($3.3.14); conditional ? ($3.3.15);
|
|
comma , ($3.3.17).
|
|
|
|
* The end of a full expression: an initializer ($3.5.7); the
|
|
expression in an expression statement ($3.6.3); the controlling
|
|
expression of a selection statement ( if or switch ) ($3.6.4); the
|
|
controlling expression of a while or do statement ($3.6.5); the three
|
|
expressions of a for statement ($3.6.5.3); the expression in a return
|
|
statement ($3.6.6.4).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.3 LIBRARY SUMMARY
|
|
|
|
A.3.1 ERRORS <errno.h>
|
|
|
|
EDOM
|
|
ERANGE
|
|
errno
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.3.2 COMMON DEFINITIONS <stddef.h>
|
|
|
|
NULL
|
|
offsetof( type, member-designator)
|
|
ptrdiff_t
|
|
size_t
|
|
wchar_t
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.3.3 DIAGNOSTICS <assert.h>
|
|
|
|
NDEBUG
|
|
void assert(int expression);
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.3.4 CHARACTER HANDLING <ctype.h>
|
|
|
|
int isalnum(int c);
|
|
int isalpha(int c);
|
|
int iscntrl(int c);
|
|
int isdigit(int c);
|
|
int isgraph(int c);
|
|
int islower(int c);
|
|
int isprint(int c);
|
|
int ispunct(int c);
|
|
int isspace(int c);
|
|
int isupper(int c);
|
|
int isxdigit(int c);
|
|
int tolower(int c);
|
|
int toupper(int c);
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.3.5 LOCALIZATION <locale.h>
|
|
|
|
LC_ALL
|
|
LC_COLLATE
|
|
LC_CTYPE
|
|
LC_MONETARY
|
|
LC_NUMERIC
|
|
LC_TIME
|
|
NULL
|
|
struct lconv
|
|
char *setlocale(int category, const char *locale);
|
|
struct lconv *localeconv(void);
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.3.6 MATHEMATICS <math.h>
|
|
|
|
HUGE_VAL
|
|
double acos(double x);
|
|
double asin(double x);
|
|
double atan(double x);
|
|
double atan2(double y, double x);
|
|
double cos(double x);
|
|
double sin(double x);
|
|
double tan(double x);
|
|
double cosh(double x);
|
|
double sinh(double x);
|
|
double tanh(double x);
|
|
double exp(double x);
|
|
double frexp(double value, int *exp);
|
|
double ldexp(double x, int exp);
|
|
double log(double x);
|
|
double log10(double x);
|
|
double modf(double value, double *iptr);
|
|
double pow(double x, double y);
|
|
double sqrt(double x);
|
|
double ceil(double x);
|
|
double fabs(double x);
|
|
double floor(double x);
|
|
double fmod(double x, double y);
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.3.7 NON-LOCAL JUMPS <setjmp.h>
|
|
|
|
jmp_buf
|
|
int setjmp(jmp_buf env);
|
|
void longjmp(jmp_buf env, int val);
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.3.8 SIGNAL HANDLING <signal.h>
|
|
|
|
sig_atomic_t
|
|
SIG_DFL
|
|
SIG_ERR
|
|
SIG_IGN
|
|
SIGABRT
|
|
SIGFPE
|
|
SIGILL
|
|
SIGINT
|
|
SIGSEGV
|
|
SIGTERM
|
|
void (*signal(int sig, void (*func)(int)))(int);
|
|
int raise(int sig);
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.3.9 VARIABLE ARGUMENTS <stdarg.h>
|
|
|
|
va_list
|
|
void va_start(va_list ap, parmN);
|
|
type va_arg(va_list ap, type);
|
|
void va_end(va_list ap);
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.3.10 INPUT/OUTPUT <stdio.h>
|
|
|
|
_IOFBF
|
|
_IOLBF
|
|
_IONBF
|
|
BUFSIZ
|
|
EOF
|
|
FILE
|
|
FILENAME_MAX
|
|
FOPEN_MAX
|
|
fpos_t
|
|
L_tmpnam
|
|
NULL
|
|
SEEK_CUR
|
|
SEEK_END
|
|
SEEK_SET
|
|
size_t
|
|
stderr
|
|
stdin
|
|
stdout
|
|
TMP_MAX
|
|
int remove(const char *filename);
|
|
int rename(const char *old, const char *new);
|
|
FILE *tmpfile(void);
|
|
char *tmpnam(char *s);
|
|
int fclose(FILE *stream);
|
|
int fflush(FILE *stream);
|
|
FILE *fopen(const char *filename, const char *mode);
|
|
FILE *freopen(const char *filename, const char *mode,
|
|
FILE *stream);
|
|
void setbuf(FILE *stream, char *buf);
|
|
int setvbuf(FILE *stream, char *buf, int mode, size_t size);
|
|
int fprintf(FILE *stream, const char *format, ...);
|
|
int fscanf(FILE *stream, const char *format, ...);
|
|
int printf(const char *format, ...);
|
|
int scanf(const char *format, ...);
|
|
int sprintf(char *s, const char *format, ...);
|
|
int sscanf(const char *s, const char *format, ...);
|
|
int vfprintf(FILE *stream, const char *format, va_list arg);
|
|
int vprintf(const char *format, va_list arg);
|
|
int vsprintf(char *s, const char *format, va_list arg);
|
|
int fgetc(FILE *stream);
|
|
char *fgets(char *s, int n, FILE *stream);
|
|
int fputc(int c, FILE *stream);
|
|
int fputs(const char *s, FILE *stream);
|
|
int getc(FILE *stream);
|
|
int getchar(void);
|
|
char *gets(char *s);
|
|
int putc(int c, FILE *stream);
|
|
int putchar(int c);
|
|
int puts(const char *s);
|
|
int ungetc(int c, FILE *stream);
|
|
size_t fread(void *ptr, size_t size, size_t nmemb,
|
|
FILE *stream);
|
|
size_t fwrite(const void *ptr, size_t size, size_t nmemb,
|
|
FILE *stream);
|
|
int fgetpos(FILE *stream, fpos_t *pos);
|
|
int fseek(FILE *stream, long int offset, int whence);
|
|
int fsetpos(FILE *stream, const fpos_t *pos);
|
|
long int ftell(FILE *stream);
|
|
void rewind(FILE *stream);
|
|
void clearerr(FILE *stream);
|
|
int feof(FILE *stream);
|
|
int ferror(FILE *stream);
|
|
void perror(const char *s);
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.3.11 GENERAL UTILITIES <stdlib.h>
|
|
|
|
EXIT_FAILURE
|
|
EXIT_SUCCESS
|
|
MB_CUR_MAX
|
|
NULL
|
|
RAND_MAX
|
|
div_t
|
|
ldiv_t
|
|
size_t
|
|
wchar_t
|
|
double atof(const char *nptr);
|
|
int atoi(const char *nptr);
|
|
long int atol(const char *nptr);
|
|
double strtod(const char *nptr, char **endptr);
|
|
long int strtol(const char *nptr, char **endptr, int base);
|
|
unsigned long int strtoul(const char *nptr, char **endptr,
|
|
int base);
|
|
int rand(void);
|
|
void srand(unsigned int seed);
|
|
void *calloc(size_t nmemb, size_t size);
|
|
void free(void *ptr);
|
|
void *malloc(size_t size);
|
|
void *realloc(void *ptr, size_t size);
|
|
void abort(void);
|
|
int atexit(void (*func)(void));
|
|
void exit(int status);
|
|
char *getenv(const char *name);
|
|
int system(const char *string);
|
|
void *bsearch(const void *key, const void *base,
|
|
size_t nmemb, size_t size,
|
|
int (*compar)(const void *, const void *));
|
|
void qsort(void *base, size_t nmemb, size_t size,
|
|
int (*compar)(const void *, const void *));
|
|
int abs(int j);
|
|
div_t div(int numer, int denom);
|
|
long int labs(long int j);
|
|
ldiv_t ldiv(long int numer, long int denom);
|
|
int mblen(const char *s, size_t n);
|
|
int mbtowc(wchar_t *pwc, const char *s, size_t n);
|
|
int wctomb(char *s, wchar_t wchar);
|
|
size_t mbstowcs(wchar_t *pwcs, const char *s, size_t n);
|
|
size_t wcstombs(char *s, const wchar_t *pwcs, size_t n);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.3.12 STRING HANDLING <string.h>
|
|
|
|
NULL
|
|
size_t
|
|
void *memcpy(void *s1, const void *s2, size_t n);
|
|
void *memmove(void *s1, const void *s2, size_t n);
|
|
char *strcpy(char *s1, const char *s2);
|
|
char *strncpy(char *s1, const char *s2, size_t n);
|
|
char *strcat(char *s1, const char *s2);
|
|
char *strncat(char *s1, const char *s2, size_t n);
|
|
int memcmp(const void *s1, const void *s2, size_t n);
|
|
int strcmp(const char *s1, const char *s2);
|
|
int strcoll(const char *s1, const char *s2);
|
|
int strncmp(const char *s1, const char *s2, size_t n);
|
|
size_t strxfrm(char *s1, const char *s2, size_t n);
|
|
void *memchr(const void *s, int c, size_t n);
|
|
char *strchr(const char *s, int c);
|
|
size_t strcspn(const char *s1, const char *s2);
|
|
char *strpbrk(const char *s1, const char *s2);
|
|
char *strrchr(const char *s, int c);
|
|
size_t strspn(const char *s1, const char *s2);
|
|
char *strstr(const char *s1, const char *s2);
|
|
char *strtok(char *s1, const char *s2);
|
|
void *memset(void *s, int c, size_t n);
|
|
char *strerror(int errnum);
|
|
size_t strlen(const char *s);
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.3.13 DATE AND TIME <time.h>
|
|
|
|
CLK_TCK
|
|
NULL
|
|
clock_t
|
|
time_t
|
|
size_t
|
|
struct tm
|
|
clock_t clock(void);
|
|
double difftime(time_t time1, time_t time0);
|
|
time_t mktime(struct tm *timeptr);
|
|
time_t time(time_t *timer);
|
|
char *asctime(const struct tm *timeptr);
|
|
char *ctime(const time_t *timer);
|
|
struct tm *gmtime(const time_t *timer);
|
|
struct tm *localtime(const time_t *timer);
|
|
size_t strftime(char *s, size_t maxsize,
|
|
const char *format, const struct tm *timeptr);
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.4 IMPLEMENTATION LIMITS
|
|
|
|
The contents of a header <limits.h> are given below, in alphabetic
|
|
order. The minimum magnitudes shown shall be replaced by
|
|
implementation-defined magnitudes with the same sign. The values
|
|
shall all be constant expressions suitable for use in #if
|
|
preprocessing directives. The components are described further in
|
|
$2.2.4.2.
|
|
|
|
#define CHAR_BIT 8
|
|
#define CHAR_MAX UCHAR_MAX or SCHAR_MAX
|
|
#define CHAR_MIN 0 or SCHAR_MIN
|
|
#define MB_LEN_MAX 1
|
|
#define INT_MAX +32767
|
|
#define INT_MIN -32767
|
|
#define LONG_MAX +2147483647
|
|
#define LONG_MIN -2147483647
|
|
#define SCHAR_MAX +127
|
|
#define SCHAR_MIN -127
|
|
#define SHRT_MAX +32767
|
|
#define SHRT_MIN -32767
|
|
#define UCHAR_MAX 255
|
|
#define UINT_MAX 65535
|
|
#define ULONG_MAX 4294967295
|
|
#define USHRT_MAX 65535
|
|
|
|
|
|
The contents of a header <float.h> are given below, in alphabetic
|
|
order. The value of FLT_RADIX shall be a constant expression suitable
|
|
for use in #if preprocessing directives. Values that need not be
|
|
constant expressions shall be supplied for all other components. The
|
|
minimum magnitudes shown for integers and exponents shall be replaced
|
|
by implementation-defined magnitudes with the same sign. The
|
|
components are described further in $2.2.4.2.
|
|
|
|
#define DBL_DIG 10
|
|
#define DBL_EPSILON 1E-9
|
|
#define DBL_MANT_DIG
|
|
#define DBL_MAX 1E+37
|
|
#define DBL_MAX_10_EXP +37
|
|
#define DBL_MAX_EXP
|
|
#define DBL_MIN 1E-37
|
|
#define DBL_MIN_10_EXP -37
|
|
#define DBL_MIN_EXP
|
|
#define FLT_DIG 6
|
|
#define FLT_EPSILON 1E-5
|
|
#define FLT_MANT_DIG
|
|
#define FLT_MAX 1E+37
|
|
#define FLT_MAX_10_EXP +37
|
|
#define FLT_MAX_EXP
|
|
#define FLT_MIN 1E-37
|
|
#define FLT_MIN_10_EXP -37
|
|
#define FLT_MIN_EXP
|
|
#define FLT_RADIX 2
|
|
#define FLT_ROUNDS
|
|
#define LDBL_DIG 10
|
|
#define LDBL_EPSILON 1E-9
|
|
#define LDBL_MANT_DIG
|
|
#define LDBL_MAX 1E+37
|
|
#define LDBL_MAX_10_EXP +37
|
|
#define LDBL_MAX_EXP
|
|
#define LDBL_MIN 1E-37
|
|
#define LDBL_MIN_10_EXP -37
|
|
#define LDBL_MIN_EXP
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.5 COMMON WARNINGS
|
|
|
|
An implementation may generate warnings in many situations, none of
|
|
which is specified as part of the Standard. The following are a few
|
|
of the more common situations.
|
|
|
|
* A block with initialization of an object that has automatic storage
|
|
duration is jumped into ($3.1.2.4).
|
|
|
|
* An integer character constant includes more than one character or a
|
|
wide character constant includes more than one multibyte character
|
|
($3.1.3.4).
|
|
|
|
* The characters /* are found in a comment ($3.1.7).
|
|
|
|
* An implicit narrowing conversion is encountered, such as the
|
|
assignment of a long int or a double to an int , or a pointer to void
|
|
to a pointer to any type of object other than char ($3.2).
|
|
|
|
* An ``unordered'' binary operator (not comma, && or || ) contains a
|
|
side-effect to an lvalue in one operand, and a side-effect to, or an
|
|
access to the value of, the identical lvalue in the other operand
|
|
($3.3).
|
|
|
|
* A function is called but no prototype has been supplied ($3.3.2.2).
|
|
|
|
* The arguments in a function call do not agree in number and type
|
|
with those of the parameters in a function definition that is not a
|
|
prototype ($3.3.2.2).
|
|
|
|
* An object is defined but not used ($3.5).
|
|
|
|
* A value is given to an object of an enumeration type other than by
|
|
assignment of an enumeration constant that is a member of that type,
|
|
or an enumeration variable that has the same type, or the value of a
|
|
function that returns the same enumeration type ($3.5.2.2).
|
|
|
|
* An aggregate has a partly bracketed initialization ($3.5.7).
|
|
|
|
* A statement cannot be reached ($3.6).
|
|
|
|
* A statement with no apparent effect is encountered ($3.6).
|
|
|
|
* A constant expression is used as the controlling expression of a
|
|
selection statement ($3.6.4).
|
|
|
|
* A function has return statements with and without expressions ($3.6.6.4).
|
|
|
|
* An incorrectly formed preprocessing group is encountered while
|
|
skipping a preprocessing group ($3.8.1).
|
|
|
|
* An unrecognized #pragma directive is encountered ($3.8.6).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6 PORTABILITY ISSUES
|
|
|
|
This appendix collects some information about portability that
|
|
appears in the Standard.
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.1 Unspecified behavior
|
|
|
|
The following are unspecified:
|
|
|
|
* The manner and timing of static initialization ($2.1.2).
|
|
|
|
* The behavior if a printable character is written when the active
|
|
position is at the final position of a line ($2.2.2).
|
|
|
|
* The behavior if a backspace character is written when the active
|
|
position is at the initial position of a line ($2.2.2).
|
|
|
|
* The behavior if a horizontal tab character is written when the
|
|
active position is at or past the last defined horizontal tabulation
|
|
position ($2.2.2).
|
|
|
|
* The behavior if a vertical tab character is written when the active
|
|
position is at or past the last defined vertical tabulation position
|
|
($2.2.2).
|
|
|
|
* The representations of floating types ($3.1.2.5).
|
|
|
|
* The order in which expressions are evaluated --- in any order
|
|
conforming to the precedence rules, even in the presence of
|
|
parentheses ($3.3).
|
|
|
|
* The order in which side effects take place ($3.3).
|
|
|
|
* The order in which the function designator and the arguments in a
|
|
function call are evaluated ($3.3.2.2).
|
|
|
|
* The alignment of the addressable storage unit allocated to hold a
|
|
bit-field ($3.5.2.1).
|
|
|
|
* The layout of storage for parameters ($3.7.1).
|
|
|
|
* The order in which # and ## operations are evaluated during macro
|
|
substitution ($3.8.3.3).
|
|
|
|
* Whether errno is a macro or an external identifier ($4.1.3).
|
|
|
|
* Whether setjmp is a macro or an external identifier ($4.6.1.1).
|
|
|
|
* Whether va_end is a macro or an external identifier ($4.8.1.3).
|
|
|
|
* The value of the file position indicator after a successful call to
|
|
the ungetc function for a text stream, until all pushed-back
|
|
characters are read or discarded ($4.9.7.11).
|
|
|
|
* The details of the value stored by the fgetpos function on success
|
|
($4.9.9.1).
|
|
|
|
* The details of the value returned by the ftell function for a text
|
|
stream on success ($4.9.9.4).
|
|
|
|
* The order and contiguity of storage allocated by the calloc ,
|
|
malloc , and realloc functions ($4.10.3).
|
|
|
|
* Which of two members that compare as equal is returned by the
|
|
bsearch function ($4.10.5.1).
|
|
|
|
* The order in an array sorted by the qsort function of two members
|
|
that compare as equal ($4.10.5.2).
|
|
|
|
* The encoding of the calendar time returned by the time function
|
|
($4.12.2.3).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.2 Undefined behavior
|
|
|
|
The behavior in the following circumstances is undefined:
|
|
|
|
* A nonempty source file does not end in a new-line character, ends
|
|
in new-line character immediately preceded by a backslash character,
|
|
or ends in a partial preprocessing token or comment ($2.1.1.2).
|
|
|
|
* A character not in the required character set is encountered in a
|
|
source file, except in a preprocessing token that is never converted
|
|
to a token, a character constant, a string literal, or a comment
|
|
($2.2.1).
|
|
|
|
* A comment, string literal, character constant, or header name
|
|
contains an invalid multibyte character or does not begin and end in
|
|
the initial shift state ($2.2.1.2).
|
|
|
|
* An unmatched ' or character is encountered on a logical source line
|
|
during tokenization ($3.1).
|
|
|
|
* The same identifier is used more than once as a label in the same
|
|
function ($3.1.2.1).
|
|
|
|
* An identifier is used that is not visible in the current scope ($3.1.2.1).
|
|
|
|
* Identifiers that are intended to denote the same entity differ in a
|
|
character beyond the minimal significant characters ($3.1.2).
|
|
|
|
* The same identifier has both internal and external linkage in the
|
|
same translation unit ($3.1.2.2).
|
|
|
|
* An identifier with external linkage is used but there does not
|
|
exist exactly one external definition in the program for the
|
|
identifier ($3.1.2.2).
|
|
|
|
* The value stored in a pointer that referred to an object with
|
|
automatic storage duration is used ($3.1.2.4).
|
|
|
|
* Two declarations of the same object or function specify types that
|
|
are not compatible ($3.1.2.6).
|
|
|
|
* An unspecified escape sequence is encountered in a character
|
|
constant or a string literal ($3.1.3.4).
|
|
|
|
* An attempt is made to modify a string literal of either form ($3.1.4).
|
|
|
|
* A character string literal token is adjacent to a wide string
|
|
literal token ($3.1.4).
|
|
|
|
* The characters ', \ , , or /* are encountered between the < and >
|
|
delimiters or the characters ', \ , or /* are encountered between the
|
|
delimiters in the two forms of a header name preprocessing token
|
|
($3.1.7).
|
|
|
|
* An arithmetic conversion produces a result that cannot be
|
|
represented in the space provided ($3.2.1).
|
|
|
|
* An lvalue with an incomplete type is used in a context that
|
|
requires the value of the designated object ($3.2.2.1).
|
|
|
|
* The value of a void expression is used or an implicit conversion
|
|
(except to void ) is applied to a void expression ($3.2.2.2).
|
|
|
|
* An object is modified more than once, or is modified and accessed
|
|
other than to determine the new value, between two sequence points
|
|
($3.3).
|
|
|
|
* An arithmetic operation is invalid (such as division or modulus by 0)
|
|
or produces a result that cannot be represented in the space
|
|
provided (such as overflow or underflow) ($3.3).
|
|
|
|
* An object has its stored value accessed by an lvalue that does not
|
|
have one of the following types: the declared type of the object, a
|
|
qualified version of the declared type of the object, the signed or
|
|
unsigned type corresponding to the declared type of the object, the
|
|
signed or unsigned type corresponding to a qualified version of the
|
|
declared type of the object, an aggregate or union type that
|
|
(recursively) includes one of the aforementioned types among its
|
|
members, or a character type ($3.3).
|
|
|
|
* An argument to a function is a void expression ($3.3.2.2).
|
|
|
|
* For a function call without a function prototype, the number of
|
|
arguments does not agree with the number of parameters ($3.3.2.2).
|
|
|
|
* For a function call without a function prototype, if the function
|
|
is defined without a function prototype, and the types of the
|
|
arguments after promotion do not agree with those of the parameters
|
|
after promotion ($3.3.2.2).
|
|
|
|
* If a function is called with a function prototype and the function
|
|
is not defined with a compatible type ($3.3.2.2).
|
|
|
|
* A function that accepts a variable number of arguments is called
|
|
without a function prototype that ends with an ellipsis ($3.3.2.2).
|
|
|
|
* An invalid array reference, null pointer reference, or reference to
|
|
an object declared with automatic storage duration in a terminated
|
|
block occurs ($3.3.3.2).
|
|
|
|
* A pointer to a function is converted to point to a function of a
|
|
different type and used to call a function of a type not compatible
|
|
with the original type ($3.3.4).
|
|
|
|
* A pointer to a function is converted to a pointer to an object or a
|
|
pointer to an object is converted to a pointer to a function ($3.3.4).
|
|
|
|
* A pointer is converted to other than an integral or pointer type ($3.3.4).
|
|
|
|
* A pointer that is not to a member of an array object is added to or
|
|
subtracted from ($3.3.6).
|
|
|
|
* Pointers that are not to the same array object are subtracted ($3.3.6).
|
|
|
|
* An expression is shifted by a negative number or by an amount
|
|
greater than or equal to the width in bits of the expression being
|
|
shifted ($3.3.7).
|
|
|
|
* Pointers are compared using a relational operator that do not point
|
|
to the same aggregate or union ($3.3.8).
|
|
|
|
* An object is assigned to an overlapping object ($3.3.16.1).
|
|
|
|
* An identifier for an object is declared with no linkage and the
|
|
type of the object is incomplete after its declarator, or after its
|
|
init-declarator if it has an initializer ($3.5).
|
|
|
|
* A function is declared at block scope with a storage-class
|
|
specifier other than extern ($3.5.1).
|
|
|
|
* A bit-field is declared with a type other than int , signed int ,
|
|
or unsigned int ($3.5.2.1).
|
|
|
|
* An attempt is made to modify an object with const-qualified type by
|
|
means of an lvalue with non-const-qualified type ($3.5.3).
|
|
|
|
* An attempt is made to refer to an object with volatile-qualified
|
|
type by means of an lvalue with non-volatile-qualified type ($3.5.3).
|
|
|
|
* The value of an uninitialized object that has automatic storage
|
|
duration is used before a value is assigned ($3.5.7).
|
|
|
|
* An object with aggregate or union type with static storage duration
|
|
has a non-brace-enclosed initializer, or an object with aggregate or
|
|
union type with automatic storage duration has either a single
|
|
expression initializer with a type other than that of the object or a
|
|
non-brace-enclosed initializer ($3.5.7).
|
|
|
|
* The value of a function is used, but no value was returned ($3.6.6.4).
|
|
|
|
* A function that accepts a variable number of arguments is defined
|
|
without a parameter type list that ends with the ellipsis notation
|
|
($3.7.1).
|
|
|
|
* An identifier for an object with internal linkage and an incomplete
|
|
type is declared with a tentative definition ($3.7.2).
|
|
|
|
* The token defined is generated during the expansion of a #if or
|
|
#elif preprocessing directive ($3.8.1).
|
|
|
|
* The #include preprocessing directive that results after expansion
|
|
does not match one of the two header name forms ($3.8.2).
|
|
|
|
* A macro argument consists of no preprocessing tokens ($3.8.3).
|
|
|
|
* There are sequences of preprocessing tokens within the list of
|
|
macro arguments that would otherwise act as preprocessing directive
|
|
lines ($3.8.3).
|
|
|
|
* The result of the preprocessing concatenation operator ## is not a
|
|
valid preprocessing token ($3.8.3).
|
|
|
|
* The #line preprocessing directive that results after expansion does
|
|
not match one of the two well-defined forms ($3.8.4).
|
|
|
|
* One of the following identifiers is the subject of a #define or
|
|
#undef preprocessing directive: defined , __LINE__ , __FILE__ ,
|
|
__DATE__ , __TIME__ , or __STDC__ ($3.8.8).
|
|
|
|
* An attempt is made to copy an object to an overlapping object by
|
|
use of a library function other than memmove ($4.).
|
|
|
|
* The effect if the program redefines a reserved external identifier
|
|
($4.1.2).
|
|
|
|
* The effect if a standard header is included within an external
|
|
definition; is included for the first time after the first reference
|
|
to any of the functions or objects it declares, or to any of the types
|
|
or macros it defines; or is included while a macro is defined with a
|
|
name the same as a keyword ($4.1.2).
|
|
|
|
* A macro definition of errno is suppressed to obtain access to an
|
|
actual object ($4.1.3).
|
|
|
|
* The parameter member-designator of an offsetof macro is an invalid
|
|
right operand of the . operator for the type parameter or designates
|
|
bit-field member of a structure ($4.1.5).
|
|
|
|
* A library function argument has an invalid value, unless the
|
|
behavior is specified explicitly ($4.1.6).
|
|
|
|
* A library function that accepts a variable number of arguments is
|
|
not declared ($4.1.6).
|
|
|
|
* The macro definition of assert is suppressed to obtain access to an
|
|
actual function ($4.2).
|
|
|
|
* The argument to a character handling function is out of the domain ($4.3).
|
|
|
|
* A macro definition of setjmp is suppressed to obtain access to an
|
|
actual function ($4.6).
|
|
|
|
* An invocation of the setjmp macro occurs in a context other than as
|
|
the controlling expression in a selection or iteration statement, or
|
|
in a comparison with an integral constant expression (possibly as
|
|
implied by the unary ! operator) as the controlling expression of a
|
|
selection or iteration statement, or as an expression statement
|
|
(possibly cast to void ) ($4.6.1.1).
|
|
|
|
* An object of automatic storage class that does not have
|
|
volatile-qualified type has been changed between a setjmp invocation
|
|
and a longjmp call and then has its value accessed ($4.6.2.1).
|
|
|
|
* The longjmp function is invoked from a nested signal routine ($4.6.2.1).
|
|
|
|
* A signal occurs other than as the result of calling the abort or
|
|
raise function, and the signal handler calls any function in the
|
|
standard library other than the signal function itself or refers to
|
|
any object with static storage duration other than by assigning a
|
|
value to a static storage duration variable of type volatile
|
|
sig_atomic_t ($4.7.1.1).
|
|
|
|
* The value of errno is referred to after a signal occurs other than
|
|
as the result of calling the abort or raise function and the
|
|
corresponding signal handler calls the signal function such that it
|
|
returns the value SIG_ERR ($4.7.1.1).
|
|
|
|
* The macro va_arg is invoked with the parameter ap that was passed
|
|
to a function that invoked the macro va_arg with the same parameter
|
|
($4.8).
|
|
|
|
* A macro definition of va_start , va_arg , or va_end or a
|
|
combination thereof is suppressed to obtain access to an actual
|
|
function ($4.8.1).
|
|
|
|
* The parameter parmN of a va_start macro is declared with the
|
|
register storage class, or with a function or array type, or with a
|
|
type that is not compatible with the type that results after
|
|
application of the default argument promotions ($4.8.1.1).
|
|
|
|
* There is no actual next argument for a va_arg macro invocation
|
|
($4.8.1.2).
|
|
|
|
* The type of the actual next argument in a variable argument list
|
|
disagrees with the type specified by the va_arg macro ($4.8.1.2).
|
|
|
|
* The va_end macro is invoked without a corresponding invocation of
|
|
the va_start macro ($4.8.1.3).
|
|
|
|
* A return occurs from a function with a variable argument list
|
|
initialized by the va_start macro before the va_end macro is invoked
|
|
($4.8.1.3).
|
|
|
|
* The stream for the fflush function points to an input stream or to
|
|
an update stream in which the most recent operation was input
|
|
($4.9.5.2).
|
|
|
|
* An output operation on an update stream is followed by an input
|
|
operation without an intervening call to the fflush function or a file
|
|
positioning function, or an input operation on an update stream is
|
|
followed by an output operation without an intervening call to a file
|
|
positioning function ($4.9.5.3).
|
|
|
|
* The format for the fprintf or fscanf function does not match the
|
|
argument list ($4.9.6).
|
|
|
|
* An invalid conversion specification is found in the format for the
|
|
fprintf or fscanf function ($4.9.6).
|
|
|
|
* A %% conversion specification for the fprintf or fscanf function
|
|
contains characters between the pair of % characters ($4.9.6).
|
|
|
|
* A conversion specification for the fprintf function contains an h
|
|
or l with a conversion specifier other than d , i , n , o , u , x , or
|
|
X , or an L with a conversion specifier other than e , E , f , g , or
|
|
G ($4.9.6.1).
|
|
|
|
* A conversion specification for the fprintf function contains a #
|
|
flag with a conversion specifier other than o , x , X , e , E , f , g,
|
|
or G ($4.9.6.1).
|
|
|
|
* A conversion specification for the fprintf function contains a 0
|
|
flag with a conversion specifier other than d , i , o , u , x , X , e,
|
|
E , f , g , or G ($4.9.6.1).
|
|
|
|
* An aggregate or union, or a pointer to an aggregate or union is an
|
|
argument to the fprintf function, except for the conversion specifiers
|
|
%s (for an array of character type) or %p (for a pointer to void )
|
|
($4.9.6.1).
|
|
|
|
* A single conversion by the fprintf function produces more than 509
|
|
characters of output ($4.9.6.1).
|
|
|
|
* A conversion specification for the fscanf function contains an h or
|
|
l with a conversion specifier other than d , i , n , o , u , or x , or
|
|
an L with a conversion specifier other than e , f , or g ($4.9.6.2).
|
|
|
|
* A pointer value printed by %p conversion by the fprintf function
|
|
during a previous program execution is the argument for %p conversion
|
|
by the fscanf function ($4.9.6.2).
|
|
|
|
* The result of a conversion by the fscanf function cannot be
|
|
represented in the space provided, or the receiving object does not
|
|
have an appropriate type ($4.9.6.2).
|
|
|
|
* The result of converting a string to a number by the atof , atoi ,
|
|
or atol function cannot be represented ($4.10.1).
|
|
|
|
* The value of a pointer that refers to space deallocated by a call
|
|
to the free or realloc function is referred to ($4.10.3).
|
|
|
|
* The pointer argument to the free or realloc function does not match
|
|
a pointer earlier returned by calloc , malloc , or realloc , or the
|
|
object pointed to has been deallocated by a call to free or realloc
|
|
($4.10.3).
|
|
|
|
* A program executes more than one call to the exit function ($4.10.4.3).
|
|
|
|
* The result of an integer arithmetic function ( abs , div , labs ,
|
|
or ldiv ) cannot be represented ($4.10.6).
|
|
|
|
* The shift states for the mblen , mbtowc , and wctomb functions are
|
|
not explicitly reset to the initial state when the LC_CTYPE category
|
|
of the current locale is changed ($4.10.7).
|
|
|
|
* An array written to by a copying or concatenation function is too
|
|
small ($4.11.2, $4.11.3).
|
|
|
|
* An invalid conversion specification is found in the format for the
|
|
strftime function ($4.12.3.5).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.3 Implementation-defined behavior
|
|
|
|
Each implementation shall document its behavior in each of the
|
|
areas listed in this section. The following are
|
|
implementation-defined:
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.3.1 Environment
|
|
|
|
* The semantics of the arguments to main ($2.1.2.2).
|
|
|
|
* What constitutes an interactive device ($2.1.2.3).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.3.2 Identifiers
|
|
|
|
* The number of significant initial characters (beyond 31) in an
|
|
identifier without external linkage ($3.1.2).
|
|
|
|
* The number of significant initial characters (beyond 6) in an
|
|
identifier with external linkage ($3.1.2).
|
|
|
|
* Whether case distinctions are significant in an identifier with
|
|
external linkage ($3.1.2).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.3.3 Characters
|
|
|
|
* The members of the source and execution character sets, except as
|
|
explicitly specified in the Standard ($2.2.1).
|
|
|
|
* The shift states used for the encoding of multibyte characters $2.2.1.2).
|
|
|
|
* The number of bits in a character in the execution character set
|
|
($2.2.4.2).
|
|
|
|
* The mapping of members of the source character set (in character
|
|
constants and string literals) to members of the execution character
|
|
set ($3.1.3.4).
|
|
|
|
* The value of an integer character constant that contains a
|
|
character or escape sequence not represented in the basic execution
|
|
character set or the extended character set for a wide character
|
|
constant ($3.1.3.4).
|
|
|
|
* The value of an integer character constant that contains more than
|
|
one character or a wide character constant that contains more than one
|
|
multibyte character ($3.1.3.4).
|
|
|
|
* The current locale used to convert multibyte characters into
|
|
corresponding wide characters (codes) for a wide character constant
|
|
($3.1.3.4).
|
|
|
|
* Whether a ``plain'' char has the same range of values as signed
|
|
char or unsigned char ($3.2.1.1).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.3.4 Integers
|
|
|
|
* The representations and sets of values of the various types of
|
|
integers ($3.1.2.5).
|
|
|
|
* The result of converting an integer to a shorter signed integer, or
|
|
the result of converting an unsigned integer to a signed integer of
|
|
equal length, if the value cannot be represented ($3.2.1.2).
|
|
|
|
* The results of bitwise operations on signed integers ($3.3).
|
|
|
|
* The sign of the remainder on integer division ($3.3.5).
|
|
|
|
* The result of a right shift of a negative-valued signed integral
|
|
type ($3.3.7).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.3.5 Floating point
|
|
|
|
* The representations and sets of values of the various types of
|
|
floating-point numbers ($3.1.2.5).
|
|
|
|
* The direction of truncation when an integral number is converted to
|
|
a floating-point number that cannot exactly represent the original
|
|
value ($3.2.1.3).
|
|
|
|
* The direction of truncation or rounding when a floating-point
|
|
number is converted to a narrower floating-point number ($3.2.1.4).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.3.6 Arrays and pointers
|
|
|
|
* The type of integer required to hold the maximum size of an array
|
|
--- that is, the type of the sizeof operator, size_t ($3.3.3.4,
|
|
$4.1.1).
|
|
|
|
* The result of casting a pointer to an integer or vice versa ($3.3.4).
|
|
|
|
* The type of integer required to hold the difference between two
|
|
pointers to members of the same array, ptrdiff_t ($3.3.6, $4.1.1).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.3.7 Registers
|
|
|
|
* The extent to which objects can actually be placed in registers by
|
|
use of the register storage-class specifier ($3.5.1).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.3.8 Structures, unions, enumerations, and bit-fields
|
|
|
|
* A member of a union object is accessed using a member of a
|
|
different type ($3.3.2.3).
|
|
|
|
* The padding and alignment of members of structures ($3.5.2.1).
|
|
This should present no problem unless binary data written by one
|
|
implementation are read by another.
|
|
|
|
* Whether a ``plain'' int bit-field is treated as a signed int
|
|
bit-field or as an unsigned int bit-field ($3.5.2.1).
|
|
|
|
* The order of allocation of bit-fields within an int ($3.5.2.1).
|
|
|
|
* Whether a bit-field can straddle a storage-unit boundary ($3.5.2.1).
|
|
|
|
* The integer type chosen to represent the values of an enumeration
|
|
type ($3.5.2.2).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.3.9 Qualifiers
|
|
|
|
* What constitutes an access to an object that has volatile-qualified
|
|
type ($3.5.5.3).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.3.10 Declarators
|
|
|
|
* The maximum number of declarators that may modify an arithmetic,
|
|
structure, or union type ($3.5.4).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.3.11 Statements
|
|
|
|
* The maximum number of case values in a switch statement ($3.6.4.2).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.3.12 Preprocessing directives
|
|
|
|
* Whether the value of a single-character character constant in a
|
|
constant expression that controls conditional inclusion matches the
|
|
value of the same character constant in the execution character set.
|
|
Whether such a character constant may have a negative value ($3.8.1).
|
|
|
|
* The method for locating includable source files ($3.8.2).
|
|
|
|
* The support of quoted names for includable source files ($3.8.2).
|
|
|
|
* The mapping of source file character sequences ($3.8.2).
|
|
|
|
* The behavior on each recognized #pragma directive ($3.8.6).
|
|
|
|
* The definitions for __DATE__ and __TIME__ when respectively, the
|
|
date and time of translation are not available ($3.8.8).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.3.13 Library functions
|
|
|
|
* The null pointer constant to which the macro NULL expands ($4.1.5).
|
|
|
|
* The diagnostic printed by and the termination behavior of the
|
|
assert function ($4.2).
|
|
|
|
* The sets of characters tested for by the isalnum , isalpha ,
|
|
iscntrl , islower , isprint , and isupper functions ($4.3.1).
|
|
|
|
* The values returned by the mathematics functions on domain errors
|
|
($4.5.1).
|
|
|
|
* Whether the mathematics functions set the integer expression errno
|
|
to the value of the macro ERANGE on underflow range errors ($4.5.1).
|
|
|
|
* Whether a domain error occurs or zero is returned when the fmod
|
|
function has a second argument of zero ($4.5.6.4).
|
|
|
|
* The set of signals for the signal function ($4.7.1.1).
|
|
|
|
* The semantics for each signal recognized by the signal function
|
|
($4.7.1.1).
|
|
|
|
* The default handling and the handling at program startup for each
|
|
signal recognized by the signal function ($4.7.1.1).
|
|
|
|
* If the equivalent of signal(sig, SIG_DFL); is not executed prior to
|
|
the call of a signal handler, the blocking of the signal that is
|
|
performed ($4.7.1.1).
|
|
|
|
* Whether the default handling is reset if the SIGILL signal is
|
|
received by a handler specified to the signal function ($4.7.1.1).
|
|
|
|
* Whether the last line of a text stream requires a terminating
|
|
new-line character ($4.9.2).
|
|
|
|
* Whether space characters that are written out to a text stream
|
|
immediately before a new-line character appear when read in ($4.9.2).
|
|
|
|
* The number of null characters that may be appended to data written
|
|
to a binary stream ($4.9.2).
|
|
|
|
* Whether the file position indicator of an append mode stream is
|
|
initially positioned at the beginning or end of the file ($4.9.3).
|
|
|
|
* Whether a write on a text stream causes the associated file to be
|
|
truncated beyond that point ($4.9.3).
|
|
|
|
* The characteristics of file buffering ($4.9.3).
|
|
|
|
* Whether a zero-length file actually exists ($4.9.3).
|
|
|
|
* The rules for composing valid file names ($4.9.3).
|
|
|
|
* Whether the same file can be open multiple times ($4.9.3).
|
|
|
|
* The effect of the remove function on an open file ($4.9.4.1).
|
|
|
|
* The effect if a file with the new name exists prior to a call to
|
|
the rename function ($4.9.4.2).
|
|
|
|
* The output for %p conversion in the fprintf function ($4.9.6.1).
|
|
|
|
* The input for %p conversion in the fscanf function ($4.9.6.2).
|
|
|
|
* The interpretation of a - character that is neither the first nor
|
|
the last character in the scanlist for %[ conversion in the fscanf
|
|
function ($4.9.6.2).
|
|
|
|
* The value to which the macro errno is set by the fgetpos or ftell
|
|
function on failure ($4.9.9.1, $4.9.9.4).
|
|
|
|
* The messages generated by the perror function ($4.9.10.4).
|
|
|
|
* The behavior of the calloc , malloc , or realloc function if the
|
|
size requested is zero ($4.10.3).
|
|
|
|
* The behavior of the abort function with regard to open and
|
|
temporary files ($4.10.4.1).
|
|
|
|
* The status returned by the exit function if the value of the
|
|
argument is other than zero, EXIT_SUCCESS , or EXIT_FAILURE
|
|
($4.10.4.3).
|
|
|
|
* The set of environment names and the method for altering the
|
|
environment list used by the getenv function ($4.10.4.4).
|
|
|
|
* The contents and mode of execution of the string by the system
|
|
function ($4.10.4.5).
|
|
|
|
* The contents of the error message strings returned by the strerror
|
|
function ($4.11.6.2).
|
|
|
|
* The local time zone and Daylight Saving Time ($4.12.1).
|
|
|
|
* The era for the clock function ($4.12.2.1).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.4 Locale-specific Behavior
|
|
|
|
The following characteristics of a hosted environment are locale-specific:
|
|
|
|
* The content of the execution character set, in addition to the
|
|
required members ($2.2.1).
|
|
|
|
* The direction of printing ($2.2.2).
|
|
|
|
* The decimal-point character ($4.1.1).
|
|
|
|
* The implementation-defined aspects of character testing and case
|
|
mapping functions ($4.3).
|
|
|
|
* The collation sequence of the execution character set ($4.11.4.4).
|
|
|
|
* The formats for time and date ($4.12.3.5).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.5 Common extensions
|
|
|
|
The following extensions are widely used in many systems, but are
|
|
not portable to all implementations. The inclusion of any extension
|
|
that may cause a strictly conforming program to become invalid renders
|
|
an implementation nonconforming. Examples of such extensions are new
|
|
keywords, or library functions declared in standard headers or
|
|
predefined macros with names that do not begin with an underscore.
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.5.1 Environment arguments
|
|
|
|
In a hosted environment, the main function receives a third
|
|
argument, char *envp[] , that points to a null-terminated array of
|
|
pointers to char , each of which points to a string that provides
|
|
information about the environment for this execution of the process
|
|
($2.1.2.2).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.5.2 Specialized identifiers
|
|
|
|
Characters other than the underscore _ , letters, and digits, that
|
|
are not defined in the required source character set (such as the
|
|
dollar sign $ , or characters in national character sets) may appear
|
|
in an identifier ($3.1.2).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.5.3 Lengths and cases of identifiers
|
|
|
|
All characters in identifiers (with or without external linkage)
|
|
are significant and case distinctions are observed ($3.1.2).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.5.4 Scopes of identifiers
|
|
|
|
A function identifier, or the identifier of an object the
|
|
declaration of which contains the keyword extern , has file scope
|
|
($3.1.2.1).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.5.5 Writable string literals
|
|
|
|
String literals are modifiable. Identical string literals shall be
|
|
distinct ($3.1.4).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.5.6 Other arithmetic types
|
|
|
|
Other arithmetic types, such as long long int , and their
|
|
appropriate conversions are defined ($3.2.2.1).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.5.7 Function pointer casts
|
|
|
|
A pointer to an object or to void may be cast to a pointer to a
|
|
function, allowing data to be invoked as a function ($3.3.4). A
|
|
pointer to a function may be cast to a pointer to an object or to void
|
|
, allowing a function to be inspected or modified (for example, by a
|
|
debugger) ($3.3.4).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.5.8 Non-int bit-field types
|
|
|
|
Types other than int , unsigned int , or signed int can be declared
|
|
as bit-fields, with appropriate maximum widths ($3.5.2.1).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.5.9 The fortran keyword
|
|
|
|
The fortran type specifier may be used in a function declaration to
|
|
indicate that function linkage suitable for FORTRAN is to be
|
|
generated, or that different representations for external names are to
|
|
be generated ($3.5.4.3).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.5.10 The asm keyword
|
|
|
|
The asm keyword may be used to insert assembly-language code
|
|
directly into the translator output. The most common implementation
|
|
is via a statement of the form
|
|
|
|
asm ( character-string-literal );
|
|
|
|
($3.6).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.5.11 Multiple external definitions
|
|
|
|
There may be more than one external definition for the identifier
|
|
of an object, with or without the explicit use of the keyword extern ,
|
|
If the definitions disagree, or more than one is initialized, the
|
|
behavior is undefined ($3.7.2).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.5.12 Empty macro arguments
|
|
|
|
A macro argument may consist of no preprocessing tokens ($3.8.3).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.5.13 Predefined macro names
|
|
|
|
Macro names that do not begin with an underscore, describing the
|
|
translation and execution environments, may be defined by the
|
|
implementation before translation begins ($3.8.8).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.5.14 Extra arguments for signal handlers
|
|
|
|
Handlers for specific signals may be called with extra arguments in
|
|
addition to the signal number ($4.7.1.1).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.5.15 Additional stream types and file-opening modes
|
|
|
|
Additional mappings from files to streams may be supported
|
|
($4.9.2), and additional file-opening modes may be specified by
|
|
characters appended to the mode argument of the fopen function
|
|
($4.9.5.3).
|
|
|
|
|
|
A.6.5.16 Defined file position indicator
|
|
|
|
The file position indicator is decremented by each successful call
|
|
to the ungetc function for a text stream, except if its value was zero
|
|
before a call ($4.9.7.11).
|
|
|
|
A.7 INDEX
|
|
|
|
Only major references are listed.
|
|
|
|
absolute-value functions, 4.5.6.2, 4.10.6.1
|
|
abstract declarator, type name, 3.5.5
|
|
abstract machine, 2.1.2.3
|
|
abstract semantics, 2.1.2.3
|
|
active position, 2.2.2
|
|
addition assignment operator, +=, 3.3.16.2
|
|
addition operator, +, 3.3.6
|
|
additive expressions, 3.3.6
|
|
address operator, &, 3.3.3.2
|
|
aggregate type, 3.1.2.5
|
|
alert escape sequence, \a, 2.2.2, 3.1.3.4
|
|
alignment, definition of, 1.6
|
|
alignment of structure members, 3.5.2.1
|
|
AND operator, bitwise, &, 3.3.10
|
|
AND operator, logical, &&, 3.3.13
|
|
argument, function, 3.3.2.2
|
|
argument, 1.6
|
|
argument promotion, default, 3.3.2.2
|
|
arithmetic conversions, usual, 3.2.1.5
|
|
arithmetic operators, unary, 3.3.3.3
|
|
arithmetic type, 3.1.2.5
|
|
array declarator, 3.5.4.2
|
|
array parameter, 3.7.1
|
|
array subscript operator, [ ], 3.3.2.1
|
|
array type, 3.1.2.5
|
|
array type conversion, 3.2.2.1
|
|
arrow operator, ->, 3.3.2.3
|
|
ASCII character set, 2.2.1.1
|
|
assignment operators, 3.3.16
|
|
asterisk punctuator, *, 3.1.6, 3.5.4.1
|
|
automatic storage, reentrancy, 2.1.2.3, 2.2.3
|
|
automatic storage duration, 3.1.2.4
|
|
|
|
backslash character, \, 2.1.1.2, 2.2.1
|
|
backspace escape sequence, \b, 2.2.2, 3.1.3.4
|
|
base documents, 1.5
|
|
basic character set, 1.6, 2.2.1
|
|
basic type, 3.1.2.5
|
|
binary stream, 4.9.2
|
|
bit, definition of, 1.6
|
|
bit, high-order, 1.6
|
|
bit, low-order, 1.6
|
|
bit-field structure member, 3.5.2.1
|
|
bitwise operators, 3.3, 3.3.7, 3.3.10, 3.3.11, 3.3.12
|
|
block, 3.6.2
|
|
block identifier scope, 3.1.2.1
|
|
braces punctuator, { }, 3.1.6, 3.5.7, 3.6.2
|
|
brackets punctuator, [ ], 3.1.6, 3.3.2.1, 3.5.4.2
|
|
broken-down-time type, 4.12.1
|
|
byte, definition of, 1.6
|
|
|
|
C program, 2.1.1.1
|
|
C Standard, definition of terms, 1.6
|
|
C Standard, organization of document, 1.4
|
|
C Standard, purpose of, 1.1
|
|
C Standard, references, 1.3
|
|
C Standard, scope, restrictions and limits, 1.2
|
|
carriage-return escape sequence, \r, 2.2.2, 3.1.3.4
|
|
case mapping functions, 4.3.2
|
|
cast expressions, 3.3.4
|
|
cast operator, ( ), 3.3.4
|
|
character, 1.6
|
|
character case mapping functions, 4.3.2
|
|
character constant, 2.1.1.2, 2.2.1, 3.1.3.4
|
|
character display semantics, 2.2.2
|
|
character handling header, 4.3
|
|
character input/output functions, 4.9.7
|
|
character sets, 2.2.1
|
|
character string literal, 2.1.1.2, 3.1.4
|
|
character testing functions, 4.3.1
|
|
character type, 3.1.2.5, 3.2.2.1, 3.5.7
|
|
character type conversion, 3.2.1.1
|
|
collating sequence, character set, 2.2.1
|
|
colon punctuator, :, 3.1.6, 3.5.2.1
|
|
comma operator, ,, 3.3.17
|
|
command processor, 4.10.4.5
|
|
comment delimiters, /* */, 3.1.9
|
|
comments, 2.1.1.2, 3.1, 3.1.9
|
|
common initial sequence, 3.3.2.3
|
|
comparison functions, 4.11.4
|
|
compatible type, 3.1.2.6, 3.5.2, 3.5.3, 3.5.4
|
|
complement operator, ~, 3.3.3.3
|
|
compliance, 1.7
|
|
composite type, 3.1.2.6
|
|
compound assignment operators, 3.3.16.2
|
|
compound statement, 3.6.2
|
|
concatenation functions, 4.11.3
|
|
conceptual models, 2.1
|
|
conditional inclusion, 3.8.1
|
|
conditional operator, ? :, 3.3.15
|
|
conforming freestanding implementation, 1.7
|
|
conforming hosted implementation, 1.7
|
|
conforming implementation, 1.7
|
|
conforming program, 1.7
|
|
const-qualified type, 3.1.2.5, 3.2.2.1, 3.5.3
|
|
constant, character, 3.1.3.4
|
|
constant, enumeration, 3.1.2, 3.1.3.3
|
|
constant, floating, 3.1.3.1
|
|
constant, integer, 3.1.3.2
|
|
constant, primary expression, 3.3.1
|
|
constant expressions, 3.4
|
|
constants, 3.1.3
|
|
constraints, definition of, 1.6
|
|
content, structure/union/enumeration, 3.5.2.3
|
|
contiguity, memory allocation, 4.10.3
|
|
control characters, 2.2.1, 4.3.1, 4.3.1.3
|
|
conversion, arithmetic operands, 3.2.1
|
|
conversion, array, 3.2.2.1
|
|
conversion, characters and integers, 3.2.1.1
|
|
conversion, explicit, 3.2
|
|
conversion, floating and integral, 3.2.1.3
|
|
conversion, floating types, 3.2.1.4, 3.2.1.5
|
|
conversion, function, 3.2.2.1
|
|
conversion, function arguments, 3.3.2.2, 3.7.1
|
|
conversion, implicit, 3.2
|
|
conversion, pointer, 3.2.2.1, 3.2.2.3
|
|
conversion, signed and unsigned integers, 3.2.1.2
|
|
conversion, void type, 3.2.2.2
|
|
conversions, 3.2
|
|
conversions, usual arithmetic, 3.2.1.5
|
|
copying functions, 4.11.2
|
|
|
|
data streams, 4.9.2
|
|
date and time header, 4.12
|
|
decimal constant, 3.1.3.2
|
|
decimal digits, 2.2.1
|
|
decimal-point character, 4.1.1
|
|
declaration specifiers, 3.5
|
|
declarations, 3.5
|
|
declarators, 3.5.4
|
|
declarator type derivation, 3.1.2.5, 3.5.4
|
|
decrement operator, postfix, --, 3.3.2.4
|
|
decrement operator, prefix, --, 3.3.3.1
|
|
default argument promotions, 3.3.2.2
|
|
definition, 3.5
|
|
derived declarator types, 3.1.2.5
|
|
derived types, 3.1.2.5
|
|
device input/output, 2.1.2.3
|
|
diagnostics, 2.1.1.3
|
|
diagnostics, assert.h, 4.2
|
|
direct input/output functions, 4.9.8
|
|
display device, 2.2.2
|
|
division assignment operator, /=, 3.3.16.2
|
|
division operator, /, 3.3.5
|
|
documentation of implementation, 1.7
|
|
domain error, 4.5.1
|
|
dot operator, ., 3.3.2.3
|
|
double-precision arithmetic, 2.1.2.3
|
|
|
|
element type, 3.1.2.5
|
|
ellipsis, unspecified parameters, , ..., 3.5.4.3
|
|
end-of-file macro, EOF, 4.3, 4.9.1
|
|
end-of-file indicator, 4.9.1, 4.9.7.1
|
|
end-of-line indicator, 2.2.1
|
|
enumerated types, 3.1.2.5
|
|
enumeration constant, 3.1.2, 3.1.3.3
|
|
enumeration content, 3.5.2.3
|
|
enumeration members, 3.5.2.2
|
|
enumeration specifiers, 3.5.2.2
|
|
enumeration tag, 3.5.2.3
|
|
enumerator, 3.5.2.2
|
|
environment, 2
|
|
environment functions, 4.10.4
|
|
environment list, 4.10.4.4
|
|
environmental considerations, 2.2
|
|
environmental limits, 2.2.4
|
|
equal-sign punctuator, =, 3.1.6, 3.5, 3.5.7
|
|
equal-to operator, ==, 3.3.9
|
|
equality expressions, 3.3.9
|
|
error, domain, 4.5.1
|
|
error, range, 4.5.1
|
|
error conditions, 4.5.1
|
|
error handling functions, 4.9.10, 4.11.6.2
|
|
error indicator, 4.9.1, 4.9.7.1, 4.9.7.3
|
|
escape sequences, 2.2.1, 2.2.2, 3.1.3.4
|
|
evaluation, 3.1.5, 3.3
|
|
exception, 3.3
|
|
exclusive OR assignment operator, ^=, 3.3.16.2
|
|
exclusive OR operator, ^, 3.3.11
|
|
executable program, 2.1.1.1
|
|
execution environment, character sets, 2.2.1
|
|
execution environment limits, 2.2.4.2
|
|
execution environments, 2.1.2
|
|
execution sequence, 2.1.2.3, 3.6
|
|
explicit conversion, 3.2
|
|
exponent part, floating constant, 3.1.3.1
|
|
exponential functions, 4.5.4
|
|
expression, 3.3
|
|
expression, full, 3.6
|
|
expression, primary, 3.3.1
|
|
expression, unary, 3.3.3
|
|
expression statement, 3.6.3
|
|
extended character set, 1.6, 2.2.1.2
|
|
external definitions, 3.7
|
|
external identifiers, underscore, 4.1.2
|
|
external linkage, 3.1.2.2
|
|
external name, 3.1.2
|
|
external object definitions, 3.7.2
|
|
|
|
file, closing, 4.9.3
|
|
file, creating, 4.9.3
|
|
file, opening, 4.9.3
|
|
file access functions, 4.9.5
|
|
file identifier scope, 3.1.2.1, 3.7
|
|
file name, 4.9.3
|
|
file operations, 4.9.4
|
|
file position indicator, 4.9.3
|
|
file positioning functions, 4.9.9
|
|
files, 4.9.3
|
|
floating arithmetic functions, 4.5.6
|
|
floating constants, 3.1.3.1
|
|
floating suffix, f or F, 3.1.3.1
|
|
floating types, 3.1.2.5
|
|
floating-point numbers, 3.1.2.5
|
|
form-feed character, 2.2.1, 3.1
|
|
form-feed escape sequence, \f, 2.2.2, 3.1.3.4
|
|
formatted input/output functions, 4.9.6
|
|
forward references, definition of, 1.6
|
|
freestanding execution environment, 2.1.2, 2.1.2.1
|
|
full expression, 3.6
|
|
fully buffered stream, 4.9.3
|
|
function, definition of, 1.6, 3.5.4.3
|
|
function, recursive call, 3.3.2.2
|
|
function argument, 3.3.2.2
|
|
function body, 3.7, 3.7.1
|
|
function call, 3.3.2.2
|
|
function call, library, 4.1.6
|
|
function declarator, 3.5.4.3
|
|
function definition, 3.5.4.3, 3.7.1
|
|
function designator, 3.2.2.1
|
|
function identifier scope, 3.1.2.1
|
|
function image, 2.2.3
|
|
function library, 2.1.1.1, 4.1.6
|
|
function parameter, 2.1.2.2, 3.3.2.2
|
|
function prototype, 3.1.2.1, 3.3.2.2, 3.5.4.3, 3.7.1
|
|
function prototype identifier scope, 3.1.2.1
|
|
function return, 3.6.6.4
|
|
function type, 3.1.2.5
|
|
function type conversion, 3.2.2.1
|
|
function-call operator, ( ), 3.3.2.2
|
|
future directions, 1.8, 3.9, 4.13
|
|
future language directions, 3.9
|
|
future library directions, 4.13
|
|
|
|
general utility library, 4.10
|
|
graphic characters, 2.2.1
|
|
greater-than operator, >, 3.3.8
|
|
greater-than-or-equal-to operator, >=, 3.3.8
|
|
|
|
header names, 3.1, 3.1.7, 3.8.2
|
|
headers, 4.1.2
|
|
hexadecimal constant, 3.1.3.2
|
|
hexadecimal digit, 3.1.3.2, 3.1.3.4
|
|
hexadecimal escape sequence, 3.1.3.4
|
|
high-order bit, 1.6
|
|
horizontal-tab character, 2.2.1, 3.1
|
|
horizontal-tab escape sequence, \t, 2.2.2, 3.1.3.4
|
|
hosted execution environment, 2.1.2, 2.1.2.2
|
|
hyperbolic functions, 4.5.3
|
|
|
|
identifier, 3.1.2, 3.3.1
|
|
identifier, maximum length, 3.1.2
|
|
identifier, reserved, 4.1.2
|
|
identifier linkage, 3.1.2.2
|
|
identifier list, 3.5.4
|
|
identifier name space, 3.1.2.3
|
|
identifier scope, 3.1.2.1
|
|
identifier type, 3.1.2.5
|
|
IEEE floating-point arithmetic standard, 2.2.4.2
|
|
implementation, definition of, 1.6
|
|
implementation limits, 1.6, 2.2.4
|
|
implementation-defined behavior, 1.6
|
|
implicit conversion, 3.2
|
|
implicit function declaration, 3.3.2.2
|
|
inclusive OR assignment operator, |=, 3.3.16.2
|
|
inclusive OR operator, |, 3.3.12
|
|
incomplete type, 3.1.2.5
|
|
increment operator, postfix, ++, 3.3.2.4
|
|
increment operator, prefix, ++, 3.3.3.1
|
|
indirection operator, *, 3.3.3.2
|
|
inequality operator, !=, 3.3.9
|
|
initialization, 2.1.2, 3.1.2.4, 3.2.2.1, 3.5.7, 3.6.2
|
|
initializer, string literal, 3.2.2.1, 3.5.7
|
|
initializer braces, 3.5.7
|
|
initial shift state, 2.2.1.2, 4.10.7
|
|
input/output, device, 2.1.2.3
|
|
input/output header, 4.9
|
|
integer arithmetic functions, 4.10.6
|
|
integer character constant, 3.1.3.4
|
|
integer constants, 3.1.3.2
|
|
integer suffix, 3.1.3.2
|
|
integer type, 3.1.2.5
|
|
integer type conversion, 3.2.1.1, 3.2.1.2
|
|
integral constant expression, 3.4
|
|
integral promotions, 2.1.2.3, 3.2.1.1
|
|
integral type, 3.1.2.5
|
|
integral type conversion, 3.2.1.3
|
|
interactive device, 2.1.2.3, 4.9.3, 4.9.5.3
|
|
internal linkage, 3.1.2.2
|
|
internal name, 3.1.2
|
|
interrupt handler, 2.1.2.3, 2.2.3, 4.7
|
|
ISO 4217 Currency and Funds Representation, 1.3, 4.4.2.1
|
|
ISO 646 Invariant Code Set, 1.3, 2.2.1.1
|
|
iteration statements, 3.6.5
|
|
|
|
jump statements, 3.6.6
|
|
|
|
keywords, 3.1.1
|
|
|
|
label name, 3.1.2.1, 3.1.2.3
|
|
labeled statements, 3.6.1
|
|
language, 3 language, future directions, 3.9
|
|
leading underscore in identifiers, 4.1.2
|
|
left-shift assignment operator, <<=, 3.3.16.2
|
|
left-shift operator, <<, 3.3.7
|
|
length function, 4.11.6.3
|
|
less-than operator, <, 3.3.8
|
|
less-than-or-equal-to operator, <=, 3.3.8
|
|
letter, 4.1.1
|
|
lexical elements, 2.1.1.2, 3.1
|
|
library, 2.1.1.1, 4
|
|
library, future directions, 4.13
|
|
library functions, use of, 4.1.6
|
|
library terms, 4.1.1
|
|
limits, environmental, 2.2.4
|
|
limits, numerical, 2.2.4.2
|
|
limits, translation, 2.2.4.1
|
|
line buffered stream, 4.9.3
|
|
line number, 3.8.4
|
|
lines, 2.1.1.2, 3.8, 4.9.2
|
|
linkages of identifiers, 3.1.2.2
|
|
locale, definition of, 1.6
|
|
localization, 4.4
|
|
logarithmic functions, 4.5.4
|
|
logical AND operator, &&, 3.3.13
|
|
logical negation operator, !, 3.3.3.3
|
|
logical OR operator, ||, 3.3.14
|
|
logical source lines, 2.1.1.2
|
|
long double suffix, l or L, 3.1.3.1
|
|
long integer suffix, l or L, 3.1.3.2
|
|
low-order bit, 1.6 lvalue, 3.2.2.1, 3.3.1, 3.3.2.4, 3.3.3.1, 3.3.16
|
|
|
|
macro function vs. definition, 4.1.6
|
|
macro name definition, 2.2.4.1
|
|
macro names, predefined, 3.8.8
|
|
macro, redefinition of, 3.8.3
|
|
macro replacement, 3.8.3
|
|
member-access operators, . and ->, 3.3.2.3
|
|
memory management functions, 4.10.3
|
|
minus operator, unary, -, 3.3.3.3
|
|
modifiable lvalue, 3.2.2.1
|
|
modulus function, 4.5.4.6
|
|
multibyte characters, 2.2.1.2, 3.1.3.4, 4.10.7, 4.10.8
|
|
multibyte functions, 4.10.7, 4.10.8
|
|
multiplication assignment operator, *=, 3.3.16.2
|
|
multiplication operator, *, 3.3.5
|
|
multiplicative expressions, 3.3.5
|
|
|
|
name, file, 4.9.3
|
|
name spaces of identifiers, 3.1.2.3
|
|
nearest-integer functions, 4.5.6
|
|
new-line character, 2.1.1.2, 2.2.1, 3.1, 3.8, 3.8.4
|
|
new-line escape sequence, \n, 2.2.2, 3.1.3.4
|
|
nongraphic characters, 2.2.2, 3.1.3.4
|
|
nonlocal jumps header, 4.6
|
|
not-equal-to operator, !=, 3.3.9
|
|
null character padding of binary streams, 4.9.2
|
|
null character, \0, 2.2.1, 3.1.3.4, 3.1.4
|
|
null pointer, 3.2.2.3
|
|
null pointer constant, 3.2.2.3
|
|
null preprocessing directive, 3.8.7
|
|
null statement, 3.6.3
|
|
number, floating-point, 3.1.2.5
|
|
numerical limits, 2.2.4.2
|
|
|
|
object, definition of, 1.6
|
|
object type, 3.1.2.5
|
|
obsolescence, 1.8, 3.9, 4.13
|
|
octal constant, 3.1.3.2
|
|
octal digit, 3.1.3.2, 3.1.3.4
|
|
octal escape sequence, 3.1.3.4
|
|
operand, 3.1.5, 3.3
|
|
operating system, 2.1.2.1, 4.10.4.5
|
|
operator, unary, 3.3.3
|
|
operators, 3.1.5, 3.3
|
|
OR assignment operator, exclusive, ^=, 3.3.16.2
|
|
OR assignment operator, inclusive, |=, 3.3.16.2
|
|
OR operator, exclusive, ^, 3.3.11
|
|
OR operator, inclusive, |, 3.3.12
|
|
OR operator, logical, ||, 3.3.14
|
|
order of memory allocation, 4.10.3
|
|
order of evaluation of expression, 3.3
|
|
ordinary identifier name space, 3.1.2.3
|
|
|
|
padding, null character, 4.9.2
|
|
parameter, ellipsis, , ..., 3.5.4.3
|
|
parameter, function, 3.3.2.2
|
|
parameter, main function, 2.1.2.2
|
|
parameter, 1.6
|
|
parameter type list, 3.5.4.3
|
|
parameters, program, 2.1.2.2
|
|
parentheses punctuator, ( ), 3.1.6, 3.5.4.3
|
|
parenthesized expression, 3.3.1
|
|
physical source lines, 2.1.1.2
|
|
plus operator, unary, +, 3.3.3.3
|
|
pointer, null, 3.2.2.3
|
|
pointer declarator, 3.5.4.1
|
|
pointer operator, ->, 3.3.2.3
|
|
pointer to function returning type, 3.3.2.2
|
|
pointer type, 3.1.2.5
|
|
pointer type conversion, 3.2.2.1, 3.2.2.3
|
|
portability of implementations, 1.7
|
|
position indicator, file, 4.9.3
|
|
postfix decrement operator, --, 3.3.2.4
|
|
postfix expressions, 3.3.2
|
|
postfix increment operator, ++, 3.3.2.4
|
|
power functions, 4.5.5
|
|
precedence of expression operators, 3.3
|
|
precedence of syntax rules, 2.1.1.2
|
|
predefined macro names, 3.8.8
|
|
prefix decrement operator, --, 3.3.3.1
|
|
prefix increment operator, ++, 3.3.3.1
|
|
preprocessing concatenation, 2.1.1.2, 3.8.3
|
|
preprocessing directives, 2.1.1.2, 3.8
|
|
preprocessing numbers, 3.1, 3.1.8
|
|
preprocessing tokens, 2.1.1.2, 3.1, 3.8
|
|
primary expressions, 3.3.1
|
|
printing characters, 2.2.2, 4.3.1, 4.3.1.7
|
|
program, conforming, 1.7
|
|
program, strictly conforming, 1.7
|
|
program diagnostics, 4.2.1
|
|
program execution, 2.1.2.3
|
|
program file, 2.1.1.1
|
|
program image, 2.1.1.2
|
|
program name, argv[0], 2.1.2.2
|
|
program parameters, 2.1.2.2
|
|
program startup, 2.1.2, 2.1.2.1, 2.1.2.2
|
|
program structure, 2.1.1.1
|
|
program termination, 2.1.2, 2.1.2.1, 2.1.2.2, 2.1.2.3
|
|
promotions, default argument, 3.3.2.2
|
|
promotions, integral, 2.1.2.3, 3.2.1.1
|
|
prototype, function, 3.1.2.1, 3.3.2.2, 3.5.4.3, 3.7.1
|
|
pseudo-random sequence functions, 4.10.2
|
|
punctuators, 3.1.6
|
|
|
|
qualified types, 3.1.2.5
|
|
|
|
range error, 4.5.1
|
|
recursive function call, 3.3.2.2
|
|
redefinition of macro, 3.8.3
|
|
reentrancy, 2.1.2.3, 2.2.3
|
|
referenced type, 3.1.2.5
|
|
relational expressions, 3.3.8
|
|
reliability of data, interrupted, 2.1.2.3
|
|
remainder assignment operator, %=, 3.3.16.2
|
|
remainder operator, %, 3.3.5
|
|
restore calling environment function, 4.6.2.1
|
|
reserved identifiers, 4.1.2
|
|
right-shift assignment operator, >>=, 3.3.16.2
|
|
right-shift operator, >>, 3.3.7
|
|
rvalue, 3.2.2.1
|
|
|
|
save calling environment function, 4.6.1.1
|
|
scalar type, 3.1.2.5
|
|
scope of identifiers, 3.1.2.1
|
|
search functions, 4.10.5.1, 4.11.5
|
|
selection statements, 3.6.4
|
|
semicolon punctuator, ;, 3.1.6, 3.5, 3.6.3
|
|
sequence points, 2.1.2.3, 3.3, 3.6
|
|
shift expressions, 3.3.7
|
|
shift states, 2.2.1.2, 4.10.7
|
|
side effects, 2.1.2.3, 3.3
|
|
signal handler, 2.2.3, 4.7.1.1
|
|
signals, 2.1.2.3, 2.2.3, 4.7
|
|
signed integer types, 3.1.2.5, 3.1.3.2, 3.2.1.2
|
|
simple assignment operator, =, 3.3.16.1
|
|
single-precision arithmetic, 2.1.2.3
|
|
sort function, 4.10.5.2
|
|
source character set, 2.2.1
|
|
source file inclusion, 3.8.2
|
|
source files, 2.1.1.1
|
|
source text, 2.1.1.2
|
|
space character, 2.1.1.2, 2.2.1, 3.1
|
|
standard streams, 4.9.1, 4.9.3
|
|
standard header, float.h, 1.7, 2.2.4.2, 4.1.4
|
|
standard header, limits.h, 1.7, 2.2.4.2, 4.1.4
|
|
standard header, stdarg.h, 1.7, 4.8
|
|
standard header, stddef.h, 1.7, 4.1.5
|
|
standard headers, 4.1.2
|
|
state-dependent encoding, 2.2.1.2, 4.10.7
|
|
statements, 3.6
|
|
static storage duration, 3.1.2.4
|
|
storage duration, 3.1.2.4
|
|
storage-class specifier, 3.5.1
|
|
stream, fully buffered, 4.9.3
|
|
stream, line buffered, 4.9.3
|
|
stream, standard error, stderr, 4.9.1, 4.9.3
|
|
stream, standard input, stdin, 4.9.1, 4.9.3
|
|
stream, standard output, stdout, 4.9.1, 4.9.3
|
|
stream, unbuffered, 4.9.3
|
|
streams, 4.9.2
|
|
strictly conforming program, 1.7
|
|
string, 4.1.1
|
|
string conversion functions, 4.10.1
|
|
string handling header, 4.11
|
|
string length, 4.1.1, 4.11.6.3
|
|
string literal, 2.1.1.2, 2.2.1, 3.1.4, 3.3.1, 3.5.7
|
|
structure/union arrow operator, ->, 3.3.2.3
|
|
structure/union content, 3.5.2.3
|
|
structure/union dot operator, ., 3.3.2.3
|
|
structure/union member name space, 3.1.2.3
|
|
structure/union specifiers, 3.5.2.1
|
|
structure/union tag, 3.5.2.3
|
|
structure/union type, 3.1.2.5, 3.5.2.1
|
|
subtraction assignment operator, -=, 3.3.16.2
|
|
subtraction operator, -, 3.3.6
|
|
suffix, floating constant, 3.1.3.1
|
|
suffix, integer constant, 3.1.3.2
|
|
switch body, 3.6.4.2
|
|
switch case label, 3.6.1, 3.6.4.2
|
|
switch default label, 3.6.1, 3.6.4.2
|
|
syntactic categories, 3
|
|
syntax notation, 3
|
|
syntax rules, precedence of, 2.1.1.2
|
|
|
|
tab characters, 2.2.1
|
|
tabs, white space, 3.1
|
|
tag, enumeration, 3.5.2.3
|
|
tag, structure/union, 3.5.2.3
|
|
tag name space, 3.1.2.3
|
|
tentative definitions, 3.7.2
|
|
text stream, 4.9.2
|
|
time components, 4.12.1
|
|
time conversion functions, 4.12.3
|
|
time manipulation functions, 4.12.2
|
|
tokens, 2.1.1.2, 3.1, 3.8
|
|
top type, 3.1.2.5
|
|
translation environment, 2.1.1
|
|
translation limits, 2.2.4.2
|
|
translation phases, 2.1.1.2
|
|
translation unit, 2.1.1.1, 3.7
|
|
trigonometric functions, 4.5.2
|
|
trigraph sequences, 2.1.1.2, 2.2.1.1
|
|
type, character, 3.1.2.5, 3.2.2.1, 3.5.7
|
|
type, compatible, 3.1.2.6, 3.5.2, 3.5.3, 3.5.4
|
|
type, composite, 3.1.2.6
|
|
type, const-qualified, 3.1.2.5, 3.5.3
|
|
type, function, 3.1.2.5
|
|
type, incomplete, 3.1.2.5
|
|
type, object, 3.1.2.5
|
|
type, qualified, 3.1.2.5
|
|
type, unqualified, 3.1.2.5
|
|
type, volatile-qualified, 3.1.2.5, 3.5.3
|
|
type conversions, 3.2
|
|
type definitions, 3.5.6
|
|
type names, 3.5.5
|
|
type specifiers, 3.5.2
|
|
type qualifiers, 3.5.3
|
|
types, 3.1.2.5
|
|
|
|
unary arithmetic operators, 3.3.3.3
|
|
unary expressions, 3.3.3
|
|
unary minus operator, -, 3.3.3.3
|
|
unary operators, 3.3.3
|
|
unary plus operator, +, 3.3.3.3
|
|
unbuffered stream, 4.9.3
|
|
undefined behavior, 1.6
|
|
underscore, leading, in identifiers, 4.1.2
|
|
union tag, 3.5.2.3
|
|
union type specifier, 3.1.2.5, 3.5.2, 3.5.2.1
|
|
unqualified type, 3.1.2.5
|
|
unsigned integer suffix, u or U, 3.1.3.2
|
|
unsigned integer types, 3.1.2.5, 3.1.3.2
|
|
unspecified behavior, 1.6
|
|
usual arithmetic conversions, 3.2.1.5
|
|
|
|
value part, floating constant, 3.1.3.1
|
|
variable arguments header, 4.8
|
|
vertical-tab character, 2.2.1, 3.1
|
|
vertical-tab escape sequence, \v, 2.2.2, 3.1.3.4
|
|
visibility of identifiers, 3.1.2.1
|
|
void expression, 3.2.2.2
|
|
volatile storage, 2.1.2.3
|
|
volatile-qualified type, 3.1.2.5, 3.5.3
|
|
|
|
white space, 2.1.1.2, 3.1, 3.8, 4.3.1.9
|
|
wide character, 3.1.3.4
|
|
wide character constant, 3.1.3.4
|
|
wide string literal, 2.1.1.2, 3.1.4
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1. This Standard is designed to promote the portability of C programs
|
|
among a variety of data-processing systems. It is intended for use by
|
|
implementors and knowledgeable programmers, and is not a tutorial. It
|
|
is accompanied by a Rationale document that explains many of the
|
|
decisions of the Technical Committee that produced it.
|
|
|
|
2. Strictly conforming programs are intended to be maximally portable
|
|
among conforming implementations. Conforming programs may depend upon
|
|
nonportable features of a conforming implementation.
|
|
|
|
3. Implementations must behave as if these separate phases occur, even
|
|
though many are typically folded together in practice.
|
|
|
|
4. As described in $3.1, the process of dividing a source file's
|
|
characters into preprocessing tokens is context-dependent. For
|
|
example, see the handling of < within a #include preprocessing
|
|
directive.
|
|
|
|
5. The trigraph sequences enable the input of characters that are not
|
|
defined in the "ISO 646-1983" Invariant Code Set, which is a subset of
|
|
the seven-bit ASCII code set.
|
|
|
|
6. Implementations should avoid imposing fixed translation limits
|
|
whenever possible.
|
|
|
|
7. See $3.1.2.5.
|
|
|
|
8. This model precludes floating-point representations other than
|
|
sign-magnitude.
|
|
|
|
9. The floating-point model in that standard sums powers of from zero,
|
|
so the values of the exponent limits are one less than shown here.
|
|
|
|
10. See ``future language directions'' ($3.9.1).
|
|
|
|
11. There is only one name space for tags even though three are
|
|
possible.
|
|
|
|
12. In the case of a volatile object, the last store may not be
|
|
explicit in the program.
|
|
|
|
13. A positional representation for integers that uses the binary
|
|
digits 0 and 1, in which the values represented by successive bits are
|
|
additive, begin with 1, and are multiplied by successive integral
|
|
powers of 2, except perhaps the bit with the highest position.
|
|
|
|
14. Note that aggregate type does not include union type because an
|
|
object with union type can only contain one member at a time.
|
|
|
|
15. There are three distinct combinations of qualified types.
|
|
|
|
16. Two types need not be identical to be compatible.
|
|
|
|
17. The semantics of these characters were discussed in $2.2.2.
|
|
|
|
18. See ``future language directions'' ($3.9.2).
|
|
|
|
19. A character string literal need not be a string (see $4.1.1),
|
|
because a null character may be embedded in it by a \0 escape
|
|
sequence.
|
|
|
|
20. Thus, sequences of characters that resemble escape sequences cause
|
|
undefined behavior.
|
|
|
|
21. Thus comments do not nest.
|
|
|
|
22. In a two's-complement representation, there is no actual change in
|
|
the bit pattern except filling the high-order bits with copies of the
|
|
sign bit if the unsigned integer has greater size.
|
|
|
|
23. The remaindering operation done when a value of integral type is
|
|
converted to unsigned type need not be done when a value of floating
|
|
type is converted to unsigned type. Thus the range of portable values
|
|
is [0, U type _MAX +1).
|
|
|
|
24. The name ``lvalue'' comes originally from the assignment
|
|
expression E1 = E2 , in which the left operand E1 must be a
|
|
(modifiable) lvalue. It is perhaps better considered as representing
|
|
an object ``locator value.'' What is sometimes called ``rvalue'' is in
|
|
this Standard described as the ``value of an expression.'' An obvious
|
|
example of an lvalue is an identifier of an object. As a further
|
|
example, if E is a unary expression that is a pointer to an object, *E
|
|
is an lvalue that designates the object to which E points.
|
|
|
|
25. Because this conversion does not occur, the operand of the sizeof
|
|
operator remains a function designator and violates the constraint in
|
|
$3.3.3.4.
|
|
|
|
26. This paragraph renders undefined statement expressions such as
|
|
i = ++i + 1; while allowing i = i + 1;
|
|
|
|
27. The syntax specifies the precedence of operators in the evaluation
|
|
of an expression, which is the same as the order of the major
|
|
subsections of this section, highest precedence first. Thus, for
|
|
example, the expressions allowed as the operands of the binary +
|
|
operator ($3.3.6) shall be those expressions defined in $3.3.1 through
|
|
$3.3.6. The exceptions are cast expressions ($3.3.4) as operands of
|
|
unary operators ($3.3.3), and an operand contained between any of the
|
|
following pairs of operators: grouping parentheses () ($3.3.1),
|
|
subscripting brackets [] ($3.3.2.1), function-call parentheses ()
|
|
($3.3.2.2), and the conditional operator ?: ($3.3.15). Within each
|
|
major subsection, the operators have the same precedence. Left- or
|
|
right-associativity is indicated in each subsection by the syntax for
|
|
the expressions discussed therein.
|
|
|
|
28. The intent of this list is to specify those circumstances in which
|
|
an object may or may not be aliased.
|
|
|
|
29. Most often, this is the result of converting an identifier that is
|
|
a function designator.
|
|
|
|
30. That is, a function with external linkage and no information about
|
|
its parameters that returns an int . If in fact it is not defined as
|
|
having type ``function returning int ,'' the behavior is undefined.
|
|
|
|
31. A function may change the values of its parameters, but these
|
|
changes cannot affect the values of the arguments. On the other hand,
|
|
it is possible to pass a pointer to an object, and the function may
|
|
change the value of the object pointed to. A parameter declared to
|
|
have array or function type is converted to a parameter with a pointer
|
|
type as described in
|
|
|
|
32. If &E is a valid pointer expression (where & is the ``address-of''
|
|
operator, which generates a pointer to its operand) the expression
|
|
(&E)->MOS is the same as E.MOS .
|
|
|
|
33. The ``byte orders'' for scalar types are invisible to isolated
|
|
programs that do not indulge in type punning (for example, by
|
|
assigning to one member of a union and inspecting the storage by
|
|
accessing another member that is an appropriately sized array of
|
|
character type), but must be accounted for when conforming to
|
|
externally-imposed storage layouts.
|
|
|
|
34. It is always true that if E is a function designator or an lvalue
|
|
that is a valid operand of the unary & operator, *&E is a function
|
|
designator or an lvalue equal to E . If *P is an lvalue and T is the
|
|
name of an object pointer type, the cast expression *(T)P is an lvalue
|
|
that has a type compatible with that to which T points. Among the
|
|
invalid values for dereferencing a pointer by the unary * operator are
|
|
a null pointer, an address inappropriately aligned for the type of
|
|
object pointed to, or the address of an object that has automatic
|
|
storage duration when execution of the block in which the object is
|
|
declared and of all enclosed blocks has terminated.
|
|
|
|
35. When applied to a parameter declared to have array or function
|
|
type, the sizeof operator yields the size of the pointer obtained by
|
|
converting as in $3.2.2.1; see $3.7.1.
|
|
|
|
36. A cast does not yield an lvalue.
|
|
|
|
37. The mapping functions for converting a pointer to an integer or an
|
|
integer to a pointer are intended to be consistent with the addressing
|
|
structure of the execution environment.
|
|
|
|
38. The expression a<b<c is not interpreted as in ordinary
|
|
mathematics. As the syntax indicates, it means (a<b)<c ; in other
|
|
words, ``if a is less than b compare 1 to c ; otherwise compare 0 to c
|
|
.''
|
|
|
|
39. Because of the precedences, a<b == c<d is 1 whenever a<b and c<d
|
|
have the same truth-value.
|
|
|
|
40. If invalid prior pointer operations, such as accesses outside
|
|
array bounds, produced undefined behavior, the effect of subsequent
|
|
comparisons is undefined.
|
|
|
|
41. A conditional expression does not yield an lvalue.
|
|
|
|
42. The asymmetric appearance of these constraints with respect to
|
|
type qualifiers is due to the conversion (specified in $3.2.2.1) that
|
|
changes lvalues to ``the value of the expression'' which removes any
|
|
type qualifiers from the top type of the expression.
|
|
|
|
43. A comma operator does not yield an lvalue.
|
|
|
|
44. The operand of a sizeof operator is not evaluated ($3.3.3.4), and
|
|
thus any operator in $3.3 may be used.
|
|
|
|
45. An integral constant expression must be used to specify the size
|
|
of a bit-field member of a structure, the value of an enumeration
|
|
constant, the size of an array, or the value of a case constant.
|
|
Further constraints that apply to the integral constant expressions
|
|
used in conditional-inclusion preprocessing directives are discussed
|
|
in $3.8.1.
|
|
|
|
46. Thus in the following initialization, static int i = 2 || 1 / 0;
|
|
the expression is a valid integral constant expression with value one.
|
|
|
|
47. Function definitions have a different syntax, described in $3.7.1.
|
|
|
|
48. See ``future language directions'' ($3.9.3).
|
|
|
|
49. The implementation may treat any register declaration simply as an
|
|
auto declaration. However, whether or not addressable storage is
|
|
actually used, the address of any part of an object declared with
|
|
storage-class specifier register may not be computed, either
|
|
explicitly (by use of the unary & operator as discussed in $3.3.3.2)
|
|
or implicitly (by converting an array name to a pointer as discussed
|
|
in $3.2.2.1). Thus the only operator that can be applied to an array
|
|
declared with storage-class specifier register is sizeof .
|
|
|
|
50. The unary & (address-of) operator may not be applied to a
|
|
bit-field object; thus there are no pointers to or arrays of bit-field
|
|
objects.
|
|
|
|
51. An unnamed bit-field is useful for padding to conform to
|
|
externally-imposed layouts.
|
|
|
|
52. Thus, the identifiers of enumeration constants in the same scope
|
|
shall all be distinct from each other and from other identifiers
|
|
declared in ordinary declarators.
|
|
|
|
53. A similar construction with enum does not exist and is not
|
|
necessary as there can be no mutual dependencies between the
|
|
declaration of an enumerated type and any other type.
|
|
|
|
54. It is not needed, for example, when a typedef name is declared to
|
|
be a specifier for a structure or union, or when a pointer to or a
|
|
function returning a structure or union is being declared. (See
|
|
incomplete types in $3.1.2.5.) The specification shall be complete
|
|
before such a function is called or defined.
|
|
|
|
55. Of course, when the declaration is of a typedef name, subsequent
|
|
declarations can make use of the typedef name to declare objects
|
|
having the specified structure, union, or enumerated type.
|
|
|
|
56. The implementation may place a const object that is not volatile
|
|
in a read-only region of storage. Moreover, the implementation need
|
|
not allocate storage for such an object if its address is never used.
|
|
|
|
57. This applies to those objects that behave as if they were defined
|
|
with qualified types, even if they are never actually defined as
|
|
objects in the program (such as an object at a memory-mapped
|
|
input/output address).
|
|
|
|
58. A volatile declaration may be used to describe an object
|
|
corresponding to a memory-mapped input/output port or an object
|
|
accessed by an asynchronously interrupting function. Actions on
|
|
objects so declared shall not be ``optimized out'' by an
|
|
implementation or reordered except as permitted by the rules for
|
|
evaluating expressions.
|
|
|
|
59. Both of these can only occur through the use of typedef s.
|
|
|
|
60. When several ``array of'' specifications are adjacent, a
|
|
multi-dimensional array is declared.
|
|
|
|
61. The macros defined in the <stdarg.h> header ($4.8) may be used to
|
|
access arguments that follow an ellipsis.
|
|
|
|
62. See ``future language directions'' ($3.9.4).
|
|
|
|
63. If both function types are ``old style,'' parameter types are not
|
|
compared.
|
|
|
|
64. As indicated by the syntax, empty parentheses in a type name are
|
|
interpreted as ``function with no parameter specification,'' rather
|
|
than redundant parentheses around the omitted identifier.
|
|
|
|
65. Unlike in the base document, any automatic duration object may be
|
|
initialized.
|
|
|
|
66. Such as assignments, and function calls which have side effects.
|
|
|
|
67. Thus specifies initialization for the loop; the controlling
|
|
expression, specifies an evaluation made before each iteration, such
|
|
that execution of the loop continues until the expression compares
|
|
equal to 0; specifies an operation (such as incrementing) that is
|
|
performed after each iteration.
|
|
|
|
68. Following the contin: label is a null statement.
|
|
|
|
69. Thus, if an identifier declared with external linkage is not used
|
|
in an expression, there need be no external definition for it.
|
|
|
|
70. The intent is that the top type in a function definition cannot be
|
|
inherited from a typedef: typedef int F(void); /* type F is ``function
|
|
of no arguments returning int '' */ F f, g; /* f and g both have type
|
|
compatible with F */ F f { /*...*/ } /* WRONG: syntax/constraint error
|
|
*/ F g() { /*...*/ } /* WRONG: declares that g returns a function */
|
|
int f(void) { /*...*/ } /* RIGHT: f has type compatible with F */ int
|
|
g() { /*...*/ } /* RIGHT: g has type compatible with F */ F *e(void) {
|
|
/*...*/ } /* e returns a pointer to a function */ F *((e))(void) {
|
|
/*...*/ } /* same: parentheses irrelevant */ int (*fp)(void); /* fp
|
|
points to a function that has type F */ F *Fp; /* Fp points to a
|
|
function that has type F */
|
|
|
|
71. See ``future language directions'' ($3.9.5).
|
|
|
|
72. A parameter is in effect declared at the head of the compound
|
|
statement that constitutes the function body, and therefore may not be
|
|
redeclared in the function body (except in an enclosed block).
|
|
|
|
73. Thus preprocessing directives are commonly called ``lines.'' These
|
|
``lines'' have no other syntactic significance, as all white space is
|
|
equivalent except in certain situations during preprocessing (see the
|
|
# character string literal creation operator in $3.8.3.2, for
|
|
example).
|
|
|
|
74. Because the controlling constant expression is evaluated during
|
|
translation phase 4, all identifiers either are or are not macro names
|
|
--- there simply are no keywords, enumeration constants, and so on.
|
|
|
|
75. Thus the constant expression in the following #if directive and if
|
|
statement is not guaranteed to evaluate to the same value in these two
|
|
contexts. #if 'z' - 'a' == 25 if ('z' - 'a' == 25)
|
|
|
|
76. As indicated by the syntax, a preprocessing token shall not follow
|
|
a #else or #endif directive before the terminating new-line character.
|
|
However, comments may appear anywhere in a source file, including
|
|
within a preprocessing directive.
|
|
|
|
77. Note that adjacent string literals are not concatenated into a
|
|
single string literal (see the translation phases in $2.1.1.2); thus
|
|
an expansion that results in two string literals is an invalid
|
|
directive.
|
|
|
|
78. Since, by macro-replacement time, all character constants and
|
|
string literals are preprocessing tokens, not sequences possibly
|
|
containing identifier-like subsequences (see $2.1.1.2, translation
|
|
phases), they are never scanned for macro names or parameters.
|
|
|
|
79. Thus indicating a Standard-conforming implementation.
|
|
|
|
80. The functions that make use of the decimal-point character are
|
|
localeconv , fprintf , fscanf , printf , scanf , sprintf , sscanf ,
|
|
vfprintf , vprintf , vsprintf , atof , and strtod .
|
|
|
|
81. A header is not necessarily a source file, nor are the < and >
|
|
delimited sequences in header names necessarily valid source file
|
|
names.
|
|
|
|
82. The list of reserved external identifiers includes errno , setjmp ,
|
|
and va_end .
|
|
|
|
83. The macro errno need not be the identifier of an object. It might
|
|
be a modifiable lvalue resulting from a function call (for example,
|
|
*errno() ).
|
|
|
|
84. Thus, a program that uses errno for error checking should set it
|
|
to zero before a library function call, then inspect it before a
|
|
subsequent library function call.
|
|
|
|
85. See ``future library directions'' ($4.13.1).
|
|
|
|
86. This means that an implementation must provide an actual function
|
|
for each library function, even if it also provides a macro for that
|
|
function.
|
|
|
|
87. Because external identifiers and some macro names beginning with
|
|
an underscore are reserved, implementations may provide special
|
|
semantics for such names. For example, the identifier _BUILTIN_abs
|
|
could be used to indicate generation of in-line code for the abs
|
|
function. Thus, the appropriate header could specify #define abs(x)
|
|
_BUILTIN_abs(x) for a compiler whose code generator will accept it.
|
|
In this manner, a user desiring to guarantee that a given library
|
|
function such as abs will be a genuine function may write #undef abs
|
|
whether the implementation's header provides a macro implementation of
|
|
abs or a builtin implementation. The prototype for the function,
|
|
which precedes and is hidden by any macro definition, is thereby
|
|
revealed also.
|
|
|
|
88. The message written might be of the form Assertion failed: file
|
|
line
|
|
|
|
89. See ``future library directions'' ($4.13.2).
|
|
|
|
90. In an implementation that uses the seven-bit ASCII character set,
|
|
the printing characters are those whose values lie from 0x20 (space)
|
|
through 0x7E (tilde); the control characters are those whose values
|
|
lie from 0 (NUL) through 0x1F (US), and the character 0x7F (DEL).
|
|
|
|
91. See ``future library directions'' ($4.13.3).
|
|
|
|
92. The only functions in $4.3 whose behavior is not affected by the
|
|
current locale are isdigit and isxdigit .
|
|
|
|
93. See ``future library directions'' ($4.13.4).
|
|
|
|
94. In an implementation that supports infinities, this allows
|
|
infinity as an argument to be a domain error if the mathematical
|
|
domain of the function does not include infinity.
|
|
|
|
95. These functions are useful for dealing with unusual conditions
|
|
encountered in a low-level function of a program.
|
|
|
|
96. For example, by executing a return statement or because another
|
|
longjmp call has caused a transfer to a setjmp invocation in a
|
|
function earlier in the set of nested calls.
|
|
|
|
97. See ``future library directions'' ($4.13.5). The names of the
|
|
signal numbers reflect the following terms (respectively): abort,
|
|
floating-point exception, illegal instruction, interrupt, segmentation
|
|
violation, and termination.
|
|
|
|
98. Of course, the contents of the file name strings are subject to
|
|
other system-specific constraints.
|
|
|
|
99. An implementation need not distinguish between text streams and
|
|
binary streams. In such an implementation, there need be no new-line
|
|
characters in a text stream nor any limit to the length of a line.
|
|
|
|
100. This is described in the Base Document as a That term is not used
|
|
in this Standard to avoid confusion with a pointer to an object that
|
|
has type FILE .
|
|
|
|
101. Among the reasons the implementation may cause the rename
|
|
function to fail are that the file is open or that it is necessary to
|
|
copy its contents to effectuate its renaming.
|
|
|
|
102. Files created using strings generated by the tmpnam function are
|
|
temporary only in the sense that their names should not collide with
|
|
those generated by conventional naming rules for the implementation.
|
|
It is still necessary to use the remove function to remove such files
|
|
when their use is ended, and before program termination.
|
|
|
|
103. Additional characters may follow these sequences.
|
|
|
|
104. The primary use of the freopen function is to change the file
|
|
associated with a standard text stream ( stderr , stdin , or stdout ),
|
|
as those identifiers need not be modifiable lvalues to which the value
|
|
returned by the fopen function may be assigned.
|
|
|
|
105. The buffer must have a lifetime at least as great as the open
|
|
stream, so the stream should be closed before a buffer that has
|
|
automatic storage duration is deallocated upon block exit.
|
|
|
|
106. Note that 0 is taken as a flag, not as the beginning of a field
|
|
width.
|
|
|
|
107. No special provisions are made for multibyte characters.
|
|
|
|
108. See ``future library directions'' ($4.13.6).
|
|
|
|
109. No special provisions are made for multibyte characters.
|
|
|
|
110. See ``future library directions'' ($4.13.6).
|
|
|
|
111. As vfprintf , vsprintf , and vprintf invoke the va_arg macro, the
|
|
value of arg after the return is indeterminate.
|
|
|
|
112. An end-of-file and a read error can be distinguished by use of
|
|
the feof and ferror functions.
|
|
|
|
113. See ``future library directions'' ($4.13.7).
|
|
|
|
114. Note that this need not be the same as the representation of
|
|
floating-point zero or a null pointer constant.
|
|
|
|
115. Each function is called as many times as it was registered.
|
|
|
|
116. Notice that the key-to-member comparison an ordering on the
|
|
array.
|
|
|
|
117. In a two's complement representation, the absolute value of the
|
|
most negative number cannot be represented.
|
|
|
|
118. The array will not be null- or zero-terminated if the value
|
|
returned is n .
|
|
|
|
119. See ``future library directions'' ($4.13.8).
|
|
|
|
120. Thus, if there is no null character in the first n characters of
|
|
the array pointed to by s2 , the result will not be null-terminated.
|
|
|
|
121. Thus the maximum number of characters that end up in the array
|
|
pointed to by s1 is strlen(s1)+n+1 .
|
|
|
|
122. The contents of ``holes'' used as padding for purposes of
|
|
alignment within structure objects are indeterminate, unless the
|
|
contents of the entire object have been set explicitly, as by the
|
|
calloc or memset function. Strings shorter than their allocated space
|
|
and unions may also cause problems in comparison.
|
|
|
|
123. The range [0, 60] for tm_sec allows for the occasional leap
|
|
second.
|
|
|
|
124. Thus, a positive or zero value for tm_isdst causes the mktime
|
|
function initially to presume that Daylight Saving Time, respectively,
|
|
is or is not in effect for the specified time. A negative value for
|
|
tm_isdst causes the mktime function to attempt to determine whether
|
|
Daylight Saving Time is in effect for the specified time.
|